]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/gcc.git/blob - gcc/doc/md.texi
Update copyright years.
[thirdparty/gcc.git] / gcc / doc / md.texi
1 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
2 @c This is part of the GCC manual.
3 @c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
4
5 @ifset INTERNALS
6 @node Machine Desc
7 @chapter Machine Descriptions
8 @cindex machine descriptions
9
10 A machine description has two parts: a file of instruction patterns
11 (@file{.md} file) and a C header file of macro definitions.
12
13 The @file{.md} file for a target machine contains a pattern for each
14 instruction that the target machine supports (or at least each instruction
15 that is worth telling the compiler about). It may also contain comments.
16 A semicolon causes the rest of the line to be a comment, unless the semicolon
17 is inside a quoted string.
18
19 See the next chapter for information on the C header file.
20
21 @menu
22 * Overview:: How the machine description is used.
23 * Patterns:: How to write instruction patterns.
24 * Example:: An explained example of a @code{define_insn} pattern.
25 * RTL Template:: The RTL template defines what insns match a pattern.
26 * Output Template:: The output template says how to make assembler code
27 from such an insn.
28 * Output Statement:: For more generality, write C code to output
29 the assembler code.
30 * Predicates:: Controlling what kinds of operands can be used
31 for an insn.
32 * Constraints:: Fine-tuning operand selection.
33 * Standard Names:: Names mark patterns to use for code generation.
34 * Pattern Ordering:: When the order of patterns makes a difference.
35 * Dependent Patterns:: Having one pattern may make you need another.
36 * Jump Patterns:: Special considerations for patterns for jump insns.
37 * Looping Patterns:: How to define patterns for special looping insns.
38 * Insn Canonicalizations::Canonicalization of Instructions
39 * Expander Definitions::Generating a sequence of several RTL insns
40 for a standard operation.
41 * Insn Splitting:: Splitting Instructions into Multiple Instructions.
42 * Including Patterns:: Including Patterns in Machine Descriptions.
43 * Peephole Definitions::Defining machine-specific peephole optimizations.
44 * Insn Attributes:: Specifying the value of attributes for generated insns.
45 * Conditional Execution::Generating @code{define_insn} patterns for
46 predication.
47 * Define Subst:: Generating @code{define_insn} and @code{define_expand}
48 patterns from other patterns.
49 * Constant Definitions::Defining symbolic constants that can be used in the
50 md file.
51 * Iterators:: Using iterators to generate patterns from a template.
52 @end menu
53
54 @node Overview
55 @section Overview of How the Machine Description is Used
56
57 There are three main conversions that happen in the compiler:
58
59 @enumerate
60
61 @item
62 The front end reads the source code and builds a parse tree.
63
64 @item
65 The parse tree is used to generate an RTL insn list based on named
66 instruction patterns.
67
68 @item
69 The insn list is matched against the RTL templates to produce assembler
70 code.
71
72 @end enumerate
73
74 For the generate pass, only the names of the insns matter, from either a
75 named @code{define_insn} or a @code{define_expand}. The compiler will
76 choose the pattern with the right name and apply the operands according
77 to the documentation later in this chapter, without regard for the RTL
78 template or operand constraints. Note that the names the compiler looks
79 for are hard-coded in the compiler---it will ignore unnamed patterns and
80 patterns with names it doesn't know about, but if you don't provide a
81 named pattern it needs, it will abort.
82
83 If a @code{define_insn} is used, the template given is inserted into the
84 insn list. If a @code{define_expand} is used, one of three things
85 happens, based on the condition logic. The condition logic may manually
86 create new insns for the insn list, say via @code{emit_insn()}, and
87 invoke @code{DONE}. For certain named patterns, it may invoke @code{FAIL} to tell the
88 compiler to use an alternate way of performing that task. If it invokes
89 neither @code{DONE} nor @code{FAIL}, the template given in the pattern
90 is inserted, as if the @code{define_expand} were a @code{define_insn}.
91
92 Once the insn list is generated, various optimization passes convert,
93 replace, and rearrange the insns in the insn list. This is where the
94 @code{define_split} and @code{define_peephole} patterns get used, for
95 example.
96
97 Finally, the insn list's RTL is matched up with the RTL templates in the
98 @code{define_insn} patterns, and those patterns are used to emit the
99 final assembly code. For this purpose, each named @code{define_insn}
100 acts like it's unnamed, since the names are ignored.
101
102 @node Patterns
103 @section Everything about Instruction Patterns
104 @cindex patterns
105 @cindex instruction patterns
106
107 @findex define_insn
108 A @code{define_insn} expression is used to define instruction patterns
109 to which insns may be matched. A @code{define_insn} expression contains
110 an incomplete RTL expression, with pieces to be filled in later, operand
111 constraints that restrict how the pieces can be filled in, and an output
112 template or C code to generate the assembler output.
113
114 A @code{define_insn} is an RTL expression containing four or five operands:
115
116 @enumerate
117 @item
118 An optional name @var{n}. When a name is present, the compiler
119 automically generates a C++ function @samp{gen_@var{n}} that takes
120 the operands of the instruction as arguments and returns the instruction's
121 rtx pattern. The compiler also assigns the instruction a unique code
122 @samp{CODE_FOR_@var{n}}, with all such codes belonging to an enum
123 called @code{insn_code}.
124
125 These names serve one of two purposes. The first is to indicate that the
126 instruction performs a certain standard job for the RTL-generation
127 pass of the compiler, such as a move, an addition, or a conditional
128 jump. The second is to help the target generate certain target-specific
129 operations, such as when implementing target-specific intrinsic functions.
130
131 It is better to prefix target-specific names with the name of the
132 target, to avoid any clash with current or future standard names.
133
134 The absence of a name is indicated by writing an empty string
135 where the name should go. Nameless instruction patterns are never
136 used for generating RTL code, but they may permit several simpler insns
137 to be combined later on.
138
139 For the purpose of debugging the compiler, you may also specify a
140 name beginning with the @samp{*} character. Such a name is used only
141 for identifying the instruction in RTL dumps; it is equivalent to having
142 a nameless pattern for all other purposes. Names beginning with the
143 @samp{*} character are not required to be unique.
144
145 The name may also have the form @samp{@@@var{n}}. This has the same
146 effect as a name @samp{@var{n}}, but in addition tells the compiler to
147 generate further helper functions; see @ref{Parameterized Names} for details.
148
149 @item
150 The @dfn{RTL template}: This is a vector of incomplete RTL expressions
151 which describe the semantics of the instruction (@pxref{RTL Template}).
152 It is incomplete because it may contain @code{match_operand},
153 @code{match_operator}, and @code{match_dup} expressions that stand for
154 operands of the instruction.
155
156 If the vector has multiple elements, the RTL template is treated as a
157 @code{parallel} expression.
158
159 @item
160 @cindex pattern conditions
161 @cindex conditions, in patterns
162 The condition: This is a string which contains a C expression. When the
163 compiler attempts to match RTL against a pattern, the condition is
164 evaluated. If the condition evaluates to @code{true}, the match is
165 permitted. The condition may be an empty string, which is treated
166 as always @code{true}.
167
168 @cindex named patterns and conditions
169 For a named pattern, the condition may not depend on the data in the
170 insn being matched, but only the target-machine-type flags. The compiler
171 needs to test these conditions during initialization in order to learn
172 exactly which named instructions are available in a particular run.
173
174 @findex operands
175 For nameless patterns, the condition is applied only when matching an
176 individual insn, and only after the insn has matched the pattern's
177 recognition template. The insn's operands may be found in the vector
178 @code{operands}.
179
180 An instruction condition cannot become more restrictive as compilation
181 progresses. If the condition accepts a particular RTL instruction at
182 one stage of compilation, it must continue to accept that instruction
183 until the final pass. For example, @samp{!reload_completed} and
184 @samp{can_create_pseudo_p ()} are both invalid instruction conditions,
185 because they are true during the earlier RTL passes and false during
186 the later ones. For the same reason, if a condition accepts an
187 instruction before register allocation, it cannot later try to control
188 register allocation by excluding certain register or value combinations.
189
190 Although a condition cannot become more restrictive as compilation
191 progresses, the condition for a nameless pattern @emph{can} become
192 more permissive. For example, a nameless instruction can require
193 @samp{reload_completed} to be true, in which case it only matches
194 after register allocation.
195
196 @item
197 The @dfn{output template} or @dfn{output statement}: This is either
198 a string, or a fragment of C code which returns a string.
199
200 When simple substitution isn't general enough, you can specify a piece
201 of C code to compute the output. @xref{Output Statement}.
202
203 @item
204 The @dfn{insn attributes}: This is an optional vector containing the values of
205 attributes for insns matching this pattern (@pxref{Insn Attributes}).
206 @end enumerate
207
208 @node Example
209 @section Example of @code{define_insn}
210 @cindex @code{define_insn} example
211
212 Here is an example of an instruction pattern, taken from the machine
213 description for the 68000/68020.
214
215 @smallexample
216 (define_insn "tstsi"
217 [(set (cc0)
218 (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "rm"))]
219 ""
220 "*
221 @{
222 if (TARGET_68020 || ! ADDRESS_REG_P (operands[0]))
223 return \"tstl %0\";
224 return \"cmpl #0,%0\";
225 @}")
226 @end smallexample
227
228 @noindent
229 This can also be written using braced strings:
230
231 @smallexample
232 (define_insn "tstsi"
233 [(set (cc0)
234 (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "rm"))]
235 ""
236 @{
237 if (TARGET_68020 || ! ADDRESS_REG_P (operands[0]))
238 return "tstl %0";
239 return "cmpl #0,%0";
240 @})
241 @end smallexample
242
243 This describes an instruction which sets the condition codes based on the
244 value of a general operand. It has no condition, so any insn with an RTL
245 description of the form shown may be matched to this pattern. The name
246 @samp{tstsi} means ``test a @code{SImode} value'' and tells the RTL
247 generation pass that, when it is necessary to test such a value, an insn
248 to do so can be constructed using this pattern.
249
250 The output control string is a piece of C code which chooses which
251 output template to return based on the kind of operand and the specific
252 type of CPU for which code is being generated.
253
254 @samp{"rm"} is an operand constraint. Its meaning is explained below.
255
256 @node RTL Template
257 @section RTL Template
258 @cindex RTL insn template
259 @cindex generating insns
260 @cindex insns, generating
261 @cindex recognizing insns
262 @cindex insns, recognizing
263
264 The RTL template is used to define which insns match the particular pattern
265 and how to find their operands. For named patterns, the RTL template also
266 says how to construct an insn from specified operands.
267
268 Construction involves substituting specified operands into a copy of the
269 template. Matching involves determining the values that serve as the
270 operands in the insn being matched. Both of these activities are
271 controlled by special expression types that direct matching and
272 substitution of the operands.
273
274 @table @code
275 @findex match_operand
276 @item (match_operand:@var{m} @var{n} @var{predicate} @var{constraint})
277 This expression is a placeholder for operand number @var{n} of
278 the insn. When constructing an insn, operand number @var{n}
279 will be substituted at this point. When matching an insn, whatever
280 appears at this position in the insn will be taken as operand
281 number @var{n}; but it must satisfy @var{predicate} or this instruction
282 pattern will not match at all.
283
284 Operand numbers must be chosen consecutively counting from zero in
285 each instruction pattern. There may be only one @code{match_operand}
286 expression in the pattern for each operand number. Usually operands
287 are numbered in the order of appearance in @code{match_operand}
288 expressions. In the case of a @code{define_expand}, any operand numbers
289 used only in @code{match_dup} expressions have higher values than all
290 other operand numbers.
291
292 @var{predicate} is a string that is the name of a function that
293 accepts two arguments, an expression and a machine mode.
294 @xref{Predicates}. During matching, the function will be called with
295 the putative operand as the expression and @var{m} as the mode
296 argument (if @var{m} is not specified, @code{VOIDmode} will be used,
297 which normally causes @var{predicate} to accept any mode). If it
298 returns zero, this instruction pattern fails to match.
299 @var{predicate} may be an empty string; then it means no test is to be
300 done on the operand, so anything which occurs in this position is
301 valid.
302
303 Most of the time, @var{predicate} will reject modes other than @var{m}---but
304 not always. For example, the predicate @code{address_operand} uses
305 @var{m} as the mode of memory ref that the address should be valid for.
306 Many predicates accept @code{const_int} nodes even though their mode is
307 @code{VOIDmode}.
308
309 @var{constraint} controls reloading and the choice of the best register
310 class to use for a value, as explained later (@pxref{Constraints}).
311 If the constraint would be an empty string, it can be omitted.
312
313 People are often unclear on the difference between the constraint and the
314 predicate. The predicate helps decide whether a given insn matches the
315 pattern. The constraint plays no role in this decision; instead, it
316 controls various decisions in the case of an insn which does match.
317
318 @findex match_scratch
319 @item (match_scratch:@var{m} @var{n} @var{constraint})
320 This expression is also a placeholder for operand number @var{n}
321 and indicates that operand must be a @code{scratch} or @code{reg}
322 expression.
323
324 When matching patterns, this is equivalent to
325
326 @smallexample
327 (match_operand:@var{m} @var{n} "scratch_operand" @var{constraint})
328 @end smallexample
329
330 but, when generating RTL, it produces a (@code{scratch}:@var{m})
331 expression.
332
333 If the last few expressions in a @code{parallel} are @code{clobber}
334 expressions whose operands are either a hard register or
335 @code{match_scratch}, the combiner can add or delete them when
336 necessary. @xref{Side Effects}.
337
338 @findex match_dup
339 @item (match_dup @var{n})
340 This expression is also a placeholder for operand number @var{n}.
341 It is used when the operand needs to appear more than once in the
342 insn.
343
344 In construction, @code{match_dup} acts just like @code{match_operand}:
345 the operand is substituted into the insn being constructed. But in
346 matching, @code{match_dup} behaves differently. It assumes that operand
347 number @var{n} has already been determined by a @code{match_operand}
348 appearing earlier in the recognition template, and it matches only an
349 identical-looking expression.
350
351 Note that @code{match_dup} should not be used to tell the compiler that
352 a particular register is being used for two operands (example:
353 @code{add} that adds one register to another; the second register is
354 both an input operand and the output operand). Use a matching
355 constraint (@pxref{Simple Constraints}) for those. @code{match_dup} is for the cases where one
356 operand is used in two places in the template, such as an instruction
357 that computes both a quotient and a remainder, where the opcode takes
358 two input operands but the RTL template has to refer to each of those
359 twice; once for the quotient pattern and once for the remainder pattern.
360
361 @findex match_operator
362 @item (match_operator:@var{m} @var{n} @var{predicate} [@var{operands}@dots{}])
363 This pattern is a kind of placeholder for a variable RTL expression
364 code.
365
366 When constructing an insn, it stands for an RTL expression whose
367 expression code is taken from that of operand @var{n}, and whose
368 operands are constructed from the patterns @var{operands}.
369
370 When matching an expression, it matches an expression if the function
371 @var{predicate} returns nonzero on that expression @emph{and} the
372 patterns @var{operands} match the operands of the expression.
373
374 Suppose that the function @code{commutative_operator} is defined as
375 follows, to match any expression whose operator is one of the
376 commutative arithmetic operators of RTL and whose mode is @var{mode}:
377
378 @smallexample
379 int
380 commutative_integer_operator (x, mode)
381 rtx x;
382 machine_mode mode;
383 @{
384 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
385 if (GET_MODE (x) != mode)
386 return 0;
387 return (GET_RTX_CLASS (code) == RTX_COMM_ARITH
388 || code == EQ || code == NE);
389 @}
390 @end smallexample
391
392 Then the following pattern will match any RTL expression consisting
393 of a commutative operator applied to two general operands:
394
395 @smallexample
396 (match_operator:SI 3 "commutative_operator"
397 [(match_operand:SI 1 "general_operand" "g")
398 (match_operand:SI 2 "general_operand" "g")])
399 @end smallexample
400
401 Here the vector @code{[@var{operands}@dots{}]} contains two patterns
402 because the expressions to be matched all contain two operands.
403
404 When this pattern does match, the two operands of the commutative
405 operator are recorded as operands 1 and 2 of the insn. (This is done
406 by the two instances of @code{match_operand}.) Operand 3 of the insn
407 will be the entire commutative expression: use @code{GET_CODE
408 (operands[3])} to see which commutative operator was used.
409
410 The machine mode @var{m} of @code{match_operator} works like that of
411 @code{match_operand}: it is passed as the second argument to the
412 predicate function, and that function is solely responsible for
413 deciding whether the expression to be matched ``has'' that mode.
414
415 When constructing an insn, argument 3 of the gen-function will specify
416 the operation (i.e.@: the expression code) for the expression to be
417 made. It should be an RTL expression, whose expression code is copied
418 into a new expression whose operands are arguments 1 and 2 of the
419 gen-function. The subexpressions of argument 3 are not used;
420 only its expression code matters.
421
422 When @code{match_operator} is used in a pattern for matching an insn,
423 it usually best if the operand number of the @code{match_operator}
424 is higher than that of the actual operands of the insn. This improves
425 register allocation because the register allocator often looks at
426 operands 1 and 2 of insns to see if it can do register tying.
427
428 There is no way to specify constraints in @code{match_operator}. The
429 operand of the insn which corresponds to the @code{match_operator}
430 never has any constraints because it is never reloaded as a whole.
431 However, if parts of its @var{operands} are matched by
432 @code{match_operand} patterns, those parts may have constraints of
433 their own.
434
435 @findex match_op_dup
436 @item (match_op_dup:@var{m} @var{n}[@var{operands}@dots{}])
437 Like @code{match_dup}, except that it applies to operators instead of
438 operands. When constructing an insn, operand number @var{n} will be
439 substituted at this point. But in matching, @code{match_op_dup} behaves
440 differently. It assumes that operand number @var{n} has already been
441 determined by a @code{match_operator} appearing earlier in the
442 recognition template, and it matches only an identical-looking
443 expression.
444
445 @findex match_parallel
446 @item (match_parallel @var{n} @var{predicate} [@var{subpat}@dots{}])
447 This pattern is a placeholder for an insn that consists of a
448 @code{parallel} expression with a variable number of elements. This
449 expression should only appear at the top level of an insn pattern.
450
451 When constructing an insn, operand number @var{n} will be substituted at
452 this point. When matching an insn, it matches if the body of the insn
453 is a @code{parallel} expression with at least as many elements as the
454 vector of @var{subpat} expressions in the @code{match_parallel}, if each
455 @var{subpat} matches the corresponding element of the @code{parallel},
456 @emph{and} the function @var{predicate} returns nonzero on the
457 @code{parallel} that is the body of the insn. It is the responsibility
458 of the predicate to validate elements of the @code{parallel} beyond
459 those listed in the @code{match_parallel}.
460
461 A typical use of @code{match_parallel} is to match load and store
462 multiple expressions, which can contain a variable number of elements
463 in a @code{parallel}. For example,
464
465 @smallexample
466 (define_insn ""
467 [(match_parallel 0 "load_multiple_operation"
468 [(set (match_operand:SI 1 "gpc_reg_operand" "=r")
469 (match_operand:SI 2 "memory_operand" "m"))
470 (use (reg:SI 179))
471 (clobber (reg:SI 179))])]
472 ""
473 "loadm 0,0,%1,%2")
474 @end smallexample
475
476 This example comes from @file{a29k.md}. The function
477 @code{load_multiple_operation} is defined in @file{a29k.c} and checks
478 that subsequent elements in the @code{parallel} are the same as the
479 @code{set} in the pattern, except that they are referencing subsequent
480 registers and memory locations.
481
482 An insn that matches this pattern might look like:
483
484 @smallexample
485 (parallel
486 [(set (reg:SI 20) (mem:SI (reg:SI 100)))
487 (use (reg:SI 179))
488 (clobber (reg:SI 179))
489 (set (reg:SI 21)
490 (mem:SI (plus:SI (reg:SI 100)
491 (const_int 4))))
492 (set (reg:SI 22)
493 (mem:SI (plus:SI (reg:SI 100)
494 (const_int 8))))])
495 @end smallexample
496
497 @findex match_par_dup
498 @item (match_par_dup @var{n} [@var{subpat}@dots{}])
499 Like @code{match_op_dup}, but for @code{match_parallel} instead of
500 @code{match_operator}.
501
502 @end table
503
504 @node Output Template
505 @section Output Templates and Operand Substitution
506 @cindex output templates
507 @cindex operand substitution
508
509 @cindex @samp{%} in template
510 @cindex percent sign
511 The @dfn{output template} is a string which specifies how to output the
512 assembler code for an instruction pattern. Most of the template is a
513 fixed string which is output literally. The character @samp{%} is used
514 to specify where to substitute an operand; it can also be used to
515 identify places where different variants of the assembler require
516 different syntax.
517
518 In the simplest case, a @samp{%} followed by a digit @var{n} says to output
519 operand @var{n} at that point in the string.
520
521 @samp{%} followed by a letter and a digit says to output an operand in an
522 alternate fashion. Four letters have standard, built-in meanings described
523 below. The machine description macro @code{PRINT_OPERAND} can define
524 additional letters with nonstandard meanings.
525
526 @samp{%c@var{digit}} can be used to substitute an operand that is a
527 constant value without the syntax that normally indicates an immediate
528 operand.
529
530 @samp{%n@var{digit}} is like @samp{%c@var{digit}} except that the value of
531 the constant is negated before printing.
532
533 @samp{%a@var{digit}} can be used to substitute an operand as if it were a
534 memory reference, with the actual operand treated as the address. This may
535 be useful when outputting a ``load address'' instruction, because often the
536 assembler syntax for such an instruction requires you to write the operand
537 as if it were a memory reference.
538
539 @samp{%l@var{digit}} is used to substitute a @code{label_ref} into a jump
540 instruction.
541
542 @samp{%=} outputs a number which is unique to each instruction in the
543 entire compilation. This is useful for making local labels to be
544 referred to more than once in a single template that generates multiple
545 assembler instructions.
546
547 @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character specifies a substitution that
548 does not use an operand. Only one case is standard: @samp{%%} outputs a
549 @samp{%} into the assembler code. Other nonstandard cases can be
550 defined in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. You must also define
551 which punctuation characters are valid with the
552 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} macro.
553
554 @cindex \
555 @cindex backslash
556 The template may generate multiple assembler instructions. Write the text
557 for the instructions, with @samp{\;} between them.
558
559 @cindex matching operands
560 When the RTL contains two operands which are required by constraint to match
561 each other, the output template must refer only to the lower-numbered operand.
562 Matching operands are not always identical, and the rest of the compiler
563 arranges to put the proper RTL expression for printing into the lower-numbered
564 operand.
565
566 One use of nonstandard letters or punctuation following @samp{%} is to
567 distinguish between different assembler languages for the same machine; for
568 example, Motorola syntax versus MIT syntax for the 68000. Motorola syntax
569 requires periods in most opcode names, while MIT syntax does not. For
570 example, the opcode @samp{movel} in MIT syntax is @samp{move.l} in Motorola
571 syntax. The same file of patterns is used for both kinds of output syntax,
572 but the character sequence @samp{%.} is used in each place where Motorola
573 syntax wants a period. The @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro for Motorola syntax
574 defines the sequence to output a period; the macro for MIT syntax defines
575 it to do nothing.
576
577 @cindex @code{#} in template
578 As a special case, a template consisting of the single character @code{#}
579 instructs the compiler to first split the insn, and then output the
580 resulting instructions separately. This helps eliminate redundancy in the
581 output templates. If you have a @code{define_insn} that needs to emit
582 multiple assembler instructions, and there is a matching @code{define_split}
583 already defined, then you can simply use @code{#} as the output template
584 instead of writing an output template that emits the multiple assembler
585 instructions.
586
587 Note that @code{#} only has an effect while generating assembly code;
588 it does not affect whether a split occurs earlier. An associated
589 @code{define_split} must exist and it must be suitable for use after
590 register allocation.
591
592 If the macro @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is defined, you can use construct
593 of the form @samp{@{option0|option1|option2@}} in the templates. These
594 describe multiple variants of assembler language syntax.
595 @xref{Instruction Output}.
596
597 @node Output Statement
598 @section C Statements for Assembler Output
599 @cindex output statements
600 @cindex C statements for assembler output
601 @cindex generating assembler output
602
603 Often a single fixed template string cannot produce correct and efficient
604 assembler code for all the cases that are recognized by a single
605 instruction pattern. For example, the opcodes may depend on the kinds of
606 operands; or some unfortunate combinations of operands may require extra
607 machine instructions.
608
609 If the output control string starts with a @samp{@@}, then it is actually
610 a series of templates, each on a separate line. (Blank lines and
611 leading spaces and tabs are ignored.) The templates correspond to the
612 pattern's constraint alternatives (@pxref{Multi-Alternative}). For example,
613 if a target machine has a two-address add instruction @samp{addr} to add
614 into a register and another @samp{addm} to add a register to memory, you
615 might write this pattern:
616
617 @smallexample
618 (define_insn "addsi3"
619 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=r,m")
620 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "general_operand" "0,0")
621 (match_operand:SI 2 "general_operand" "g,r")))]
622 ""
623 "@@
624 addr %2,%0
625 addm %2,%0")
626 @end smallexample
627
628 @cindex @code{*} in template
629 @cindex asterisk in template
630 If the output control string starts with a @samp{*}, then it is not an
631 output template but rather a piece of C program that should compute a
632 template. It should execute a @code{return} statement to return the
633 template-string you want. Most such templates use C string literals, which
634 require doublequote characters to delimit them. To include these
635 doublequote characters in the string, prefix each one with @samp{\}.
636
637 If the output control string is written as a brace block instead of a
638 double-quoted string, it is automatically assumed to be C code. In that
639 case, it is not necessary to put in a leading asterisk, or to escape the
640 doublequotes surrounding C string literals.
641
642 The operands may be found in the array @code{operands}, whose C data type
643 is @code{rtx []}.
644
645 It is very common to select different ways of generating assembler code
646 based on whether an immediate operand is within a certain range. Be
647 careful when doing this, because the result of @code{INTVAL} is an
648 integer on the host machine. If the host machine has more bits in an
649 @code{int} than the target machine has in the mode in which the constant
650 will be used, then some of the bits you get from @code{INTVAL} will be
651 superfluous. For proper results, you must carefully disregard the
652 values of those bits.
653
654 @findex output_asm_insn
655 It is possible to output an assembler instruction and then go on to output
656 or compute more of them, using the subroutine @code{output_asm_insn}. This
657 receives two arguments: a template-string and a vector of operands. The
658 vector may be @code{operands}, or it may be another array of @code{rtx}
659 that you declare locally and initialize yourself.
660
661 @findex which_alternative
662 When an insn pattern has multiple alternatives in its constraints, often
663 the appearance of the assembler code is determined mostly by which alternative
664 was matched. When this is so, the C code can test the variable
665 @code{which_alternative}, which is the ordinal number of the alternative
666 that was actually satisfied (0 for the first, 1 for the second alternative,
667 etc.).
668
669 For example, suppose there are two opcodes for storing zero, @samp{clrreg}
670 for registers and @samp{clrmem} for memory locations. Here is how
671 a pattern could use @code{which_alternative} to choose between them:
672
673 @smallexample
674 (define_insn ""
675 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=r,m")
676 (const_int 0))]
677 ""
678 @{
679 return (which_alternative == 0
680 ? "clrreg %0" : "clrmem %0");
681 @})
682 @end smallexample
683
684 The example above, where the assembler code to generate was
685 @emph{solely} determined by the alternative, could also have been specified
686 as follows, having the output control string start with a @samp{@@}:
687
688 @smallexample
689 @group
690 (define_insn ""
691 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=r,m")
692 (const_int 0))]
693 ""
694 "@@
695 clrreg %0
696 clrmem %0")
697 @end group
698 @end smallexample
699
700 If you just need a little bit of C code in one (or a few) alternatives,
701 you can use @samp{*} inside of a @samp{@@} multi-alternative template:
702
703 @smallexample
704 @group
705 (define_insn ""
706 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=r,<,m")
707 (const_int 0))]
708 ""
709 "@@
710 clrreg %0
711 * return stack_mem_p (operands[0]) ? \"push 0\" : \"clrmem %0\";
712 clrmem %0")
713 @end group
714 @end smallexample
715
716 @node Predicates
717 @section Predicates
718 @cindex predicates
719 @cindex operand predicates
720 @cindex operator predicates
721
722 A predicate determines whether a @code{match_operand} or
723 @code{match_operator} expression matches, and therefore whether the
724 surrounding instruction pattern will be used for that combination of
725 operands. GCC has a number of machine-independent predicates, and you
726 can define machine-specific predicates as needed. By convention,
727 predicates used with @code{match_operand} have names that end in
728 @samp{_operand}, and those used with @code{match_operator} have names
729 that end in @samp{_operator}.
730
731 All predicates are boolean functions (in the mathematical sense) of
732 two arguments: the RTL expression that is being considered at that
733 position in the instruction pattern, and the machine mode that the
734 @code{match_operand} or @code{match_operator} specifies. In this
735 section, the first argument is called @var{op} and the second argument
736 @var{mode}. Predicates can be called from C as ordinary two-argument
737 functions; this can be useful in output templates or other
738 machine-specific code.
739
740 Operand predicates can allow operands that are not actually acceptable
741 to the hardware, as long as the constraints give reload the ability to
742 fix them up (@pxref{Constraints}). However, GCC will usually generate
743 better code if the predicates specify the requirements of the machine
744 instructions as closely as possible. Reload cannot fix up operands
745 that must be constants (``immediate operands''); you must use a
746 predicate that allows only constants, or else enforce the requirement
747 in the extra condition.
748
749 @cindex predicates and machine modes
750 @cindex normal predicates
751 @cindex special predicates
752 Most predicates handle their @var{mode} argument in a uniform manner.
753 If @var{mode} is @code{VOIDmode} (unspecified), then @var{op} can have
754 any mode. If @var{mode} is anything else, then @var{op} must have the
755 same mode, unless @var{op} is a @code{CONST_INT} or integer
756 @code{CONST_DOUBLE}. These RTL expressions always have
757 @code{VOIDmode}, so it would be counterproductive to check that their
758 mode matches. Instead, predicates that accept @code{CONST_INT} and/or
759 integer @code{CONST_DOUBLE} check that the value stored in the
760 constant will fit in the requested mode.
761
762 Predicates with this behavior are called @dfn{normal}.
763 @command{genrecog} can optimize the instruction recognizer based on
764 knowledge of how normal predicates treat modes. It can also diagnose
765 certain kinds of common errors in the use of normal predicates; for
766 instance, it is almost always an error to use a normal predicate
767 without specifying a mode.
768
769 Predicates that do something different with their @var{mode} argument
770 are called @dfn{special}. The generic predicates
771 @code{address_operand} and @code{pmode_register_operand} are special
772 predicates. @command{genrecog} does not do any optimizations or
773 diagnosis when special predicates are used.
774
775 @menu
776 * Machine-Independent Predicates:: Predicates available to all back ends.
777 * Defining Predicates:: How to write machine-specific predicate
778 functions.
779 @end menu
780
781 @node Machine-Independent Predicates
782 @subsection Machine-Independent Predicates
783 @cindex machine-independent predicates
784 @cindex generic predicates
785
786 These are the generic predicates available to all back ends. They are
787 defined in @file{recog.c}. The first category of predicates allow
788 only constant, or @dfn{immediate}, operands.
789
790 @defun immediate_operand
791 This predicate allows any sort of constant that fits in @var{mode}.
792 It is an appropriate choice for instructions that take operands that
793 must be constant.
794 @end defun
795
796 @defun const_int_operand
797 This predicate allows any @code{CONST_INT} expression that fits in
798 @var{mode}. It is an appropriate choice for an immediate operand that
799 does not allow a symbol or label.
800 @end defun
801
802 @defun const_double_operand
803 This predicate accepts any @code{CONST_DOUBLE} expression that has
804 exactly @var{mode}. If @var{mode} is @code{VOIDmode}, it will also
805 accept @code{CONST_INT}. It is intended for immediate floating point
806 constants.
807 @end defun
808
809 @noindent
810 The second category of predicates allow only some kind of machine
811 register.
812
813 @defun register_operand
814 This predicate allows any @code{REG} or @code{SUBREG} expression that
815 is valid for @var{mode}. It is often suitable for arithmetic
816 instruction operands on a RISC machine.
817 @end defun
818
819 @defun pmode_register_operand
820 This is a slight variant on @code{register_operand} which works around
821 a limitation in the machine-description reader.
822
823 @smallexample
824 (match_operand @var{n} "pmode_register_operand" @var{constraint})
825 @end smallexample
826
827 @noindent
828 means exactly what
829
830 @smallexample
831 (match_operand:P @var{n} "register_operand" @var{constraint})
832 @end smallexample
833
834 @noindent
835 would mean, if the machine-description reader accepted @samp{:P}
836 mode suffixes. Unfortunately, it cannot, because @code{Pmode} is an
837 alias for some other mode, and might vary with machine-specific
838 options. @xref{Misc}.
839 @end defun
840
841 @defun scratch_operand
842 This predicate allows hard registers and @code{SCRATCH} expressions,
843 but not pseudo-registers. It is used internally by @code{match_scratch};
844 it should not be used directly.
845 @end defun
846
847 @noindent
848 The third category of predicates allow only some kind of memory reference.
849
850 @defun memory_operand
851 This predicate allows any valid reference to a quantity of mode
852 @var{mode} in memory, as determined by the weak form of
853 @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} (@pxref{Addressing Modes}).
854 @end defun
855
856 @defun address_operand
857 This predicate is a little unusual; it allows any operand that is a
858 valid expression for the @emph{address} of a quantity of mode
859 @var{mode}, again determined by the weak form of
860 @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}. To first order, if
861 @samp{@w{(mem:@var{mode} (@var{exp}))}} is acceptable to
862 @code{memory_operand}, then @var{exp} is acceptable to
863 @code{address_operand}. Note that @var{exp} does not necessarily have
864 the mode @var{mode}.
865 @end defun
866
867 @defun indirect_operand
868 This is a stricter form of @code{memory_operand} which allows only
869 memory references with a @code{general_operand} as the address
870 expression. New uses of this predicate are discouraged, because
871 @code{general_operand} is very permissive, so it's hard to tell what
872 an @code{indirect_operand} does or does not allow. If a target has
873 different requirements for memory operands for different instructions,
874 it is better to define target-specific predicates which enforce the
875 hardware's requirements explicitly.
876 @end defun
877
878 @defun push_operand
879 This predicate allows a memory reference suitable for pushing a value
880 onto the stack. This will be a @code{MEM} which refers to
881 @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, with a side effect in its address expression
882 (@pxref{Incdec}); which one is determined by the
883 @code{STACK_PUSH_CODE} macro (@pxref{Frame Layout}).
884 @end defun
885
886 @defun pop_operand
887 This predicate allows a memory reference suitable for popping a value
888 off the stack. Again, this will be a @code{MEM} referring to
889 @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, with a side effect in its address
890 expression. However, this time @code{STACK_POP_CODE} is expected.
891 @end defun
892
893 @noindent
894 The fourth category of predicates allow some combination of the above
895 operands.
896
897 @defun nonmemory_operand
898 This predicate allows any immediate or register operand valid for @var{mode}.
899 @end defun
900
901 @defun nonimmediate_operand
902 This predicate allows any register or memory operand valid for @var{mode}.
903 @end defun
904
905 @defun general_operand
906 This predicate allows any immediate, register, or memory operand
907 valid for @var{mode}.
908 @end defun
909
910 @noindent
911 Finally, there are two generic operator predicates.
912
913 @defun comparison_operator
914 This predicate matches any expression which performs an arithmetic
915 comparison in @var{mode}; that is, @code{COMPARISON_P} is true for the
916 expression code.
917 @end defun
918
919 @defun ordered_comparison_operator
920 This predicate matches any expression which performs an arithmetic
921 comparison in @var{mode} and whose expression code is valid for integer
922 modes; that is, the expression code will be one of @code{eq}, @code{ne},
923 @code{lt}, @code{ltu}, @code{le}, @code{leu}, @code{gt}, @code{gtu},
924 @code{ge}, @code{geu}.
925 @end defun
926
927 @node Defining Predicates
928 @subsection Defining Machine-Specific Predicates
929 @cindex defining predicates
930 @findex define_predicate
931 @findex define_special_predicate
932
933 Many machines have requirements for their operands that cannot be
934 expressed precisely using the generic predicates. You can define
935 additional predicates using @code{define_predicate} and
936 @code{define_special_predicate} expressions. These expressions have
937 three operands:
938
939 @itemize @bullet
940 @item
941 The name of the predicate, as it will be referred to in
942 @code{match_operand} or @code{match_operator} expressions.
943
944 @item
945 An RTL expression which evaluates to true if the predicate allows the
946 operand @var{op}, false if it does not. This expression can only use
947 the following RTL codes:
948
949 @table @code
950 @item MATCH_OPERAND
951 When written inside a predicate expression, a @code{MATCH_OPERAND}
952 expression evaluates to true if the predicate it names would allow
953 @var{op}. The operand number and constraint are ignored. Due to
954 limitations in @command{genrecog}, you can only refer to generic
955 predicates and predicates that have already been defined.
956
957 @item MATCH_CODE
958 This expression evaluates to true if @var{op} or a specified
959 subexpression of @var{op} has one of a given list of RTX codes.
960
961 The first operand of this expression is a string constant containing a
962 comma-separated list of RTX code names (in lower case). These are the
963 codes for which the @code{MATCH_CODE} will be true.
964
965 The second operand is a string constant which indicates what
966 subexpression of @var{op} to examine. If it is absent or the empty
967 string, @var{op} itself is examined. Otherwise, the string constant
968 must be a sequence of digits and/or lowercase letters. Each character
969 indicates a subexpression to extract from the current expression; for
970 the first character this is @var{op}, for the second and subsequent
971 characters it is the result of the previous character. A digit
972 @var{n} extracts @samp{@w{XEXP (@var{e}, @var{n})}}; a letter @var{l}
973 extracts @samp{@w{XVECEXP (@var{e}, 0, @var{n})}} where @var{n} is the
974 alphabetic ordinal of @var{l} (0 for `a', 1 for 'b', and so on). The
975 @code{MATCH_CODE} then examines the RTX code of the subexpression
976 extracted by the complete string. It is not possible to extract
977 components of an @code{rtvec} that is not at position 0 within its RTX
978 object.
979
980 @item MATCH_TEST
981 This expression has one operand, a string constant containing a C
982 expression. The predicate's arguments, @var{op} and @var{mode}, are
983 available with those names in the C expression. The @code{MATCH_TEST}
984 evaluates to true if the C expression evaluates to a nonzero value.
985 @code{MATCH_TEST} expressions must not have side effects.
986
987 @item AND
988 @itemx IOR
989 @itemx NOT
990 @itemx IF_THEN_ELSE
991 The basic @samp{MATCH_} expressions can be combined using these
992 logical operators, which have the semantics of the C operators
993 @samp{&&}, @samp{||}, @samp{!}, and @samp{@w{? :}} respectively. As
994 in Common Lisp, you may give an @code{AND} or @code{IOR} expression an
995 arbitrary number of arguments; this has exactly the same effect as
996 writing a chain of two-argument @code{AND} or @code{IOR} expressions.
997 @end table
998
999 @item
1000 An optional block of C code, which should execute
1001 @samp{@w{return true}} if the predicate is found to match and
1002 @samp{@w{return false}} if it does not. It must not have any side
1003 effects. The predicate arguments, @var{op} and @var{mode}, are
1004 available with those names.
1005
1006 If a code block is present in a predicate definition, then the RTL
1007 expression must evaluate to true @emph{and} the code block must
1008 execute @samp{@w{return true}} for the predicate to allow the operand.
1009 The RTL expression is evaluated first; do not re-check anything in the
1010 code block that was checked in the RTL expression.
1011 @end itemize
1012
1013 The program @command{genrecog} scans @code{define_predicate} and
1014 @code{define_special_predicate} expressions to determine which RTX
1015 codes are possibly allowed. You should always make this explicit in
1016 the RTL predicate expression, using @code{MATCH_OPERAND} and
1017 @code{MATCH_CODE}.
1018
1019 Here is an example of a simple predicate definition, from the IA64
1020 machine description:
1021
1022 @smallexample
1023 @group
1024 ;; @r{True if @var{op} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} which refers to the sdata section.}
1025 (define_predicate "small_addr_symbolic_operand"
1026 (and (match_code "symbol_ref")
1027 (match_test "SYMBOL_REF_SMALL_ADDR_P (op)")))
1028 @end group
1029 @end smallexample
1030
1031 @noindent
1032 And here is another, showing the use of the C block.
1033
1034 @smallexample
1035 @group
1036 ;; @r{True if @var{op} is a register operand that is (or could be) a GR reg.}
1037 (define_predicate "gr_register_operand"
1038 (match_operand 0 "register_operand")
1039 @{
1040 unsigned int regno;
1041 if (GET_CODE (op) == SUBREG)
1042 op = SUBREG_REG (op);
1043
1044 regno = REGNO (op);
1045 return (regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER || GENERAL_REGNO_P (regno));
1046 @})
1047 @end group
1048 @end smallexample
1049
1050 Predicates written with @code{define_predicate} automatically include
1051 a test that @var{mode} is @code{VOIDmode}, or @var{op} has the same
1052 mode as @var{mode}, or @var{op} is a @code{CONST_INT} or
1053 @code{CONST_DOUBLE}. They do @emph{not} check specifically for
1054 integer @code{CONST_DOUBLE}, nor do they test that the value of either
1055 kind of constant fits in the requested mode. This is because
1056 target-specific predicates that take constants usually have to do more
1057 stringent value checks anyway. If you need the exact same treatment
1058 of @code{CONST_INT} or @code{CONST_DOUBLE} that the generic predicates
1059 provide, use a @code{MATCH_OPERAND} subexpression to call
1060 @code{const_int_operand}, @code{const_double_operand}, or
1061 @code{immediate_operand}.
1062
1063 Predicates written with @code{define_special_predicate} do not get any
1064 automatic mode checks, and are treated as having special mode handling
1065 by @command{genrecog}.
1066
1067 The program @command{genpreds} is responsible for generating code to
1068 test predicates. It also writes a header file containing function
1069 declarations for all machine-specific predicates. It is not necessary
1070 to declare these predicates in @file{@var{cpu}-protos.h}.
1071 @end ifset
1072
1073 @c Most of this node appears by itself (in a different place) even
1074 @c when the INTERNALS flag is clear. Passages that require the internals
1075 @c manual's context are conditionalized to appear only in the internals manual.
1076 @ifset INTERNALS
1077 @node Constraints
1078 @section Operand Constraints
1079 @cindex operand constraints
1080 @cindex constraints
1081
1082 Each @code{match_operand} in an instruction pattern can specify
1083 constraints for the operands allowed. The constraints allow you to
1084 fine-tune matching within the set of operands allowed by the
1085 predicate.
1086
1087 @end ifset
1088 @ifclear INTERNALS
1089 @node Constraints
1090 @section Constraints for @code{asm} Operands
1091 @cindex operand constraints, @code{asm}
1092 @cindex constraints, @code{asm}
1093 @cindex @code{asm} constraints
1094
1095 Here are specific details on what constraint letters you can use with
1096 @code{asm} operands.
1097 @end ifclear
1098 Constraints can say whether
1099 an operand may be in a register, and which kinds of register; whether the
1100 operand can be a memory reference, and which kinds of address; whether the
1101 operand may be an immediate constant, and which possible values it may
1102 have. Constraints can also require two operands to match.
1103 Side-effects aren't allowed in operands of inline @code{asm}, unless
1104 @samp{<} or @samp{>} constraints are used, because there is no guarantee
1105 that the side effects will happen exactly once in an instruction that can update
1106 the addressing register.
1107
1108 @ifset INTERNALS
1109 @menu
1110 * Simple Constraints:: Basic use of constraints.
1111 * Multi-Alternative:: When an insn has two alternative constraint-patterns.
1112 * Class Preferences:: Constraints guide which hard register to put things in.
1113 * Modifiers:: More precise control over effects of constraints.
1114 * Machine Constraints:: Existing constraints for some particular machines.
1115 * Disable Insn Alternatives:: Disable insn alternatives using attributes.
1116 * Define Constraints:: How to define machine-specific constraints.
1117 * C Constraint Interface:: How to test constraints from C code.
1118 @end menu
1119 @end ifset
1120
1121 @ifclear INTERNALS
1122 @menu
1123 * Simple Constraints:: Basic use of constraints.
1124 * Multi-Alternative:: When an insn has two alternative constraint-patterns.
1125 * Modifiers:: More precise control over effects of constraints.
1126 * Machine Constraints:: Special constraints for some particular machines.
1127 @end menu
1128 @end ifclear
1129
1130 @node Simple Constraints
1131 @subsection Simple Constraints
1132 @cindex simple constraints
1133
1134 The simplest kind of constraint is a string full of letters, each of
1135 which describes one kind of operand that is permitted. Here are
1136 the letters that are allowed:
1137
1138 @table @asis
1139 @item whitespace
1140 Whitespace characters are ignored and can be inserted at any position
1141 except the first. This enables each alternative for different operands to
1142 be visually aligned in the machine description even if they have different
1143 number of constraints and modifiers.
1144
1145 @cindex @samp{m} in constraint
1146 @cindex memory references in constraints
1147 @item @samp{m}
1148 A memory operand is allowed, with any kind of address that the machine
1149 supports in general.
1150 Note that the letter used for the general memory constraint can be
1151 re-defined by a back end using the @code{TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT} macro.
1152
1153 @cindex offsettable address
1154 @cindex @samp{o} in constraint
1155 @item @samp{o}
1156 A memory operand is allowed, but only if the address is
1157 @dfn{offsettable}. This means that adding a small integer (actually,
1158 the width in bytes of the operand, as determined by its machine mode)
1159 may be added to the address and the result is also a valid memory
1160 address.
1161
1162 @cindex autoincrement/decrement addressing
1163 For example, an address which is constant is offsettable; so is an
1164 address that is the sum of a register and a constant (as long as a
1165 slightly larger constant is also within the range of address-offsets
1166 supported by the machine); but an autoincrement or autodecrement
1167 address is not offsettable. More complicated indirect/indexed
1168 addresses may or may not be offsettable depending on the other
1169 addressing modes that the machine supports.
1170
1171 Note that in an output operand which can be matched by another
1172 operand, the constraint letter @samp{o} is valid only when accompanied
1173 by both @samp{<} (if the target machine has predecrement addressing)
1174 and @samp{>} (if the target machine has preincrement addressing).
1175
1176 @cindex @samp{V} in constraint
1177 @item @samp{V}
1178 A memory operand that is not offsettable. In other words, anything that
1179 would fit the @samp{m} constraint but not the @samp{o} constraint.
1180
1181 @cindex @samp{<} in constraint
1182 @item @samp{<}
1183 A memory operand with autodecrement addressing (either predecrement or
1184 postdecrement) is allowed. In inline @code{asm} this constraint is only
1185 allowed if the operand is used exactly once in an instruction that can
1186 handle the side effects. Not using an operand with @samp{<} in constraint
1187 string in the inline @code{asm} pattern at all or using it in multiple
1188 instructions isn't valid, because the side effects wouldn't be performed
1189 or would be performed more than once. Furthermore, on some targets
1190 the operand with @samp{<} in constraint string must be accompanied by
1191 special instruction suffixes like @code{%U0} instruction suffix on PowerPC
1192 or @code{%P0} on IA-64.
1193
1194 @cindex @samp{>} in constraint
1195 @item @samp{>}
1196 A memory operand with autoincrement addressing (either preincrement or
1197 postincrement) is allowed. In inline @code{asm} the same restrictions
1198 as for @samp{<} apply.
1199
1200 @cindex @samp{r} in constraint
1201 @cindex registers in constraints
1202 @item @samp{r}
1203 A register operand is allowed provided that it is in a general
1204 register.
1205
1206 @cindex constants in constraints
1207 @cindex @samp{i} in constraint
1208 @item @samp{i}
1209 An immediate integer operand (one with constant value) is allowed.
1210 This includes symbolic constants whose values will be known only at
1211 assembly time or later.
1212
1213 @cindex @samp{n} in constraint
1214 @item @samp{n}
1215 An immediate integer operand with a known numeric value is allowed.
1216 Many systems cannot support assembly-time constants for operands less
1217 than a word wide. Constraints for these operands should use @samp{n}
1218 rather than @samp{i}.
1219
1220 @cindex @samp{I} in constraint
1221 @item @samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}
1222 Other letters in the range @samp{I} through @samp{P} may be defined in
1223 a machine-dependent fashion to permit immediate integer operands with
1224 explicit integer values in specified ranges. For example, on the
1225 68000, @samp{I} is defined to stand for the range of values 1 to 8.
1226 This is the range permitted as a shift count in the shift
1227 instructions.
1228
1229 @cindex @samp{E} in constraint
1230 @item @samp{E}
1231 An immediate floating operand (expression code @code{const_double}) is
1232 allowed, but only if the target floating point format is the same as
1233 that of the host machine (on which the compiler is running).
1234
1235 @cindex @samp{F} in constraint
1236 @item @samp{F}
1237 An immediate floating operand (expression code @code{const_double} or
1238 @code{const_vector}) is allowed.
1239
1240 @cindex @samp{G} in constraint
1241 @cindex @samp{H} in constraint
1242 @item @samp{G}, @samp{H}
1243 @samp{G} and @samp{H} may be defined in a machine-dependent fashion to
1244 permit immediate floating operands in particular ranges of values.
1245
1246 @cindex @samp{s} in constraint
1247 @item @samp{s}
1248 An immediate integer operand whose value is not an explicit integer is
1249 allowed.
1250
1251 This might appear strange; if an insn allows a constant operand with a
1252 value not known at compile time, it certainly must allow any known
1253 value. So why use @samp{s} instead of @samp{i}? Sometimes it allows
1254 better code to be generated.
1255
1256 For example, on the 68000 in a fullword instruction it is possible to
1257 use an immediate operand; but if the immediate value is between @minus{}128
1258 and 127, better code results from loading the value into a register and
1259 using the register. This is because the load into the register can be
1260 done with a @samp{moveq} instruction. We arrange for this to happen
1261 by defining the letter @samp{K} to mean ``any integer outside the
1262 range @minus{}128 to 127'', and then specifying @samp{Ks} in the operand
1263 constraints.
1264
1265 @cindex @samp{g} in constraint
1266 @item @samp{g}
1267 Any register, memory or immediate integer operand is allowed, except for
1268 registers that are not general registers.
1269
1270 @cindex @samp{X} in constraint
1271 @item @samp{X}
1272 @ifset INTERNALS
1273 Any operand whatsoever is allowed, even if it does not satisfy
1274 @code{general_operand}. This is normally used in the constraint of
1275 a @code{match_scratch} when certain alternatives will not actually
1276 require a scratch register.
1277 @end ifset
1278 @ifclear INTERNALS
1279 Any operand whatsoever is allowed.
1280 @end ifclear
1281
1282 @cindex @samp{0} in constraint
1283 @cindex digits in constraint
1284 @item @samp{0}, @samp{1}, @samp{2}, @dots{} @samp{9}
1285 An operand that matches the specified operand number is allowed. If a
1286 digit is used together with letters within the same alternative, the
1287 digit should come last.
1288
1289 This number is allowed to be more than a single digit. If multiple
1290 digits are encountered consecutively, they are interpreted as a single
1291 decimal integer. There is scant chance for ambiguity, since to-date
1292 it has never been desirable that @samp{10} be interpreted as matching
1293 either operand 1 @emph{or} operand 0. Should this be desired, one
1294 can use multiple alternatives instead.
1295
1296 @cindex matching constraint
1297 @cindex constraint, matching
1298 This is called a @dfn{matching constraint} and what it really means is
1299 that the assembler has only a single operand that fills two roles
1300 @ifset INTERNALS
1301 considered separate in the RTL insn. For example, an add insn has two
1302 input operands and one output operand in the RTL, but on most CISC
1303 @end ifset
1304 @ifclear INTERNALS
1305 which @code{asm} distinguishes. For example, an add instruction uses
1306 two input operands and an output operand, but on most CISC
1307 @end ifclear
1308 machines an add instruction really has only two operands, one of them an
1309 input-output operand:
1310
1311 @smallexample
1312 addl #35,r12
1313 @end smallexample
1314
1315 Matching constraints are used in these circumstances.
1316 More precisely, the two operands that match must include one input-only
1317 operand and one output-only operand. Moreover, the digit must be a
1318 smaller number than the number of the operand that uses it in the
1319 constraint.
1320
1321 @ifset INTERNALS
1322 For operands to match in a particular case usually means that they
1323 are identical-looking RTL expressions. But in a few special cases
1324 specific kinds of dissimilarity are allowed. For example, @code{*x}
1325 as an input operand will match @code{*x++} as an output operand.
1326 For proper results in such cases, the output template should always
1327 use the output-operand's number when printing the operand.
1328 @end ifset
1329
1330 @cindex load address instruction
1331 @cindex push address instruction
1332 @cindex address constraints
1333 @cindex @samp{p} in constraint
1334 @item @samp{p}
1335 An operand that is a valid memory address is allowed. This is
1336 for ``load address'' and ``push address'' instructions.
1337
1338 @findex address_operand
1339 @samp{p} in the constraint must be accompanied by @code{address_operand}
1340 as the predicate in the @code{match_operand}. This predicate interprets
1341 the mode specified in the @code{match_operand} as the mode of the memory
1342 reference for which the address would be valid.
1343
1344 @cindex other register constraints
1345 @cindex extensible constraints
1346 @item @var{other-letters}
1347 Other letters can be defined in machine-dependent fashion to stand for
1348 particular classes of registers or other arbitrary operand types.
1349 @samp{d}, @samp{a} and @samp{f} are defined on the 68000/68020 to stand
1350 for data, address and floating point registers.
1351 @end table
1352
1353 @ifset INTERNALS
1354 In order to have valid assembler code, each operand must satisfy
1355 its constraint. But a failure to do so does not prevent the pattern
1356 from applying to an insn. Instead, it directs the compiler to modify
1357 the code so that the constraint will be satisfied. Usually this is
1358 done by copying an operand into a register.
1359
1360 Contrast, therefore, the two instruction patterns that follow:
1361
1362 @smallexample
1363 (define_insn ""
1364 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=r")
1365 (plus:SI (match_dup 0)
1366 (match_operand:SI 1 "general_operand" "r")))]
1367 ""
1368 "@dots{}")
1369 @end smallexample
1370
1371 @noindent
1372 which has two operands, one of which must appear in two places, and
1373
1374 @smallexample
1375 (define_insn ""
1376 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=r")
1377 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "general_operand" "0")
1378 (match_operand:SI 2 "general_operand" "r")))]
1379 ""
1380 "@dots{}")
1381 @end smallexample
1382
1383 @noindent
1384 which has three operands, two of which are required by a constraint to be
1385 identical. If we are considering an insn of the form
1386
1387 @smallexample
1388 (insn @var{n} @var{prev} @var{next}
1389 (set (reg:SI 3)
1390 (plus:SI (reg:SI 6) (reg:SI 109)))
1391 @dots{})
1392 @end smallexample
1393
1394 @noindent
1395 the first pattern would not apply at all, because this insn does not
1396 contain two identical subexpressions in the right place. The pattern would
1397 say, ``That does not look like an add instruction; try other patterns''.
1398 The second pattern would say, ``Yes, that's an add instruction, but there
1399 is something wrong with it''. It would direct the reload pass of the
1400 compiler to generate additional insns to make the constraint true. The
1401 results might look like this:
1402
1403 @smallexample
1404 (insn @var{n2} @var{prev} @var{n}
1405 (set (reg:SI 3) (reg:SI 6))
1406 @dots{})
1407
1408 (insn @var{n} @var{n2} @var{next}
1409 (set (reg:SI 3)
1410 (plus:SI (reg:SI 3) (reg:SI 109)))
1411 @dots{})
1412 @end smallexample
1413
1414 It is up to you to make sure that each operand, in each pattern, has
1415 constraints that can handle any RTL expression that could be present for
1416 that operand. (When multiple alternatives are in use, each pattern must,
1417 for each possible combination of operand expressions, have at least one
1418 alternative which can handle that combination of operands.) The
1419 constraints don't need to @emph{allow} any possible operand---when this is
1420 the case, they do not constrain---but they must at least point the way to
1421 reloading any possible operand so that it will fit.
1422
1423 @itemize @bullet
1424 @item
1425 If the constraint accepts whatever operands the predicate permits,
1426 there is no problem: reloading is never necessary for this operand.
1427
1428 For example, an operand whose constraints permit everything except
1429 registers is safe provided its predicate rejects registers.
1430
1431 An operand whose predicate accepts only constant values is safe
1432 provided its constraints include the letter @samp{i}. If any possible
1433 constant value is accepted, then nothing less than @samp{i} will do;
1434 if the predicate is more selective, then the constraints may also be
1435 more selective.
1436
1437 @item
1438 Any operand expression can be reloaded by copying it into a register.
1439 So if an operand's constraints allow some kind of register, it is
1440 certain to be safe. It need not permit all classes of registers; the
1441 compiler knows how to copy a register into another register of the
1442 proper class in order to make an instruction valid.
1443
1444 @cindex nonoffsettable memory reference
1445 @cindex memory reference, nonoffsettable
1446 @item
1447 A nonoffsettable memory reference can be reloaded by copying the
1448 address into a register. So if the constraint uses the letter
1449 @samp{o}, all memory references are taken care of.
1450
1451 @item
1452 A constant operand can be reloaded by allocating space in memory to
1453 hold it as preinitialized data. Then the memory reference can be used
1454 in place of the constant. So if the constraint uses the letters
1455 @samp{o} or @samp{m}, constant operands are not a problem.
1456
1457 @item
1458 If the constraint permits a constant and a pseudo register used in an insn
1459 was not allocated to a hard register and is equivalent to a constant,
1460 the register will be replaced with the constant. If the predicate does
1461 not permit a constant and the insn is re-recognized for some reason, the
1462 compiler will crash. Thus the predicate must always recognize any
1463 objects allowed by the constraint.
1464 @end itemize
1465
1466 If the operand's predicate can recognize registers, but the constraint does
1467 not permit them, it can make the compiler crash. When this operand happens
1468 to be a register, the reload pass will be stymied, because it does not know
1469 how to copy a register temporarily into memory.
1470
1471 If the predicate accepts a unary operator, the constraint applies to the
1472 operand. For example, the MIPS processor at ISA level 3 supports an
1473 instruction which adds two registers in @code{SImode} to produce a
1474 @code{DImode} result, but only if the registers are correctly sign
1475 extended. This predicate for the input operands accepts a
1476 @code{sign_extend} of an @code{SImode} register. Write the constraint
1477 to indicate the type of register that is required for the operand of the
1478 @code{sign_extend}.
1479 @end ifset
1480
1481 @node Multi-Alternative
1482 @subsection Multiple Alternative Constraints
1483 @cindex multiple alternative constraints
1484
1485 Sometimes a single instruction has multiple alternative sets of possible
1486 operands. For example, on the 68000, a logical-or instruction can combine
1487 register or an immediate value into memory, or it can combine any kind of
1488 operand into a register; but it cannot combine one memory location into
1489 another.
1490
1491 These constraints are represented as multiple alternatives. An alternative
1492 can be described by a series of letters for each operand. The overall
1493 constraint for an operand is made from the letters for this operand
1494 from the first alternative, a comma, the letters for this operand from
1495 the second alternative, a comma, and so on until the last alternative.
1496 All operands for a single instruction must have the same number of
1497 alternatives.
1498 @ifset INTERNALS
1499 Here is how it is done for fullword logical-or on the 68000:
1500
1501 @smallexample
1502 (define_insn "iorsi3"
1503 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=m,d")
1504 (ior:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "general_operand" "%0,0")
1505 (match_operand:SI 2 "general_operand" "dKs,dmKs")))]
1506 @dots{})
1507 @end smallexample
1508
1509 The first alternative has @samp{m} (memory) for operand 0, @samp{0} for
1510 operand 1 (meaning it must match operand 0), and @samp{dKs} for operand
1511 2. The second alternative has @samp{d} (data register) for operand 0,
1512 @samp{0} for operand 1, and @samp{dmKs} for operand 2. The @samp{=} and
1513 @samp{%} in the constraints apply to all the alternatives; their
1514 meaning is explained in the next section (@pxref{Class Preferences}).
1515
1516 If all the operands fit any one alternative, the instruction is valid.
1517 Otherwise, for each alternative, the compiler counts how many instructions
1518 must be added to copy the operands so that that alternative applies.
1519 The alternative requiring the least copying is chosen. If two alternatives
1520 need the same amount of copying, the one that comes first is chosen.
1521 These choices can be altered with the @samp{?} and @samp{!} characters:
1522
1523 @table @code
1524 @cindex @samp{?} in constraint
1525 @cindex question mark
1526 @item ?
1527 Disparage slightly the alternative that the @samp{?} appears in,
1528 as a choice when no alternative applies exactly. The compiler regards
1529 this alternative as one unit more costly for each @samp{?} that appears
1530 in it.
1531
1532 @cindex @samp{!} in constraint
1533 @cindex exclamation point
1534 @item !
1535 Disparage severely the alternative that the @samp{!} appears in.
1536 This alternative can still be used if it fits without reloading,
1537 but if reloading is needed, some other alternative will be used.
1538
1539 @cindex @samp{^} in constraint
1540 @cindex caret
1541 @item ^
1542 This constraint is analogous to @samp{?} but it disparages slightly
1543 the alternative only if the operand with the @samp{^} needs a reload.
1544
1545 @cindex @samp{$} in constraint
1546 @cindex dollar sign
1547 @item $
1548 This constraint is analogous to @samp{!} but it disparages severely
1549 the alternative only if the operand with the @samp{$} needs a reload.
1550 @end table
1551
1552 When an insn pattern has multiple alternatives in its constraints, often
1553 the appearance of the assembler code is determined mostly by which
1554 alternative was matched. When this is so, the C code for writing the
1555 assembler code can use the variable @code{which_alternative}, which is
1556 the ordinal number of the alternative that was actually satisfied (0 for
1557 the first, 1 for the second alternative, etc.). @xref{Output Statement}.
1558 @end ifset
1559 @ifclear INTERNALS
1560
1561 So the first alternative for the 68000's logical-or could be written as
1562 @code{"+m" (output) : "ir" (input)}. The second could be @code{"+r"
1563 (output): "irm" (input)}. However, the fact that two memory locations
1564 cannot be used in a single instruction prevents simply using @code{"+rm"
1565 (output) : "irm" (input)}. Using multi-alternatives, this might be
1566 written as @code{"+m,r" (output) : "ir,irm" (input)}. This describes
1567 all the available alternatives to the compiler, allowing it to choose
1568 the most efficient one for the current conditions.
1569
1570 There is no way within the template to determine which alternative was
1571 chosen. However you may be able to wrap your @code{asm} statements with
1572 builtins such as @code{__builtin_constant_p} to achieve the desired results.
1573 @end ifclear
1574
1575 @ifset INTERNALS
1576 @node Class Preferences
1577 @subsection Register Class Preferences
1578 @cindex class preference constraints
1579 @cindex register class preference constraints
1580
1581 @cindex voting between constraint alternatives
1582 The operand constraints have another function: they enable the compiler
1583 to decide which kind of hardware register a pseudo register is best
1584 allocated to. The compiler examines the constraints that apply to the
1585 insns that use the pseudo register, looking for the machine-dependent
1586 letters such as @samp{d} and @samp{a} that specify classes of registers.
1587 The pseudo register is put in whichever class gets the most ``votes''.
1588 The constraint letters @samp{g} and @samp{r} also vote: they vote in
1589 favor of a general register. The machine description says which registers
1590 are considered general.
1591
1592 Of course, on some machines all registers are equivalent, and no register
1593 classes are defined. Then none of this complexity is relevant.
1594 @end ifset
1595
1596 @node Modifiers
1597 @subsection Constraint Modifier Characters
1598 @cindex modifiers in constraints
1599 @cindex constraint modifier characters
1600
1601 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1602 Here are constraint modifier characters.
1603
1604 @table @samp
1605 @cindex @samp{=} in constraint
1606 @item =
1607 Means that this operand is written to by this instruction:
1608 the previous value is discarded and replaced by new data.
1609
1610 @cindex @samp{+} in constraint
1611 @item +
1612 Means that this operand is both read and written by the instruction.
1613
1614 When the compiler fixes up the operands to satisfy the constraints,
1615 it needs to know which operands are read by the instruction and
1616 which are written by it. @samp{=} identifies an operand which is only
1617 written; @samp{+} identifies an operand that is both read and written; all
1618 other operands are assumed to only be read.
1619
1620 If you specify @samp{=} or @samp{+} in a constraint, you put it in the
1621 first character of the constraint string.
1622
1623 @cindex @samp{&} in constraint
1624 @cindex earlyclobber operand
1625 @item &
1626 Means (in a particular alternative) that this operand is an
1627 @dfn{earlyclobber} operand, which is written before the instruction is
1628 finished using the input operands. Therefore, this operand may not lie
1629 in a register that is read by the instruction or as part of any memory
1630 address.
1631
1632 @samp{&} applies only to the alternative in which it is written. In
1633 constraints with multiple alternatives, sometimes one alternative
1634 requires @samp{&} while others do not. See, for example, the
1635 @samp{movdf} insn of the 68000.
1636
1637 An operand which is read by the instruction can be tied to an earlyclobber
1638 operand if its only use as an input occurs before the early result is
1639 written. Adding alternatives of this form often allows GCC to produce
1640 better code when only some of the read operands can be affected by the
1641 earlyclobber. See, for example, the @samp{mulsi3} insn of the ARM@.
1642
1643 Furthermore, if the @dfn{earlyclobber} operand is also a read/write
1644 operand, then that operand is written only after it's used.
1645
1646 @samp{&} does not obviate the need to write @samp{=} or @samp{+}. As
1647 @dfn{earlyclobber} operands are always written, a read-only
1648 @dfn{earlyclobber} operand is ill-formed and will be rejected by the
1649 compiler.
1650
1651 @cindex @samp{%} in constraint
1652 @item %
1653 Declares the instruction to be commutative for this operand and the
1654 following operand. This means that the compiler may interchange the
1655 two operands if that is the cheapest way to make all operands fit the
1656 constraints. @samp{%} applies to all alternatives and must appear as
1657 the first character in the constraint. Only read-only operands can use
1658 @samp{%}.
1659
1660 @ifset INTERNALS
1661 This is often used in patterns for addition instructions
1662 that really have only two operands: the result must go in one of the
1663 arguments. Here for example, is how the 68000 halfword-add
1664 instruction is defined:
1665
1666 @smallexample
1667 (define_insn "addhi3"
1668 [(set (match_operand:HI 0 "general_operand" "=m,r")
1669 (plus:HI (match_operand:HI 1 "general_operand" "%0,0")
1670 (match_operand:HI 2 "general_operand" "di,g")))]
1671 @dots{})
1672 @end smallexample
1673 @end ifset
1674 GCC can only handle one commutative pair in an asm; if you use more,
1675 the compiler may fail. Note that you need not use the modifier if
1676 the two alternatives are strictly identical; this would only waste
1677 time in the reload pass.
1678 @ifset INTERNALS
1679 The modifier is not operational after
1680 register allocation, so the result of @code{define_peephole2}
1681 and @code{define_split}s performed after reload cannot rely on
1682 @samp{%} to make the intended insn match.
1683
1684 @cindex @samp{#} in constraint
1685 @item #
1686 Says that all following characters, up to the next comma, are to be
1687 ignored as a constraint. They are significant only for choosing
1688 register preferences.
1689
1690 @cindex @samp{*} in constraint
1691 @item *
1692 Says that the following character should be ignored when choosing
1693 register preferences. @samp{*} has no effect on the meaning of the
1694 constraint as a constraint, and no effect on reloading. For LRA
1695 @samp{*} additionally disparages slightly the alternative if the
1696 following character matches the operand.
1697
1698 Here is an example: the 68000 has an instruction to sign-extend a
1699 halfword in a data register, and can also sign-extend a value by
1700 copying it into an address register. While either kind of register is
1701 acceptable, the constraints on an address-register destination are
1702 less strict, so it is best if register allocation makes an address
1703 register its goal. Therefore, @samp{*} is used so that the @samp{d}
1704 constraint letter (for data register) is ignored when computing
1705 register preferences.
1706
1707 @smallexample
1708 (define_insn "extendhisi2"
1709 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=*d,a")
1710 (sign_extend:SI
1711 (match_operand:HI 1 "general_operand" "0,g")))]
1712 @dots{})
1713 @end smallexample
1714 @end ifset
1715 @end table
1716
1717 @node Machine Constraints
1718 @subsection Constraints for Particular Machines
1719 @cindex machine specific constraints
1720 @cindex constraints, machine specific
1721
1722 Whenever possible, you should use the general-purpose constraint letters
1723 in @code{asm} arguments, since they will convey meaning more readily to
1724 people reading your code. Failing that, use the constraint letters
1725 that usually have very similar meanings across architectures. The most
1726 commonly used constraints are @samp{m} and @samp{r} (for memory and
1727 general-purpose registers respectively; @pxref{Simple Constraints}), and
1728 @samp{I}, usually the letter indicating the most common
1729 immediate-constant format.
1730
1731 Each architecture defines additional constraints. These constraints
1732 are used by the compiler itself for instruction generation, as well as
1733 for @code{asm} statements; therefore, some of the constraints are not
1734 particularly useful for @code{asm}. Here is a summary of some of the
1735 machine-dependent constraints available on some particular machines;
1736 it includes both constraints that are useful for @code{asm} and
1737 constraints that aren't. The compiler source file mentioned in the
1738 table heading for each architecture is the definitive reference for
1739 the meanings of that architecture's constraints.
1740
1741 @c Please keep this table alphabetized by target!
1742 @table @emph
1743 @item AArch64 family---@file{config/aarch64/constraints.md}
1744 @table @code
1745 @item k
1746 The stack pointer register (@code{SP})
1747
1748 @item w
1749 Floating point register, Advanced SIMD vector register or SVE vector register
1750
1751 @item x
1752 Like @code{w}, but restricted to registers 0 to 15 inclusive.
1753
1754 @item y
1755 Like @code{w}, but restricted to registers 0 to 7 inclusive.
1756
1757 @item Upl
1758 One of the low eight SVE predicate registers (@code{P0} to @code{P7})
1759
1760 @item Upa
1761 Any of the SVE predicate registers (@code{P0} to @code{P15})
1762
1763 @item I
1764 Integer constant that is valid as an immediate operand in an @code{ADD}
1765 instruction
1766
1767 @item J
1768 Integer constant that is valid as an immediate operand in a @code{SUB}
1769 instruction (once negated)
1770
1771 @item K
1772 Integer constant that can be used with a 32-bit logical instruction
1773
1774 @item L
1775 Integer constant that can be used with a 64-bit logical instruction
1776
1777 @item M
1778 Integer constant that is valid as an immediate operand in a 32-bit @code{MOV}
1779 pseudo instruction. The @code{MOV} may be assembled to one of several different
1780 machine instructions depending on the value
1781
1782 @item N
1783 Integer constant that is valid as an immediate operand in a 64-bit @code{MOV}
1784 pseudo instruction
1785
1786 @item S
1787 An absolute symbolic address or a label reference
1788
1789 @item Y
1790 Floating point constant zero
1791
1792 @item Z
1793 Integer constant zero
1794
1795 @item Ush
1796 The high part (bits 12 and upwards) of the pc-relative address of a symbol
1797 within 4GB of the instruction
1798
1799 @item Q
1800 A memory address which uses a single base register with no offset
1801
1802 @item Ump
1803 A memory address suitable for a load/store pair instruction in SI, DI, SF and
1804 DF modes
1805
1806 @end table
1807
1808
1809 @item AMD GCN ---@file{config/gcn/constraints.md}
1810 @table @code
1811 @item I
1812 Immediate integer in the range @minus{}16 to 64
1813
1814 @item J
1815 Immediate 16-bit signed integer
1816
1817 @item Kf
1818 Immediate constant @minus{}1
1819
1820 @item L
1821 Immediate 15-bit unsigned integer
1822
1823 @item A
1824 Immediate constant that can be inlined in an instruction encoding: integer
1825 @minus{}16..64, or float 0.0, +/@minus{}0.5, +/@minus{}1.0, +/@minus{}2.0,
1826 +/@minus{}4.0, 1.0/(2.0*PI)
1827
1828 @item B
1829 Immediate 32-bit signed integer that can be attached to an instruction encoding
1830
1831 @item C
1832 Immediate 32-bit integer in range @minus{}16..4294967295 (i.e. 32-bit unsigned
1833 integer or @samp{A} constraint)
1834
1835 @item DA
1836 Immediate 64-bit constant that can be split into two @samp{A} constants
1837
1838 @item DB
1839 Immediate 64-bit constant that can be split into two @samp{B} constants
1840
1841 @item U
1842 Any @code{unspec}
1843
1844 @item Y
1845 Any @code{symbol_ref} or @code{label_ref}
1846
1847 @item v
1848 VGPR register
1849
1850 @item Sg
1851 SGPR register
1852
1853 @item SD
1854 SGPR registers valid for instruction destinations, including VCC, M0 and EXEC
1855
1856 @item SS
1857 SGPR registers valid for instruction sources, including VCC, M0, EXEC and SCC
1858
1859 @item Sm
1860 SGPR registers valid as a source for scalar memory instructions (excludes M0
1861 and EXEC)
1862
1863 @item Sv
1864 SGPR registers valid as a source or destination for vector instructions
1865 (excludes EXEC)
1866
1867 @item ca
1868 All condition registers: SCC, VCCZ, EXECZ
1869
1870 @item cs
1871 Scalar condition register: SCC
1872
1873 @item cV
1874 Vector condition register: VCC, VCC_LO, VCC_HI
1875
1876 @item e
1877 EXEC register (EXEC_LO and EXEC_HI)
1878
1879 @item RB
1880 Memory operand with address space suitable for @code{buffer_*} instructions
1881
1882 @item RF
1883 Memory operand with address space suitable for @code{flat_*} instructions
1884
1885 @item RS
1886 Memory operand with address space suitable for @code{s_*} instructions
1887
1888 @item RL
1889 Memory operand with address space suitable for @code{ds_*} LDS instructions
1890
1891 @item RG
1892 Memory operand with address space suitable for @code{ds_*} GDS instructions
1893
1894 @item RD
1895 Memory operand with address space suitable for any @code{ds_*} instructions
1896
1897 @item RM
1898 Memory operand with address space suitable for @code{global_*} instructions
1899
1900 @end table
1901
1902
1903 @item ARC ---@file{config/arc/constraints.md}
1904 @table @code
1905 @item q
1906 Registers usable in ARCompact 16-bit instructions: @code{r0}-@code{r3},
1907 @code{r12}-@code{r15}. This constraint can only match when the @option{-mq}
1908 option is in effect.
1909
1910 @item e
1911 Registers usable as base-regs of memory addresses in ARCompact 16-bit memory
1912 instructions: @code{r0}-@code{r3}, @code{r12}-@code{r15}, @code{sp}.
1913 This constraint can only match when the @option{-mq}
1914 option is in effect.
1915 @item D
1916 ARC FPX (dpfp) 64-bit registers. @code{D0}, @code{D1}.
1917
1918 @item I
1919 A signed 12-bit integer constant.
1920
1921 @item Cal
1922 constant for arithmetic/logical operations. This might be any constant
1923 that can be put into a long immediate by the assmbler or linker without
1924 involving a PIC relocation.
1925
1926 @item K
1927 A 3-bit unsigned integer constant.
1928
1929 @item L
1930 A 6-bit unsigned integer constant.
1931
1932 @item CnL
1933 One's complement of a 6-bit unsigned integer constant.
1934
1935 @item CmL
1936 Two's complement of a 6-bit unsigned integer constant.
1937
1938 @item M
1939 A 5-bit unsigned integer constant.
1940
1941 @item O
1942 A 7-bit unsigned integer constant.
1943
1944 @item P
1945 A 8-bit unsigned integer constant.
1946
1947 @item H
1948 Any const_double value.
1949 @end table
1950
1951 @item ARM family---@file{config/arm/constraints.md}
1952 @table @code
1953
1954 @item h
1955 In Thumb state, the core registers @code{r8}-@code{r15}.
1956
1957 @item k
1958 The stack pointer register.
1959
1960 @item l
1961 In Thumb State the core registers @code{r0}-@code{r7}. In ARM state this
1962 is an alias for the @code{r} constraint.
1963
1964 @item t
1965 VFP floating-point registers @code{s0}-@code{s31}. Used for 32 bit values.
1966
1967 @item w
1968 VFP floating-point registers @code{d0}-@code{d31} and the appropriate
1969 subset @code{d0}-@code{d15} based on command line options.
1970 Used for 64 bit values only. Not valid for Thumb1.
1971
1972 @item y
1973 The iWMMX co-processor registers.
1974
1975 @item z
1976 The iWMMX GR registers.
1977
1978 @item G
1979 The floating-point constant 0.0
1980
1981 @item I
1982 Integer that is valid as an immediate operand in a data processing
1983 instruction. That is, an integer in the range 0 to 255 rotated by a
1984 multiple of 2
1985
1986 @item J
1987 Integer in the range @minus{}4095 to 4095
1988
1989 @item K
1990 Integer that satisfies constraint @samp{I} when inverted (ones complement)
1991
1992 @item L
1993 Integer that satisfies constraint @samp{I} when negated (twos complement)
1994
1995 @item M
1996 Integer in the range 0 to 32
1997
1998 @item Q
1999 A memory reference where the exact address is in a single register
2000 (`@samp{m}' is preferable for @code{asm} statements)
2001
2002 @item R
2003 An item in the constant pool
2004
2005 @item S
2006 A symbol in the text segment of the current file
2007
2008 @item Uv
2009 A memory reference suitable for VFP load/store insns (reg+constant offset)
2010
2011 @item Uy
2012 A memory reference suitable for iWMMXt load/store instructions.
2013
2014 @item Uq
2015 A memory reference suitable for the ARMv4 ldrsb instruction.
2016 @end table
2017
2018 @item AVR family---@file{config/avr/constraints.md}
2019 @table @code
2020 @item l
2021 Registers from r0 to r15
2022
2023 @item a
2024 Registers from r16 to r23
2025
2026 @item d
2027 Registers from r16 to r31
2028
2029 @item w
2030 Registers from r24 to r31. These registers can be used in @samp{adiw} command
2031
2032 @item e
2033 Pointer register (r26--r31)
2034
2035 @item b
2036 Base pointer register (r28--r31)
2037
2038 @item q
2039 Stack pointer register (SPH:SPL)
2040
2041 @item t
2042 Temporary register r0
2043
2044 @item x
2045 Register pair X (r27:r26)
2046
2047 @item y
2048 Register pair Y (r29:r28)
2049
2050 @item z
2051 Register pair Z (r31:r30)
2052
2053 @item I
2054 Constant greater than @minus{}1, less than 64
2055
2056 @item J
2057 Constant greater than @minus{}64, less than 1
2058
2059 @item K
2060 Constant integer 2
2061
2062 @item L
2063 Constant integer 0
2064
2065 @item M
2066 Constant that fits in 8 bits
2067
2068 @item N
2069 Constant integer @minus{}1
2070
2071 @item O
2072 Constant integer 8, 16, or 24
2073
2074 @item P
2075 Constant integer 1
2076
2077 @item G
2078 A floating point constant 0.0
2079
2080 @item Q
2081 A memory address based on Y or Z pointer with displacement.
2082 @end table
2083
2084 @item Blackfin family---@file{config/bfin/constraints.md}
2085 @table @code
2086 @item a
2087 P register
2088
2089 @item d
2090 D register
2091
2092 @item z
2093 A call clobbered P register.
2094
2095 @item q@var{n}
2096 A single register. If @var{n} is in the range 0 to 7, the corresponding D
2097 register. If it is @code{A}, then the register P0.
2098
2099 @item D
2100 Even-numbered D register
2101
2102 @item W
2103 Odd-numbered D register
2104
2105 @item e
2106 Accumulator register.
2107
2108 @item A
2109 Even-numbered accumulator register.
2110
2111 @item B
2112 Odd-numbered accumulator register.
2113
2114 @item b
2115 I register
2116
2117 @item v
2118 B register
2119
2120 @item f
2121 M register
2122
2123 @item c
2124 Registers used for circular buffering, i.e.@: I, B, or L registers.
2125
2126 @item C
2127 The CC register.
2128
2129 @item t
2130 LT0 or LT1.
2131
2132 @item k
2133 LC0 or LC1.
2134
2135 @item u
2136 LB0 or LB1.
2137
2138 @item x
2139 Any D, P, B, M, I or L register.
2140
2141 @item y
2142 Additional registers typically used only in prologues and epilogues: RETS,
2143 RETN, RETI, RETX, RETE, ASTAT, SEQSTAT and USP.
2144
2145 @item w
2146 Any register except accumulators or CC.
2147
2148 @item Ksh
2149 Signed 16 bit integer (in the range @minus{}32768 to 32767)
2150
2151 @item Kuh
2152 Unsigned 16 bit integer (in the range 0 to 65535)
2153
2154 @item Ks7
2155 Signed 7 bit integer (in the range @minus{}64 to 63)
2156
2157 @item Ku7
2158 Unsigned 7 bit integer (in the range 0 to 127)
2159
2160 @item Ku5
2161 Unsigned 5 bit integer (in the range 0 to 31)
2162
2163 @item Ks4
2164 Signed 4 bit integer (in the range @minus{}8 to 7)
2165
2166 @item Ks3
2167 Signed 3 bit integer (in the range @minus{}3 to 4)
2168
2169 @item Ku3
2170 Unsigned 3 bit integer (in the range 0 to 7)
2171
2172 @item P@var{n}
2173 Constant @var{n}, where @var{n} is a single-digit constant in the range 0 to 4.
2174
2175 @item PA
2176 An integer equal to one of the MACFLAG_XXX constants that is suitable for
2177 use with either accumulator.
2178
2179 @item PB
2180 An integer equal to one of the MACFLAG_XXX constants that is suitable for
2181 use only with accumulator A1.
2182
2183 @item M1
2184 Constant 255.
2185
2186 @item M2
2187 Constant 65535.
2188
2189 @item J
2190 An integer constant with exactly a single bit set.
2191
2192 @item L
2193 An integer constant with all bits set except exactly one.
2194
2195 @item H
2196
2197 @item Q
2198 Any SYMBOL_REF.
2199 @end table
2200
2201 @item CR16 Architecture---@file{config/cr16/cr16.h}
2202 @table @code
2203
2204 @item b
2205 Registers from r0 to r14 (registers without stack pointer)
2206
2207 @item t
2208 Register from r0 to r11 (all 16-bit registers)
2209
2210 @item p
2211 Register from r12 to r15 (all 32-bit registers)
2212
2213 @item I
2214 Signed constant that fits in 4 bits
2215
2216 @item J
2217 Signed constant that fits in 5 bits
2218
2219 @item K
2220 Signed constant that fits in 6 bits
2221
2222 @item L
2223 Unsigned constant that fits in 4 bits
2224
2225 @item M
2226 Signed constant that fits in 32 bits
2227
2228 @item N
2229 Check for 64 bits wide constants for add/sub instructions
2230
2231 @item G
2232 Floating point constant that is legal for store immediate
2233 @end table
2234
2235 @item C-SKY---@file{config/csky/constraints.md}
2236 @table @code
2237
2238 @item a
2239 The mini registers r0 - r7.
2240
2241 @item b
2242 The low registers r0 - r15.
2243
2244 @item c
2245 C register.
2246
2247 @item y
2248 HI and LO registers.
2249
2250 @item l
2251 LO register.
2252
2253 @item h
2254 HI register.
2255
2256 @item v
2257 Vector registers.
2258
2259 @item z
2260 Stack pointer register (SP).
2261 @end table
2262
2263 @ifset INTERNALS
2264 The C-SKY back end supports a large set of additional constraints
2265 that are only useful for instruction selection or splitting rather
2266 than inline asm, such as constraints representing constant integer
2267 ranges accepted by particular instruction encodings.
2268 Refer to the source code for details.
2269 @end ifset
2270
2271 @item Epiphany---@file{config/epiphany/constraints.md}
2272 @table @code
2273 @item U16
2274 An unsigned 16-bit constant.
2275
2276 @item K
2277 An unsigned 5-bit constant.
2278
2279 @item L
2280 A signed 11-bit constant.
2281
2282 @item Cm1
2283 A signed 11-bit constant added to @minus{}1.
2284 Can only match when the @option{-m1reg-@var{reg}} option is active.
2285
2286 @item Cl1
2287 Left-shift of @minus{}1, i.e., a bit mask with a block of leading ones, the rest
2288 being a block of trailing zeroes.
2289 Can only match when the @option{-m1reg-@var{reg}} option is active.
2290
2291 @item Cr1
2292 Right-shift of @minus{}1, i.e., a bit mask with a trailing block of ones, the
2293 rest being zeroes. Or to put it another way, one less than a power of two.
2294 Can only match when the @option{-m1reg-@var{reg}} option is active.
2295
2296 @item Cal
2297 Constant for arithmetic/logical operations.
2298 This is like @code{i}, except that for position independent code,
2299 no symbols / expressions needing relocations are allowed.
2300
2301 @item Csy
2302 Symbolic constant for call/jump instruction.
2303
2304 @item Rcs
2305 The register class usable in short insns. This is a register class
2306 constraint, and can thus drive register allocation.
2307 This constraint won't match unless @option{-mprefer-short-insn-regs} is
2308 in effect.
2309
2310 @item Rsc
2311 The the register class of registers that can be used to hold a
2312 sibcall call address. I.e., a caller-saved register.
2313
2314 @item Rct
2315 Core control register class.
2316
2317 @item Rgs
2318 The register group usable in short insns.
2319 This constraint does not use a register class, so that it only
2320 passively matches suitable registers, and doesn't drive register allocation.
2321
2322 @ifset INTERNALS
2323 @item Car
2324 Constant suitable for the addsi3_r pattern. This is a valid offset
2325 For byte, halfword, or word addressing.
2326 @end ifset
2327
2328 @item Rra
2329 Matches the return address if it can be replaced with the link register.
2330
2331 @item Rcc
2332 Matches the integer condition code register.
2333
2334 @item Sra
2335 Matches the return address if it is in a stack slot.
2336
2337 @item Cfm
2338 Matches control register values to switch fp mode, which are encapsulated in
2339 @code{UNSPEC_FP_MODE}.
2340 @end table
2341
2342 @item FRV---@file{config/frv/frv.h}
2343 @table @code
2344 @item a
2345 Register in the class @code{ACC_REGS} (@code{acc0} to @code{acc7}).
2346
2347 @item b
2348 Register in the class @code{EVEN_ACC_REGS} (@code{acc0} to @code{acc7}).
2349
2350 @item c
2351 Register in the class @code{CC_REGS} (@code{fcc0} to @code{fcc3} and
2352 @code{icc0} to @code{icc3}).
2353
2354 @item d
2355 Register in the class @code{GPR_REGS} (@code{gr0} to @code{gr63}).
2356
2357 @item e
2358 Register in the class @code{EVEN_REGS} (@code{gr0} to @code{gr63}).
2359 Odd registers are excluded not in the class but through the use of a machine
2360 mode larger than 4 bytes.
2361
2362 @item f
2363 Register in the class @code{FPR_REGS} (@code{fr0} to @code{fr63}).
2364
2365 @item h
2366 Register in the class @code{FEVEN_REGS} (@code{fr0} to @code{fr63}).
2367 Odd registers are excluded not in the class but through the use of a machine
2368 mode larger than 4 bytes.
2369
2370 @item l
2371 Register in the class @code{LR_REG} (the @code{lr} register).
2372
2373 @item q
2374 Register in the class @code{QUAD_REGS} (@code{gr2} to @code{gr63}).
2375 Register numbers not divisible by 4 are excluded not in the class but through
2376 the use of a machine mode larger than 8 bytes.
2377
2378 @item t
2379 Register in the class @code{ICC_REGS} (@code{icc0} to @code{icc3}).
2380
2381 @item u
2382 Register in the class @code{FCC_REGS} (@code{fcc0} to @code{fcc3}).
2383
2384 @item v
2385 Register in the class @code{ICR_REGS} (@code{cc4} to @code{cc7}).
2386
2387 @item w
2388 Register in the class @code{FCR_REGS} (@code{cc0} to @code{cc3}).
2389
2390 @item x
2391 Register in the class @code{QUAD_FPR_REGS} (@code{fr0} to @code{fr63}).
2392 Register numbers not divisible by 4 are excluded not in the class but through
2393 the use of a machine mode larger than 8 bytes.
2394
2395 @item z
2396 Register in the class @code{SPR_REGS} (@code{lcr} and @code{lr}).
2397
2398 @item A
2399 Register in the class @code{QUAD_ACC_REGS} (@code{acc0} to @code{acc7}).
2400
2401 @item B
2402 Register in the class @code{ACCG_REGS} (@code{accg0} to @code{accg7}).
2403
2404 @item C
2405 Register in the class @code{CR_REGS} (@code{cc0} to @code{cc7}).
2406
2407 @item G
2408 Floating point constant zero
2409
2410 @item I
2411 6-bit signed integer constant
2412
2413 @item J
2414 10-bit signed integer constant
2415
2416 @item L
2417 16-bit signed integer constant
2418
2419 @item M
2420 16-bit unsigned integer constant
2421
2422 @item N
2423 12-bit signed integer constant that is negative---i.e.@: in the
2424 range of @minus{}2048 to @minus{}1
2425
2426 @item O
2427 Constant zero
2428
2429 @item P
2430 12-bit signed integer constant that is greater than zero---i.e.@: in the
2431 range of 1 to 2047.
2432
2433 @end table
2434
2435 @item FT32---@file{config/ft32/constraints.md}
2436 @table @code
2437 @item A
2438 An absolute address
2439
2440 @item B
2441 An offset address
2442
2443 @item W
2444 A register indirect memory operand
2445
2446 @item e
2447 An offset address.
2448
2449 @item f
2450 An offset address.
2451
2452 @item O
2453 The constant zero or one
2454
2455 @item I
2456 A 16-bit signed constant (@minus{}32768 @dots{} 32767)
2457
2458 @item w
2459 A bitfield mask suitable for bext or bins
2460
2461 @item x
2462 An inverted bitfield mask suitable for bext or bins
2463
2464 @item L
2465 A 16-bit unsigned constant, multiple of 4 (0 @dots{} 65532)
2466
2467 @item S
2468 A 20-bit signed constant (@minus{}524288 @dots{} 524287)
2469
2470 @item b
2471 A constant for a bitfield width (1 @dots{} 16)
2472
2473 @item KA
2474 A 10-bit signed constant (@minus{}512 @dots{} 511)
2475
2476 @end table
2477
2478 @item Hewlett-Packard PA-RISC---@file{config/pa/pa.h}
2479 @table @code
2480 @item a
2481 General register 1
2482
2483 @item f
2484 Floating point register
2485
2486 @item q
2487 Shift amount register
2488
2489 @item x
2490 Floating point register (deprecated)
2491
2492 @item y
2493 Upper floating point register (32-bit), floating point register (64-bit)
2494
2495 @item Z
2496 Any register
2497
2498 @item I
2499 Signed 11-bit integer constant
2500
2501 @item J
2502 Signed 14-bit integer constant
2503
2504 @item K
2505 Integer constant that can be deposited with a @code{zdepi} instruction
2506
2507 @item L
2508 Signed 5-bit integer constant
2509
2510 @item M
2511 Integer constant 0
2512
2513 @item N
2514 Integer constant that can be loaded with a @code{ldil} instruction
2515
2516 @item O
2517 Integer constant whose value plus one is a power of 2
2518
2519 @item P
2520 Integer constant that can be used for @code{and} operations in @code{depi}
2521 and @code{extru} instructions
2522
2523 @item S
2524 Integer constant 31
2525
2526 @item U
2527 Integer constant 63
2528
2529 @item G
2530 Floating-point constant 0.0
2531
2532 @item A
2533 A @code{lo_sum} data-linkage-table memory operand
2534
2535 @item Q
2536 A memory operand that can be used as the destination operand of an
2537 integer store instruction
2538
2539 @item R
2540 A scaled or unscaled indexed memory operand
2541
2542 @item T
2543 A memory operand for floating-point loads and stores
2544
2545 @item W
2546 A register indirect memory operand
2547 @end table
2548
2549 @item Intel IA-64---@file{config/ia64/ia64.h}
2550 @table @code
2551 @item a
2552 General register @code{r0} to @code{r3} for @code{addl} instruction
2553
2554 @item b
2555 Branch register
2556
2557 @item c
2558 Predicate register (@samp{c} as in ``conditional'')
2559
2560 @item d
2561 Application register residing in M-unit
2562
2563 @item e
2564 Application register residing in I-unit
2565
2566 @item f
2567 Floating-point register
2568
2569 @item m
2570 Memory operand. If used together with @samp{<} or @samp{>},
2571 the operand can have postincrement and postdecrement which
2572 require printing with @samp{%Pn} on IA-64.
2573
2574 @item G
2575 Floating-point constant 0.0 or 1.0
2576
2577 @item I
2578 14-bit signed integer constant
2579
2580 @item J
2581 22-bit signed integer constant
2582
2583 @item K
2584 8-bit signed integer constant for logical instructions
2585
2586 @item L
2587 8-bit adjusted signed integer constant for compare pseudo-ops
2588
2589 @item M
2590 6-bit unsigned integer constant for shift counts
2591
2592 @item N
2593 9-bit signed integer constant for load and store postincrements
2594
2595 @item O
2596 The constant zero
2597
2598 @item P
2599 0 or @minus{}1 for @code{dep} instruction
2600
2601 @item Q
2602 Non-volatile memory for floating-point loads and stores
2603
2604 @item R
2605 Integer constant in the range 1 to 4 for @code{shladd} instruction
2606
2607 @item S
2608 Memory operand except postincrement and postdecrement. This is
2609 now roughly the same as @samp{m} when not used together with @samp{<}
2610 or @samp{>}.
2611 @end table
2612
2613 @item M32C---@file{config/m32c/m32c.c}
2614 @table @code
2615 @item Rsp
2616 @itemx Rfb
2617 @itemx Rsb
2618 @samp{$sp}, @samp{$fb}, @samp{$sb}.
2619
2620 @item Rcr
2621 Any control register, when they're 16 bits wide (nothing if control
2622 registers are 24 bits wide)
2623
2624 @item Rcl
2625 Any control register, when they're 24 bits wide.
2626
2627 @item R0w
2628 @itemx R1w
2629 @itemx R2w
2630 @itemx R3w
2631 $r0, $r1, $r2, $r3.
2632
2633 @item R02
2634 $r0 or $r2, or $r2r0 for 32 bit values.
2635
2636 @item R13
2637 $r1 or $r3, or $r3r1 for 32 bit values.
2638
2639 @item Rdi
2640 A register that can hold a 64 bit value.
2641
2642 @item Rhl
2643 $r0 or $r1 (registers with addressable high/low bytes)
2644
2645 @item R23
2646 $r2 or $r3
2647
2648 @item Raa
2649 Address registers
2650
2651 @item Raw
2652 Address registers when they're 16 bits wide.
2653
2654 @item Ral
2655 Address registers when they're 24 bits wide.
2656
2657 @item Rqi
2658 Registers that can hold QI values.
2659
2660 @item Rad
2661 Registers that can be used with displacements ($a0, $a1, $sb).
2662
2663 @item Rsi
2664 Registers that can hold 32 bit values.
2665
2666 @item Rhi
2667 Registers that can hold 16 bit values.
2668
2669 @item Rhc
2670 Registers chat can hold 16 bit values, including all control
2671 registers.
2672
2673 @item Rra
2674 $r0 through R1, plus $a0 and $a1.
2675
2676 @item Rfl
2677 The flags register.
2678
2679 @item Rmm
2680 The memory-based pseudo-registers $mem0 through $mem15.
2681
2682 @item Rpi
2683 Registers that can hold pointers (16 bit registers for r8c, m16c; 24
2684 bit registers for m32cm, m32c).
2685
2686 @item Rpa
2687 Matches multiple registers in a PARALLEL to form a larger register.
2688 Used to match function return values.
2689
2690 @item Is3
2691 @minus{}8 @dots{} 7
2692
2693 @item IS1
2694 @minus{}128 @dots{} 127
2695
2696 @item IS2
2697 @minus{}32768 @dots{} 32767
2698
2699 @item IU2
2700 0 @dots{} 65535
2701
2702 @item In4
2703 @minus{}8 @dots{} @minus{}1 or 1 @dots{} 8
2704
2705 @item In5
2706 @minus{}16 @dots{} @minus{}1 or 1 @dots{} 16
2707
2708 @item In6
2709 @minus{}32 @dots{} @minus{}1 or 1 @dots{} 32
2710
2711 @item IM2
2712 @minus{}65536 @dots{} @minus{}1
2713
2714 @item Ilb
2715 An 8 bit value with exactly one bit set.
2716
2717 @item Ilw
2718 A 16 bit value with exactly one bit set.
2719
2720 @item Sd
2721 The common src/dest memory addressing modes.
2722
2723 @item Sa
2724 Memory addressed using $a0 or $a1.
2725
2726 @item Si
2727 Memory addressed with immediate addresses.
2728
2729 @item Ss
2730 Memory addressed using the stack pointer ($sp).
2731
2732 @item Sf
2733 Memory addressed using the frame base register ($fb).
2734
2735 @item Ss
2736 Memory addressed using the small base register ($sb).
2737
2738 @item S1
2739 $r1h
2740 @end table
2741
2742 @item MicroBlaze---@file{config/microblaze/constraints.md}
2743 @table @code
2744 @item d
2745 A general register (@code{r0} to @code{r31}).
2746
2747 @item z
2748 A status register (@code{rmsr}, @code{$fcc1} to @code{$fcc7}).
2749
2750 @end table
2751
2752 @item MIPS---@file{config/mips/constraints.md}
2753 @table @code
2754 @item d
2755 A general-purpose register. This is equivalent to @code{r} unless
2756 generating MIPS16 code, in which case the MIPS16 register set is used.
2757
2758 @item f
2759 A floating-point register (if available).
2760
2761 @item h
2762 Formerly the @code{hi} register. This constraint is no longer supported.
2763
2764 @item l
2765 The @code{lo} register. Use this register to store values that are
2766 no bigger than a word.
2767
2768 @item x
2769 The concatenated @code{hi} and @code{lo} registers. Use this register
2770 to store doubleword values.
2771
2772 @item c
2773 A register suitable for use in an indirect jump. This will always be
2774 @code{$25} for @option{-mabicalls}.
2775
2776 @item v
2777 Register @code{$3}. Do not use this constraint in new code;
2778 it is retained only for compatibility with glibc.
2779
2780 @item y
2781 Equivalent to @code{r}; retained for backwards compatibility.
2782
2783 @item z
2784 A floating-point condition code register.
2785
2786 @item I
2787 A signed 16-bit constant (for arithmetic instructions).
2788
2789 @item J
2790 Integer zero.
2791
2792 @item K
2793 An unsigned 16-bit constant (for logic instructions).
2794
2795 @item L
2796 A signed 32-bit constant in which the lower 16 bits are zero.
2797 Such constants can be loaded using @code{lui}.
2798
2799 @item M
2800 A constant that cannot be loaded using @code{lui}, @code{addiu}
2801 or @code{ori}.
2802
2803 @item N
2804 A constant in the range @minus{}65535 to @minus{}1 (inclusive).
2805
2806 @item O
2807 A signed 15-bit constant.
2808
2809 @item P
2810 A constant in the range 1 to 65535 (inclusive).
2811
2812 @item G
2813 Floating-point zero.
2814
2815 @item R
2816 An address that can be used in a non-macro load or store.
2817
2818 @item ZC
2819 A memory operand whose address is formed by a base register and offset
2820 that is suitable for use in instructions with the same addressing mode
2821 as @code{ll} and @code{sc}.
2822
2823 @item ZD
2824 An address suitable for a @code{prefetch} instruction, or for any other
2825 instruction with the same addressing mode as @code{prefetch}.
2826 @end table
2827
2828 @item Motorola 680x0---@file{config/m68k/constraints.md}
2829 @table @code
2830 @item a
2831 Address register
2832
2833 @item d
2834 Data register
2835
2836 @item f
2837 68881 floating-point register, if available
2838
2839 @item I
2840 Integer in the range 1 to 8
2841
2842 @item J
2843 16-bit signed number
2844
2845 @item K
2846 Signed number whose magnitude is greater than 0x80
2847
2848 @item L
2849 Integer in the range @minus{}8 to @minus{}1
2850
2851 @item M
2852 Signed number whose magnitude is greater than 0x100
2853
2854 @item N
2855 Range 24 to 31, rotatert:SI 8 to 1 expressed as rotate
2856
2857 @item O
2858 16 (for rotate using swap)
2859
2860 @item P
2861 Range 8 to 15, rotatert:HI 8 to 1 expressed as rotate
2862
2863 @item R
2864 Numbers that mov3q can handle
2865
2866 @item G
2867 Floating point constant that is not a 68881 constant
2868
2869 @item S
2870 Operands that satisfy 'm' when -mpcrel is in effect
2871
2872 @item T
2873 Operands that satisfy 's' when -mpcrel is not in effect
2874
2875 @item Q
2876 Address register indirect addressing mode
2877
2878 @item U
2879 Register offset addressing
2880
2881 @item W
2882 const_call_operand
2883
2884 @item Cs
2885 symbol_ref or const
2886
2887 @item Ci
2888 const_int
2889
2890 @item C0
2891 const_int 0
2892
2893 @item Cj
2894 Range of signed numbers that don't fit in 16 bits
2895
2896 @item Cmvq
2897 Integers valid for mvq
2898
2899 @item Capsw
2900 Integers valid for a moveq followed by a swap
2901
2902 @item Cmvz
2903 Integers valid for mvz
2904
2905 @item Cmvs
2906 Integers valid for mvs
2907
2908 @item Ap
2909 push_operand
2910
2911 @item Ac
2912 Non-register operands allowed in clr
2913
2914 @end table
2915
2916 @item Moxie---@file{config/moxie/constraints.md}
2917 @table @code
2918 @item A
2919 An absolute address
2920
2921 @item B
2922 An offset address
2923
2924 @item W
2925 A register indirect memory operand
2926
2927 @item I
2928 A constant in the range of 0 to 255.
2929
2930 @item N
2931 A constant in the range of 0 to @minus{}255.
2932
2933 @end table
2934
2935 @item MSP430--@file{config/msp430/constraints.md}
2936 @table @code
2937
2938 @item R12
2939 Register R12.
2940
2941 @item R13
2942 Register R13.
2943
2944 @item K
2945 Integer constant 1.
2946
2947 @item L
2948 Integer constant -1^20..1^19.
2949
2950 @item M
2951 Integer constant 1-4.
2952
2953 @item Ya
2954 Memory references which do not require an extended MOVX instruction.
2955
2956 @item Yl
2957 Memory reference, labels only.
2958
2959 @item Ys
2960 Memory reference, stack only.
2961
2962 @end table
2963
2964 @item NDS32---@file{config/nds32/constraints.md}
2965 @table @code
2966 @item w
2967 LOW register class $r0 to $r7 constraint for V3/V3M ISA.
2968 @item l
2969 LOW register class $r0 to $r7.
2970 @item d
2971 MIDDLE register class $r0 to $r11, $r16 to $r19.
2972 @item h
2973 HIGH register class $r12 to $r14, $r20 to $r31.
2974 @item t
2975 Temporary assist register $ta (i.e.@: $r15).
2976 @item k
2977 Stack register $sp.
2978 @item Iu03
2979 Unsigned immediate 3-bit value.
2980 @item In03
2981 Negative immediate 3-bit value in the range of @minus{}7--0.
2982 @item Iu04
2983 Unsigned immediate 4-bit value.
2984 @item Is05
2985 Signed immediate 5-bit value.
2986 @item Iu05
2987 Unsigned immediate 5-bit value.
2988 @item In05
2989 Negative immediate 5-bit value in the range of @minus{}31--0.
2990 @item Ip05
2991 Unsigned immediate 5-bit value for movpi45 instruction with range 16--47.
2992 @item Iu06
2993 Unsigned immediate 6-bit value constraint for addri36.sp instruction.
2994 @item Iu08
2995 Unsigned immediate 8-bit value.
2996 @item Iu09
2997 Unsigned immediate 9-bit value.
2998 @item Is10
2999 Signed immediate 10-bit value.
3000 @item Is11
3001 Signed immediate 11-bit value.
3002 @item Is15
3003 Signed immediate 15-bit value.
3004 @item Iu15
3005 Unsigned immediate 15-bit value.
3006 @item Ic15
3007 A constant which is not in the range of imm15u but ok for bclr instruction.
3008 @item Ie15
3009 A constant which is not in the range of imm15u but ok for bset instruction.
3010 @item It15
3011 A constant which is not in the range of imm15u but ok for btgl instruction.
3012 @item Ii15
3013 A constant whose compliment value is in the range of imm15u
3014 and ok for bitci instruction.
3015 @item Is16
3016 Signed immediate 16-bit value.
3017 @item Is17
3018 Signed immediate 17-bit value.
3019 @item Is19
3020 Signed immediate 19-bit value.
3021 @item Is20
3022 Signed immediate 20-bit value.
3023 @item Ihig
3024 The immediate value that can be simply set high 20-bit.
3025 @item Izeb
3026 The immediate value 0xff.
3027 @item Izeh
3028 The immediate value 0xffff.
3029 @item Ixls
3030 The immediate value 0x01.
3031 @item Ix11
3032 The immediate value 0x7ff.
3033 @item Ibms
3034 The immediate value with power of 2.
3035 @item Ifex
3036 The immediate value with power of 2 minus 1.
3037 @item U33
3038 Memory constraint for 333 format.
3039 @item U45
3040 Memory constraint for 45 format.
3041 @item U37
3042 Memory constraint for 37 format.
3043 @end table
3044
3045 @item Nios II family---@file{config/nios2/constraints.md}
3046 @table @code
3047
3048 @item I
3049 Integer that is valid as an immediate operand in an
3050 instruction taking a signed 16-bit number. Range
3051 @minus{}32768 to 32767.
3052
3053 @item J
3054 Integer that is valid as an immediate operand in an
3055 instruction taking an unsigned 16-bit number. Range
3056 0 to 65535.
3057
3058 @item K
3059 Integer that is valid as an immediate operand in an
3060 instruction taking only the upper 16-bits of a
3061 32-bit number. Range 32-bit numbers with the lower
3062 16-bits being 0.
3063
3064 @item L
3065 Integer that is valid as an immediate operand for a
3066 shift instruction. Range 0 to 31.
3067
3068 @item M
3069 Integer that is valid as an immediate operand for
3070 only the value 0. Can be used in conjunction with
3071 the format modifier @code{z} to use @code{r0}
3072 instead of @code{0} in the assembly output.
3073
3074 @item N
3075 Integer that is valid as an immediate operand for
3076 a custom instruction opcode. Range 0 to 255.
3077
3078 @item P
3079 An immediate operand for R2 andchi/andci instructions.
3080
3081 @item S
3082 Matches immediates which are addresses in the small
3083 data section and therefore can be added to @code{gp}
3084 as a 16-bit immediate to re-create their 32-bit value.
3085
3086 @item U
3087 Matches constants suitable as an operand for the rdprs and
3088 cache instructions.
3089
3090 @item v
3091 A memory operand suitable for Nios II R2 load/store
3092 exclusive instructions.
3093
3094 @item w
3095 A memory operand suitable for load/store IO and cache
3096 instructions.
3097
3098 @ifset INTERNALS
3099 @item T
3100 A @code{const} wrapped @code{UNSPEC} expression,
3101 representing a supported PIC or TLS relocation.
3102 @end ifset
3103
3104 @end table
3105
3106 @item OpenRISC---@file{config/or1k/constraints.md}
3107 @table @code
3108 @item I
3109 Integer that is valid as an immediate operand in an
3110 instruction taking a signed 16-bit number. Range
3111 @minus{}32768 to 32767.
3112
3113 @item K
3114 Integer that is valid as an immediate operand in an
3115 instruction taking an unsigned 16-bit number. Range
3116 0 to 65535.
3117
3118 @item M
3119 Signed 16-bit constant shifted left 16 bits. (Used with @code{l.movhi})
3120
3121 @item O
3122 Zero
3123
3124 @ifset INTERNALS
3125 @item c
3126 Register usable for sibcalls.
3127 @end ifset
3128
3129 @end table
3130
3131 @item PDP-11---@file{config/pdp11/constraints.md}
3132 @table @code
3133 @item a
3134 Floating point registers AC0 through AC3. These can be loaded from/to
3135 memory with a single instruction.
3136
3137 @item d
3138 Odd numbered general registers (R1, R3, R5). These are used for
3139 16-bit multiply operations.
3140
3141 @item D
3142 A memory reference that is encoded within the opcode, but not
3143 auto-increment or auto-decrement.
3144
3145 @item f
3146 Any of the floating point registers (AC0 through AC5).
3147
3148 @item G
3149 Floating point constant 0.
3150
3151 @item h
3152 Floating point registers AC4 and AC5. These cannot be loaded from/to
3153 memory with a single instruction.
3154
3155 @item I
3156 An integer constant that fits in 16 bits.
3157
3158 @item J
3159 An integer constant whose low order 16 bits are zero.
3160
3161 @item K
3162 An integer constant that does not meet the constraints for codes
3163 @samp{I} or @samp{J}.
3164
3165 @item L
3166 The integer constant 1.
3167
3168 @item M
3169 The integer constant @minus{}1.
3170
3171 @item N
3172 The integer constant 0.
3173
3174 @item O
3175 Integer constants 0 through 3; shifts by these
3176 amounts are handled as multiple single-bit shifts rather than a single
3177 variable-length shift.
3178
3179 @item Q
3180 A memory reference which requires an additional word (address or
3181 offset) after the opcode.
3182
3183 @item R
3184 A memory reference that is encoded within the opcode.
3185
3186 @end table
3187
3188 @item PowerPC and IBM RS6000---@file{config/rs6000/constraints.md}
3189 @table @code
3190 @item r
3191 A general purpose register (GPR), @code{r0}@dots{}@code{r31}.
3192
3193 @item b
3194 A base register. Like @code{r}, but @code{r0} is not allowed, so
3195 @code{r1}@dots{}@code{r31}.
3196
3197 @item f
3198 A floating point register (FPR), @code{f0}@dots{}@code{f31}.
3199
3200 @item d
3201 A floating point register. This is the same as @code{f} nowadays;
3202 historically @code{f} was for single-precision and @code{d} was for
3203 double-precision floating point.
3204
3205 @item v
3206 An Altivec vector register (VR), @code{v0}@dots{}@code{v31}.
3207
3208 @item wa
3209 A VSX register (VSR), @code{vs0}@dots{}@code{vs63}. This is either an
3210 FPR (@code{vs0}@dots{}@code{vs31} are @code{f0}@dots{}@code{f31}) or a VR
3211 (@code{vs32}@dots{}@code{vs63} are @code{v0}@dots{}@code{v31}).
3212
3213 When using @code{wa}, you should use the @code{%x} output modifier, so that
3214 the correct register number is printed. For example:
3215
3216 @smallexample
3217 asm ("xvadddp %x0,%x1,%x2"
3218 : "=wa" (v1)
3219 : "wa" (v2), "wa" (v3));
3220 @end smallexample
3221
3222 You should not use @code{%x} for @code{v} operands:
3223
3224 @smallexample
3225 asm ("xsaddqp %0,%1,%2"
3226 : "=v" (v1)
3227 : "v" (v2), "v" (v3));
3228 @end smallexample
3229
3230 @ifset INTERNALS
3231 @item h
3232 A special register (@code{vrsave}, @code{ctr}, or @code{lr}).
3233 @end ifset
3234
3235 @item c
3236 The count register, @code{ctr}.
3237
3238 @item l
3239 The link register, @code{lr}.
3240
3241 @item x
3242 Condition register field 0, @code{cr0}.
3243
3244 @item y
3245 Any condition register field, @code{cr0}@dots{}@code{cr7}.
3246
3247 @ifset INTERNALS
3248 @item z
3249 The carry bit, @code{XER[CA]}.
3250
3251 @item we
3252 Like @code{wa}, if @option{-mpower9-vector} and @option{-m64} are used;
3253 otherwise, @code{NO_REGS}.
3254
3255 @item wn
3256 No register (@code{NO_REGS}).
3257
3258 @item wr
3259 Like @code{r}, if @option{-mpowerpc64} is used; otherwise, @code{NO_REGS}.
3260
3261 @item wx
3262 Like @code{d}, if @option{-mpowerpc-gfxopt} is used; otherwise, @code{NO_REGS}.
3263
3264 @item wA
3265 Like @code{b}, if @option{-mpowerpc64} is used; otherwise, @code{NO_REGS}.
3266
3267 @item wB
3268 Signed 5-bit constant integer that can be loaded into an Altivec register.
3269
3270 @item wD
3271 Int constant that is the element number of the 64-bit scalar in a vector.
3272
3273 @item wE
3274 Vector constant that can be loaded with the XXSPLTIB instruction.
3275
3276 @item wF
3277 Memory operand suitable for power8 GPR load fusion.
3278
3279 @item wL
3280 Int constant that is the element number mfvsrld accesses in a vector.
3281
3282 @item wM
3283 Match vector constant with all 1's if the XXLORC instruction is available.
3284
3285 @item wO
3286 Memory operand suitable for the ISA 3.0 vector d-form instructions.
3287
3288 @item wQ
3289 Memory operand suitable for the load/store quad instructions.
3290
3291 @item wS
3292 Vector constant that can be loaded with XXSPLTIB & sign extension.
3293
3294 @item wY
3295 A memory operand for a DS-form instruction.
3296
3297 @item wZ
3298 An indexed or indirect memory operand, ignoring the bottom 4 bits.
3299 @end ifset
3300
3301 @item I
3302 A signed 16-bit constant.
3303
3304 @item J
3305 An unsigned 16-bit constant shifted left 16 bits (use @code{L} instead
3306 for @code{SImode} constants).
3307
3308 @item K
3309 An unsigned 16-bit constant.
3310
3311 @item L
3312 A signed 16-bit constant shifted left 16 bits.
3313
3314 @ifset INTERNALS
3315 @item M
3316 An integer constant greater than 31.
3317
3318 @item N
3319 An exact power of 2.
3320
3321 @item O
3322 The integer constant zero.
3323
3324 @item P
3325 A constant whose negation is a signed 16-bit constant.
3326 @end ifset
3327
3328 @item eI
3329 A signed 34-bit integer constant if prefixed instructions are supported.
3330
3331 @ifset INTERNALS
3332 @item G
3333 A floating point constant that can be loaded into a register with one
3334 instruction per word.
3335
3336 @item H
3337 A floating point constant that can be loaded into a register using
3338 three instructions.
3339 @end ifset
3340
3341 @item m
3342 A memory operand.
3343 Normally, @code{m} does not allow addresses that update the base register.
3344 If the @code{<} or @code{>} constraint is also used, they are allowed and
3345 therefore on PowerPC targets in that case it is only safe
3346 to use @code{m<>} in an @code{asm} statement if that @code{asm} statement
3347 accesses the operand exactly once. The @code{asm} statement must also
3348 use @code{%U@var{<opno>}} as a placeholder for the ``update'' flag in the
3349 corresponding load or store instruction. For example:
3350
3351 @smallexample
3352 asm ("st%U0 %1,%0" : "=m<>" (mem) : "r" (val));
3353 @end smallexample
3354
3355 is correct but:
3356
3357 @smallexample
3358 asm ("st %1,%0" : "=m<>" (mem) : "r" (val));
3359 @end smallexample
3360
3361 is not.
3362
3363 @ifset INTERNALS
3364 @item es
3365 A ``stable'' memory operand; that is, one which does not include any
3366 automodification of the base register. This used to be useful when
3367 @code{m} allowed automodification of the base register, but as those
3368 are now only allowed when @code{<} or @code{>} is used, @code{es} is
3369 basically the same as @code{m} without @code{<} and @code{>}.
3370 @end ifset
3371
3372 @item Q
3373 A memory operand addressed by just a base register.
3374
3375 @ifset INTERNALS
3376 @item Y
3377 A memory operand for a DQ-form instruction.
3378 @end ifset
3379
3380 @item Z
3381 A memory operand accessed with indexed or indirect addressing.
3382
3383 @ifset INTERNALS
3384 @item R
3385 An AIX TOC entry.
3386 @end ifset
3387
3388 @item a
3389 An indexed or indirect address.
3390
3391 @ifset INTERNALS
3392 @item U
3393 A V.4 small data reference.
3394
3395 @item W
3396 A vector constant that does not require memory.
3397
3398 @item j
3399 The zero vector constant.
3400 @end ifset
3401
3402 @end table
3403
3404 @item PRU---@file{config/pru/constraints.md}
3405 @table @code
3406 @item I
3407 An unsigned 8-bit integer constant.
3408
3409 @item J
3410 An unsigned 16-bit integer constant.
3411
3412 @item L
3413 An unsigned 5-bit integer constant (for shift counts).
3414
3415 @item T
3416 A text segment (program memory) constant label.
3417
3418 @item Z
3419 Integer constant zero.
3420
3421 @end table
3422
3423 @item RL78---@file{config/rl78/constraints.md}
3424 @table @code
3425
3426 @item Int3
3427 An integer constant in the range 1 @dots{} 7.
3428 @item Int8
3429 An integer constant in the range 0 @dots{} 255.
3430 @item J
3431 An integer constant in the range @minus{}255 @dots{} 0
3432 @item K
3433 The integer constant 1.
3434 @item L
3435 The integer constant -1.
3436 @item M
3437 The integer constant 0.
3438 @item N
3439 The integer constant 2.
3440 @item O
3441 The integer constant -2.
3442 @item P
3443 An integer constant in the range 1 @dots{} 15.
3444 @item Qbi
3445 The built-in compare types--eq, ne, gtu, ltu, geu, and leu.
3446 @item Qsc
3447 The synthetic compare types--gt, lt, ge, and le.
3448 @item Wab
3449 A memory reference with an absolute address.
3450 @item Wbc
3451 A memory reference using @code{BC} as a base register, with an optional offset.
3452 @item Wca
3453 A memory reference using @code{AX}, @code{BC}, @code{DE}, or @code{HL} for the address, for calls.
3454 @item Wcv
3455 A memory reference using any 16-bit register pair for the address, for calls.
3456 @item Wd2
3457 A memory reference using @code{DE} as a base register, with an optional offset.
3458 @item Wde
3459 A memory reference using @code{DE} as a base register, without any offset.
3460 @item Wfr
3461 Any memory reference to an address in the far address space.
3462 @item Wh1
3463 A memory reference using @code{HL} as a base register, with an optional one-byte offset.
3464 @item Whb
3465 A memory reference using @code{HL} as a base register, with @code{B} or @code{C} as the index register.
3466 @item Whl
3467 A memory reference using @code{HL} as a base register, without any offset.
3468 @item Ws1
3469 A memory reference using @code{SP} as a base register, with an optional one-byte offset.
3470 @item Y
3471 Any memory reference to an address in the near address space.
3472 @item A
3473 The @code{AX} register.
3474 @item B
3475 The @code{BC} register.
3476 @item D
3477 The @code{DE} register.
3478 @item R
3479 @code{A} through @code{L} registers.
3480 @item S
3481 The @code{SP} register.
3482 @item T
3483 The @code{HL} register.
3484 @item Z08W
3485 The 16-bit @code{R8} register.
3486 @item Z10W
3487 The 16-bit @code{R10} register.
3488 @item Zint
3489 The registers reserved for interrupts (@code{R24} to @code{R31}).
3490 @item a
3491 The @code{A} register.
3492 @item b
3493 The @code{B} register.
3494 @item c
3495 The @code{C} register.
3496 @item d
3497 The @code{D} register.
3498 @item e
3499 The @code{E} register.
3500 @item h
3501 The @code{H} register.
3502 @item l
3503 The @code{L} register.
3504 @item v
3505 The virtual registers.
3506 @item w
3507 The @code{PSW} register.
3508 @item x
3509 The @code{X} register.
3510
3511 @end table
3512
3513 @item RISC-V---@file{config/riscv/constraints.md}
3514 @table @code
3515
3516 @item f
3517 A floating-point register (if available).
3518
3519 @item I
3520 An I-type 12-bit signed immediate.
3521
3522 @item J
3523 Integer zero.
3524
3525 @item K
3526 A 5-bit unsigned immediate for CSR access instructions.
3527
3528 @item A
3529 An address that is held in a general-purpose register.
3530
3531 @end table
3532
3533 @item RX---@file{config/rx/constraints.md}
3534 @table @code
3535 @item Q
3536 An address which does not involve register indirect addressing or
3537 pre/post increment/decrement addressing.
3538
3539 @item Symbol
3540 A symbol reference.
3541
3542 @item Int08
3543 A constant in the range @minus{}256 to 255, inclusive.
3544
3545 @item Sint08
3546 A constant in the range @minus{}128 to 127, inclusive.
3547
3548 @item Sint16
3549 A constant in the range @minus{}32768 to 32767, inclusive.
3550
3551 @item Sint24
3552 A constant in the range @minus{}8388608 to 8388607, inclusive.
3553
3554 @item Uint04
3555 A constant in the range 0 to 15, inclusive.
3556
3557 @end table
3558
3559 @item S/390 and zSeries---@file{config/s390/s390.h}
3560 @table @code
3561 @item a
3562 Address register (general purpose register except r0)
3563
3564 @item c
3565 Condition code register
3566
3567 @item d
3568 Data register (arbitrary general purpose register)
3569
3570 @item f
3571 Floating-point register
3572
3573 @item I
3574 Unsigned 8-bit constant (0--255)
3575
3576 @item J
3577 Unsigned 12-bit constant (0--4095)
3578
3579 @item K
3580 Signed 16-bit constant (@minus{}32768--32767)
3581
3582 @item L
3583 Value appropriate as displacement.
3584 @table @code
3585 @item (0..4095)
3586 for short displacement
3587 @item (@minus{}524288..524287)
3588 for long displacement
3589 @end table
3590
3591 @item M
3592 Constant integer with a value of 0x7fffffff.
3593
3594 @item N
3595 Multiple letter constraint followed by 4 parameter letters.
3596 @table @code
3597 @item 0..9:
3598 number of the part counting from most to least significant
3599 @item H,Q:
3600 mode of the part
3601 @item D,S,H:
3602 mode of the containing operand
3603 @item 0,F:
3604 value of the other parts (F---all bits set)
3605 @end table
3606 The constraint matches if the specified part of a constant
3607 has a value different from its other parts.
3608
3609 @item Q
3610 Memory reference without index register and with short displacement.
3611
3612 @item R
3613 Memory reference with index register and short displacement.
3614
3615 @item S
3616 Memory reference without index register but with long displacement.
3617
3618 @item T
3619 Memory reference with index register and long displacement.
3620
3621 @item U
3622 Pointer with short displacement.
3623
3624 @item W
3625 Pointer with long displacement.
3626
3627 @item Y
3628 Shift count operand.
3629
3630 @end table
3631
3632 @need 1000
3633 @item SPARC---@file{config/sparc/sparc.h}
3634 @table @code
3635 @item f
3636 Floating-point register on the SPARC-V8 architecture and
3637 lower floating-point register on the SPARC-V9 architecture.
3638
3639 @item e
3640 Floating-point register. It is equivalent to @samp{f} on the
3641 SPARC-V8 architecture and contains both lower and upper
3642 floating-point registers on the SPARC-V9 architecture.
3643
3644 @item c
3645 Floating-point condition code register.
3646
3647 @item d
3648 Lower floating-point register. It is only valid on the SPARC-V9
3649 architecture when the Visual Instruction Set is available.
3650
3651 @item b
3652 Floating-point register. It is only valid on the SPARC-V9 architecture
3653 when the Visual Instruction Set is available.
3654
3655 @item h
3656 64-bit global or out register for the SPARC-V8+ architecture.
3657
3658 @item C
3659 The constant all-ones, for floating-point.
3660
3661 @item A
3662 Signed 5-bit constant
3663
3664 @item D
3665 A vector constant
3666
3667 @item I
3668 Signed 13-bit constant
3669
3670 @item J
3671 Zero
3672
3673 @item K
3674 32-bit constant with the low 12 bits clear (a constant that can be
3675 loaded with the @code{sethi} instruction)
3676
3677 @item L
3678 A constant in the range supported by @code{movcc} instructions (11-bit
3679 signed immediate)
3680
3681 @item M
3682 A constant in the range supported by @code{movrcc} instructions (10-bit
3683 signed immediate)
3684
3685 @item N
3686 Same as @samp{K}, except that it verifies that bits that are not in the
3687 lower 32-bit range are all zero. Must be used instead of @samp{K} for
3688 modes wider than @code{SImode}
3689
3690 @item O
3691 The constant 4096
3692
3693 @item G
3694 Floating-point zero
3695
3696 @item H
3697 Signed 13-bit constant, sign-extended to 32 or 64 bits
3698
3699 @item P
3700 The constant -1
3701
3702 @item Q
3703 Floating-point constant whose integral representation can
3704 be moved into an integer register using a single sethi
3705 instruction
3706
3707 @item R
3708 Floating-point constant whose integral representation can
3709 be moved into an integer register using a single mov
3710 instruction
3711
3712 @item S
3713 Floating-point constant whose integral representation can
3714 be moved into an integer register using a high/lo_sum
3715 instruction sequence
3716
3717 @item T
3718 Memory address aligned to an 8-byte boundary
3719
3720 @item U
3721 Even register
3722
3723 @item W
3724 Memory address for @samp{e} constraint registers
3725
3726 @item w
3727 Memory address with only a base register
3728
3729 @item Y
3730 Vector zero
3731
3732 @end table
3733
3734 @item TI C6X family---@file{config/c6x/constraints.md}
3735 @table @code
3736 @item a
3737 Register file A (A0--A31).
3738
3739 @item b
3740 Register file B (B0--B31).
3741
3742 @item A
3743 Predicate registers in register file A (A0--A2 on C64X and
3744 higher, A1 and A2 otherwise).
3745
3746 @item B
3747 Predicate registers in register file B (B0--B2).
3748
3749 @item C
3750 A call-used register in register file B (B0--B9, B16--B31).
3751
3752 @item Da
3753 Register file A, excluding predicate registers (A3--A31,
3754 plus A0 if not C64X or higher).
3755
3756 @item Db
3757 Register file B, excluding predicate registers (B3--B31).
3758
3759 @item Iu4
3760 Integer constant in the range 0 @dots{} 15.
3761
3762 @item Iu5
3763 Integer constant in the range 0 @dots{} 31.
3764
3765 @item In5
3766 Integer constant in the range @minus{}31 @dots{} 0.
3767
3768 @item Is5
3769 Integer constant in the range @minus{}16 @dots{} 15.
3770
3771 @item I5x
3772 Integer constant that can be the operand of an ADDA or a SUBA insn.
3773
3774 @item IuB
3775 Integer constant in the range 0 @dots{} 65535.
3776
3777 @item IsB
3778 Integer constant in the range @minus{}32768 @dots{} 32767.
3779
3780 @item IsC
3781 Integer constant in the range @math{-2^{20}} @dots{} @math{2^{20} - 1}.
3782
3783 @item Jc
3784 Integer constant that is a valid mask for the clr instruction.
3785
3786 @item Js
3787 Integer constant that is a valid mask for the set instruction.
3788
3789 @item Q
3790 Memory location with A base register.
3791
3792 @item R
3793 Memory location with B base register.
3794
3795 @ifset INTERNALS
3796 @item S0
3797 On C64x+ targets, a GP-relative small data reference.
3798
3799 @item S1
3800 Any kind of @code{SYMBOL_REF}, for use in a call address.
3801
3802 @item Si
3803 Any kind of immediate operand, unless it matches the S0 constraint.
3804
3805 @item T
3806 Memory location with B base register, but not using a long offset.
3807
3808 @item W
3809 A memory operand with an address that cannot be used in an unaligned access.
3810
3811 @end ifset
3812 @item Z
3813 Register B14 (aka DP).
3814
3815 @end table
3816
3817 @item TILE-Gx---@file{config/tilegx/constraints.md}
3818 @table @code
3819 @item R00
3820 @itemx R01
3821 @itemx R02
3822 @itemx R03
3823 @itemx R04
3824 @itemx R05
3825 @itemx R06
3826 @itemx R07
3827 @itemx R08
3828 @itemx R09
3829 @itemx R10
3830 Each of these represents a register constraint for an individual
3831 register, from r0 to r10.
3832
3833 @item I
3834 Signed 8-bit integer constant.
3835
3836 @item J
3837 Signed 16-bit integer constant.
3838
3839 @item K
3840 Unsigned 16-bit integer constant.
3841
3842 @item L
3843 Integer constant that fits in one signed byte when incremented by one
3844 (@minus{}129 @dots{} 126).
3845
3846 @item m
3847 Memory operand. If used together with @samp{<} or @samp{>}, the
3848 operand can have postincrement which requires printing with @samp{%In}
3849 and @samp{%in} on TILE-Gx. For example:
3850
3851 @smallexample
3852 asm ("st_add %I0,%1,%i0" : "=m<>" (*mem) : "r" (val));
3853 @end smallexample
3854
3855 @item M
3856 A bit mask suitable for the BFINS instruction.
3857
3858 @item N
3859 Integer constant that is a byte tiled out eight times.
3860
3861 @item O
3862 The integer zero constant.
3863
3864 @item P
3865 Integer constant that is a sign-extended byte tiled out as four shorts.
3866
3867 @item Q
3868 Integer constant that fits in one signed byte when incremented
3869 (@minus{}129 @dots{} 126), but excluding -1.
3870
3871 @item S
3872 Integer constant that has all 1 bits consecutive and starting at bit 0.
3873
3874 @item T
3875 A 16-bit fragment of a got, tls, or pc-relative reference.
3876
3877 @item U
3878 Memory operand except postincrement. This is roughly the same as
3879 @samp{m} when not used together with @samp{<} or @samp{>}.
3880
3881 @item W
3882 An 8-element vector constant with identical elements.
3883
3884 @item Y
3885 A 4-element vector constant with identical elements.
3886
3887 @item Z0
3888 The integer constant 0xffffffff.
3889
3890 @item Z1
3891 The integer constant 0xffffffff00000000.
3892
3893 @end table
3894
3895 @item TILEPro---@file{config/tilepro/constraints.md}
3896 @table @code
3897 @item R00
3898 @itemx R01
3899 @itemx R02
3900 @itemx R03
3901 @itemx R04
3902 @itemx R05
3903 @itemx R06
3904 @itemx R07
3905 @itemx R08
3906 @itemx R09
3907 @itemx R10
3908 Each of these represents a register constraint for an individual
3909 register, from r0 to r10.
3910
3911 @item I
3912 Signed 8-bit integer constant.
3913
3914 @item J
3915 Signed 16-bit integer constant.
3916
3917 @item K
3918 Nonzero integer constant with low 16 bits zero.
3919
3920 @item L
3921 Integer constant that fits in one signed byte when incremented by one
3922 (@minus{}129 @dots{} 126).
3923
3924 @item m
3925 Memory operand. If used together with @samp{<} or @samp{>}, the
3926 operand can have postincrement which requires printing with @samp{%In}
3927 and @samp{%in} on TILEPro. For example:
3928
3929 @smallexample
3930 asm ("swadd %I0,%1,%i0" : "=m<>" (mem) : "r" (val));
3931 @end smallexample
3932
3933 @item M
3934 A bit mask suitable for the MM instruction.
3935
3936 @item N
3937 Integer constant that is a byte tiled out four times.
3938
3939 @item O
3940 The integer zero constant.
3941
3942 @item P
3943 Integer constant that is a sign-extended byte tiled out as two shorts.
3944
3945 @item Q
3946 Integer constant that fits in one signed byte when incremented
3947 (@minus{}129 @dots{} 126), but excluding -1.
3948
3949 @item T
3950 A symbolic operand, or a 16-bit fragment of a got, tls, or pc-relative
3951 reference.
3952
3953 @item U
3954 Memory operand except postincrement. This is roughly the same as
3955 @samp{m} when not used together with @samp{<} or @samp{>}.
3956
3957 @item W
3958 A 4-element vector constant with identical elements.
3959
3960 @item Y
3961 A 2-element vector constant with identical elements.
3962
3963 @end table
3964
3965 @item Visium---@file{config/visium/constraints.md}
3966 @table @code
3967 @item b
3968 EAM register @code{mdb}
3969
3970 @item c
3971 EAM register @code{mdc}
3972
3973 @item f
3974 Floating point register
3975
3976 @ifset INTERNALS
3977 @item k
3978 Register for sibcall optimization
3979 @end ifset
3980
3981 @item l
3982 General register, but not @code{r29}, @code{r30} and @code{r31}
3983
3984 @item t
3985 Register @code{r1}
3986
3987 @item u
3988 Register @code{r2}
3989
3990 @item v
3991 Register @code{r3}
3992
3993 @item G
3994 Floating-point constant 0.0
3995
3996 @item J
3997 Integer constant in the range 0 .. 65535 (16-bit immediate)
3998
3999 @item K
4000 Integer constant in the range 1 .. 31 (5-bit immediate)
4001
4002 @item L
4003 Integer constant in the range @minus{}65535 .. @minus{}1 (16-bit negative immediate)
4004
4005 @item M
4006 Integer constant @minus{}1
4007
4008 @item O
4009 Integer constant 0
4010
4011 @item P
4012 Integer constant 32
4013 @end table
4014
4015 @item x86 family---@file{config/i386/constraints.md}
4016 @table @code
4017 @item R
4018 Legacy register---the eight integer registers available on all
4019 i386 processors (@code{a}, @code{b}, @code{c}, @code{d},
4020 @code{si}, @code{di}, @code{bp}, @code{sp}).
4021
4022 @item q
4023 Any register accessible as @code{@var{r}l}. In 32-bit mode, @code{a},
4024 @code{b}, @code{c}, and @code{d}; in 64-bit mode, any integer register.
4025
4026 @item Q
4027 Any register accessible as @code{@var{r}h}: @code{a}, @code{b},
4028 @code{c}, and @code{d}.
4029
4030 @ifset INTERNALS
4031 @item l
4032 Any register that can be used as the index in a base+index memory
4033 access: that is, any general register except the stack pointer.
4034 @end ifset
4035
4036 @item a
4037 The @code{a} register.
4038
4039 @item b
4040 The @code{b} register.
4041
4042 @item c
4043 The @code{c} register.
4044
4045 @item d
4046 The @code{d} register.
4047
4048 @item S
4049 The @code{si} register.
4050
4051 @item D
4052 The @code{di} register.
4053
4054 @item A
4055 The @code{a} and @code{d} registers. This class is used for instructions
4056 that return double word results in the @code{ax:dx} register pair. Single
4057 word values will be allocated either in @code{ax} or @code{dx}.
4058 For example on i386 the following implements @code{rdtsc}:
4059
4060 @smallexample
4061 unsigned long long rdtsc (void)
4062 @{
4063 unsigned long long tick;
4064 __asm__ __volatile__("rdtsc":"=A"(tick));
4065 return tick;
4066 @}
4067 @end smallexample
4068
4069 This is not correct on x86-64 as it would allocate tick in either @code{ax}
4070 or @code{dx}. You have to use the following variant instead:
4071
4072 @smallexample
4073 unsigned long long rdtsc (void)
4074 @{
4075 unsigned int tickl, tickh;
4076 __asm__ __volatile__("rdtsc":"=a"(tickl),"=d"(tickh));
4077 return ((unsigned long long)tickh << 32)|tickl;
4078 @}
4079 @end smallexample
4080
4081 @item U
4082 The call-clobbered integer registers.
4083
4084 @item f
4085 Any 80387 floating-point (stack) register.
4086
4087 @item t
4088 Top of 80387 floating-point stack (@code{%st(0)}).
4089
4090 @item u
4091 Second from top of 80387 floating-point stack (@code{%st(1)}).
4092
4093 @ifset INTERNALS
4094 @item Yk
4095 Any mask register that can be used as a predicate, i.e.@: @code{k1-k7}.
4096
4097 @item k
4098 Any mask register.
4099 @end ifset
4100
4101 @item y
4102 Any MMX register.
4103
4104 @item x
4105 Any SSE register.
4106
4107 @item v
4108 Any EVEX encodable SSE register (@code{%xmm0-%xmm31}).
4109
4110 @ifset INTERNALS
4111 @item w
4112 Any bound register.
4113 @end ifset
4114
4115 @item Yz
4116 First SSE register (@code{%xmm0}).
4117
4118 @ifset INTERNALS
4119 @item Yi
4120 Any SSE register, when SSE2 and inter-unit moves are enabled.
4121
4122 @item Yj
4123 Any SSE register, when SSE2 and inter-unit moves from vector registers are enabled.
4124
4125 @item Ym
4126 Any MMX register, when inter-unit moves are enabled.
4127
4128 @item Yn
4129 Any MMX register, when inter-unit moves from vector registers are enabled.
4130
4131 @item Yp
4132 Any integer register when @code{TARGET_PARTIAL_REG_STALL} is disabled.
4133
4134 @item Ya
4135 Any integer register when zero extensions with @code{AND} are disabled.
4136
4137 @item Yb
4138 Any register that can be used as the GOT base when calling@*
4139 @code{___tls_get_addr}: that is, any general register except @code{a}
4140 and @code{sp} registers, for @option{-fno-plt} if linker supports it.
4141 Otherwise, @code{b} register.
4142
4143 @item Yf
4144 Any x87 register when 80387 floating-point arithmetic is enabled.
4145
4146 @item Yr
4147 Lower SSE register when avoiding REX prefix and all SSE registers otherwise.
4148
4149 @item Yv
4150 For AVX512VL, any EVEX-encodable SSE register (@code{%xmm0-%xmm31}),
4151 otherwise any SSE register.
4152
4153 @item Yh
4154 Any EVEX-encodable SSE register, that has number factor of four.
4155
4156 @item Bf
4157 Flags register operand.
4158
4159 @item Bg
4160 GOT memory operand.
4161
4162 @item Bm
4163 Vector memory operand.
4164
4165 @item Bc
4166 Constant memory operand.
4167
4168 @item Bn
4169 Memory operand without REX prefix.
4170
4171 @item Bs
4172 Sibcall memory operand.
4173
4174 @item Bw
4175 Call memory operand.
4176
4177 @item Bz
4178 Constant call address operand.
4179
4180 @item BC
4181 SSE constant -1 operand.
4182 @end ifset
4183
4184 @item I
4185 Integer constant in the range 0 @dots{} 31, for 32-bit shifts.
4186
4187 @item J
4188 Integer constant in the range 0 @dots{} 63, for 64-bit shifts.
4189
4190 @item K
4191 Signed 8-bit integer constant.
4192
4193 @item L
4194 @code{0xFF} or @code{0xFFFF}, for andsi as a zero-extending move.
4195
4196 @item M
4197 0, 1, 2, or 3 (shifts for the @code{lea} instruction).
4198
4199 @item N
4200 Unsigned 8-bit integer constant (for @code{in} and @code{out}
4201 instructions).
4202
4203 @ifset INTERNALS
4204 @item O
4205 Integer constant in the range 0 @dots{} 127, for 128-bit shifts.
4206 @end ifset
4207
4208 @item G
4209 Standard 80387 floating point constant.
4210
4211 @item C
4212 SSE constant zero operand.
4213
4214 @item e
4215 32-bit signed integer constant, or a symbolic reference known
4216 to fit that range (for immediate operands in sign-extending x86-64
4217 instructions).
4218
4219 @item We
4220 32-bit signed integer constant, or a symbolic reference known
4221 to fit that range (for sign-extending conversion operations that
4222 require non-@code{VOIDmode} immediate operands).
4223
4224 @item Wz
4225 32-bit unsigned integer constant, or a symbolic reference known
4226 to fit that range (for zero-extending conversion operations that
4227 require non-@code{VOIDmode} immediate operands).
4228
4229 @item Wd
4230 128-bit integer constant where both the high and low 64-bit word
4231 satisfy the @code{e} constraint.
4232
4233 @item Z
4234 32-bit unsigned integer constant, or a symbolic reference known
4235 to fit that range (for immediate operands in zero-extending x86-64
4236 instructions).
4237
4238 @item Tv
4239 VSIB address operand.
4240
4241 @item Ts
4242 Address operand without segment register.
4243
4244 @end table
4245
4246 @item Xstormy16---@file{config/stormy16/stormy16.h}
4247 @table @code
4248 @item a
4249 Register r0.
4250
4251 @item b
4252 Register r1.
4253
4254 @item c
4255 Register r2.
4256
4257 @item d
4258 Register r8.
4259
4260 @item e
4261 Registers r0 through r7.
4262
4263 @item t
4264 Registers r0 and r1.
4265
4266 @item y
4267 The carry register.
4268
4269 @item z
4270 Registers r8 and r9.
4271
4272 @item I
4273 A constant between 0 and 3 inclusive.
4274
4275 @item J
4276 A constant that has exactly one bit set.
4277
4278 @item K
4279 A constant that has exactly one bit clear.
4280
4281 @item L
4282 A constant between 0 and 255 inclusive.
4283
4284 @item M
4285 A constant between @minus{}255 and 0 inclusive.
4286
4287 @item N
4288 A constant between @minus{}3 and 0 inclusive.
4289
4290 @item O
4291 A constant between 1 and 4 inclusive.
4292
4293 @item P
4294 A constant between @minus{}4 and @minus{}1 inclusive.
4295
4296 @item Q
4297 A memory reference that is a stack push.
4298
4299 @item R
4300 A memory reference that is a stack pop.
4301
4302 @item S
4303 A memory reference that refers to a constant address of known value.
4304
4305 @item T
4306 The register indicated by Rx (not implemented yet).
4307
4308 @item U
4309 A constant that is not between 2 and 15 inclusive.
4310
4311 @item Z
4312 The constant 0.
4313
4314 @end table
4315
4316 @item Xtensa---@file{config/xtensa/constraints.md}
4317 @table @code
4318 @item a
4319 General-purpose 32-bit register
4320
4321 @item b
4322 One-bit boolean register
4323
4324 @item A
4325 MAC16 40-bit accumulator register
4326
4327 @item I
4328 Signed 12-bit integer constant, for use in MOVI instructions
4329
4330 @item J
4331 Signed 8-bit integer constant, for use in ADDI instructions
4332
4333 @item K
4334 Integer constant valid for BccI instructions
4335
4336 @item L
4337 Unsigned constant valid for BccUI instructions
4338
4339 @end table
4340
4341 @end table
4342
4343 @ifset INTERNALS
4344 @node Disable Insn Alternatives
4345 @subsection Disable insn alternatives using the @code{enabled} attribute
4346 @cindex enabled
4347
4348 There are three insn attributes that may be used to selectively disable
4349 instruction alternatives:
4350
4351 @table @code
4352 @item enabled
4353 Says whether an alternative is available on the current subtarget.
4354
4355 @item preferred_for_size
4356 Says whether an enabled alternative should be used in code that is
4357 optimized for size.
4358
4359 @item preferred_for_speed
4360 Says whether an enabled alternative should be used in code that is
4361 optimized for speed.
4362 @end table
4363
4364 All these attributes should use @code{(const_int 1)} to allow an alternative
4365 or @code{(const_int 0)} to disallow it. The attributes must be a static
4366 property of the subtarget; they cannot for example depend on the
4367 current operands, on the current optimization level, on the location
4368 of the insn within the body of a loop, on whether register allocation
4369 has finished, or on the current compiler pass.
4370
4371 The @code{enabled} attribute is a correctness property. It tells GCC to act
4372 as though the disabled alternatives were never defined in the first place.
4373 This is useful when adding new instructions to an existing pattern in
4374 cases where the new instructions are only available for certain cpu
4375 architecture levels (typically mapped to the @code{-march=} command-line
4376 option).
4377
4378 In contrast, the @code{preferred_for_size} and @code{preferred_for_speed}
4379 attributes are strong optimization hints rather than correctness properties.
4380 @code{preferred_for_size} tells GCC which alternatives to consider when
4381 adding or modifying an instruction that GCC wants to optimize for size.
4382 @code{preferred_for_speed} does the same thing for speed. Note that things
4383 like code motion can lead to cases where code optimized for size uses
4384 alternatives that are not preferred for size, and similarly for speed.
4385
4386 Although @code{define_insn}s can in principle specify the @code{enabled}
4387 attribute directly, it is often clearer to have subsiduary attributes
4388 for each architectural feature of interest. The @code{define_insn}s
4389 can then use these subsiduary attributes to say which alternatives
4390 require which features. The example below does this for @code{cpu_facility}.
4391
4392 E.g. the following two patterns could easily be merged using the @code{enabled}
4393 attribute:
4394
4395 @smallexample
4396
4397 (define_insn "*movdi_old"
4398 [(set (match_operand:DI 0 "register_operand" "=d")
4399 (match_operand:DI 1 "register_operand" " d"))]
4400 "!TARGET_NEW"
4401 "lgr %0,%1")
4402
4403 (define_insn "*movdi_new"
4404 [(set (match_operand:DI 0 "register_operand" "=d,f,d")
4405 (match_operand:DI 1 "register_operand" " d,d,f"))]
4406 "TARGET_NEW"
4407 "@@
4408 lgr %0,%1
4409 ldgr %0,%1
4410 lgdr %0,%1")
4411
4412 @end smallexample
4413
4414 to:
4415
4416 @smallexample
4417
4418 (define_insn "*movdi_combined"
4419 [(set (match_operand:DI 0 "register_operand" "=d,f,d")
4420 (match_operand:DI 1 "register_operand" " d,d,f"))]
4421 ""
4422 "@@
4423 lgr %0,%1
4424 ldgr %0,%1
4425 lgdr %0,%1"
4426 [(set_attr "cpu_facility" "*,new,new")])
4427
4428 @end smallexample
4429
4430 with the @code{enabled} attribute defined like this:
4431
4432 @smallexample
4433
4434 (define_attr "cpu_facility" "standard,new" (const_string "standard"))
4435
4436 (define_attr "enabled" ""
4437 (cond [(eq_attr "cpu_facility" "standard") (const_int 1)
4438 (and (eq_attr "cpu_facility" "new")
4439 (ne (symbol_ref "TARGET_NEW") (const_int 0)))
4440 (const_int 1)]
4441 (const_int 0)))
4442
4443 @end smallexample
4444
4445 @end ifset
4446
4447 @ifset INTERNALS
4448 @node Define Constraints
4449 @subsection Defining Machine-Specific Constraints
4450 @cindex defining constraints
4451 @cindex constraints, defining
4452
4453 Machine-specific constraints fall into two categories: register and
4454 non-register constraints. Within the latter category, constraints
4455 which allow subsets of all possible memory or address operands should
4456 be specially marked, to give @code{reload} more information.
4457
4458 Machine-specific constraints can be given names of arbitrary length,
4459 but they must be entirely composed of letters, digits, underscores
4460 (@samp{_}), and angle brackets (@samp{< >}). Like C identifiers, they
4461 must begin with a letter or underscore.
4462
4463 In order to avoid ambiguity in operand constraint strings, no
4464 constraint can have a name that begins with any other constraint's
4465 name. For example, if @code{x} is defined as a constraint name,
4466 @code{xy} may not be, and vice versa. As a consequence of this rule,
4467 no constraint may begin with one of the generic constraint letters:
4468 @samp{E F V X g i m n o p r s}.
4469
4470 Register constraints correspond directly to register classes.
4471 @xref{Register Classes}. There is thus not much flexibility in their
4472 definitions.
4473
4474 @deffn {MD Expression} define_register_constraint name regclass docstring
4475 All three arguments are string constants.
4476 @var{name} is the name of the constraint, as it will appear in
4477 @code{match_operand} expressions. If @var{name} is a multi-letter
4478 constraint its length shall be the same for all constraints starting
4479 with the same letter. @var{regclass} can be either the
4480 name of the corresponding register class (@pxref{Register Classes}),
4481 or a C expression which evaluates to the appropriate register class.
4482 If it is an expression, it must have no side effects, and it cannot
4483 look at the operand. The usual use of expressions is to map some
4484 register constraints to @code{NO_REGS} when the register class
4485 is not available on a given subarchitecture.
4486
4487 @var{docstring} is a sentence documenting the meaning of the
4488 constraint. Docstrings are explained further below.
4489 @end deffn
4490
4491 Non-register constraints are more like predicates: the constraint
4492 definition gives a boolean expression which indicates whether the
4493 constraint matches.
4494
4495 @deffn {MD Expression} define_constraint name docstring exp
4496 The @var{name} and @var{docstring} arguments are the same as for
4497 @code{define_register_constraint}, but note that the docstring comes
4498 immediately after the name for these expressions. @var{exp} is an RTL
4499 expression, obeying the same rules as the RTL expressions in predicate
4500 definitions. @xref{Defining Predicates}, for details. If it
4501 evaluates true, the constraint matches; if it evaluates false, it
4502 doesn't. Constraint expressions should indicate which RTL codes they
4503 might match, just like predicate expressions.
4504
4505 @code{match_test} C expressions have access to the
4506 following variables:
4507
4508 @table @var
4509 @item op
4510 The RTL object defining the operand.
4511 @item mode
4512 The machine mode of @var{op}.
4513 @item ival
4514 @samp{INTVAL (@var{op})}, if @var{op} is a @code{const_int}.
4515 @item hval
4516 @samp{CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (@var{op})}, if @var{op} is an integer
4517 @code{const_double}.
4518 @item lval
4519 @samp{CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (@var{op})}, if @var{op} is an integer
4520 @code{const_double}.
4521 @item rval
4522 @samp{CONST_DOUBLE_REAL_VALUE (@var{op})}, if @var{op} is a floating-point
4523 @code{const_double}.
4524 @end table
4525
4526 The @var{*val} variables should only be used once another piece of the
4527 expression has verified that @var{op} is the appropriate kind of RTL
4528 object.
4529 @end deffn
4530
4531 Most non-register constraints should be defined with
4532 @code{define_constraint}. The remaining two definition expressions
4533 are only appropriate for constraints that should be handled specially
4534 by @code{reload} if they fail to match.
4535
4536 @deffn {MD Expression} define_memory_constraint name docstring exp
4537 Use this expression for constraints that match a subset of all memory
4538 operands: that is, @code{reload} can make them match by converting the
4539 operand to the form @samp{@w{(mem (reg @var{X}))}}, where @var{X} is a
4540 base register (from the register class specified by
4541 @code{BASE_REG_CLASS}, @pxref{Register Classes}).
4542
4543 For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
4544 memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
4545 register. The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined to represent a
4546 memory address of this type. If @samp{Q} is defined with
4547 @code{define_memory_constraint}, a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any
4548 memory operand, because @code{reload} knows it can simply copy the
4549 memory address into a base register if required. This is analogous to
4550 the way an @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
4551
4552 The syntax and semantics are otherwise identical to
4553 @code{define_constraint}.
4554 @end deffn
4555
4556 @deffn {MD Expression} define_special_memory_constraint name docstring exp
4557 Use this expression for constraints that match a subset of all memory
4558 operands: that is, @code{reload} cannot make them match by reloading
4559 the address as it is described for @code{define_memory_constraint} or
4560 such address reload is undesirable with the performance point of view.
4561
4562 For example, @code{define_special_memory_constraint} can be useful if
4563 specifically aligned memory is necessary or desirable for some insn
4564 operand.
4565
4566 The syntax and semantics are otherwise identical to
4567 @code{define_constraint}.
4568 @end deffn
4569
4570 @deffn {MD Expression} define_address_constraint name docstring exp
4571 Use this expression for constraints that match a subset of all address
4572 operands: that is, @code{reload} can make the constraint match by
4573 converting the operand to the form @samp{@w{(reg @var{X})}}, again
4574 with @var{X} a base register.
4575
4576 Constraints defined with @code{define_address_constraint} can only be
4577 used with the @code{address_operand} predicate, or machine-specific
4578 predicates that work the same way. They are treated analogously to
4579 the generic @samp{p} constraint.
4580
4581 The syntax and semantics are otherwise identical to
4582 @code{define_constraint}.
4583 @end deffn
4584
4585 For historical reasons, names beginning with the letters @samp{G H}
4586 are reserved for constraints that match only @code{const_double}s, and
4587 names beginning with the letters @samp{I J K L M N O P} are reserved
4588 for constraints that match only @code{const_int}s. This may change in
4589 the future. For the time being, constraints with these names must be
4590 written in a stylized form, so that @code{genpreds} can tell you did
4591 it correctly:
4592
4593 @smallexample
4594 @group
4595 (define_constraint "[@var{GHIJKLMNOP}]@dots{}"
4596 "@var{doc}@dots{}"
4597 (and (match_code "const_int") ; @r{@code{const_double} for G/H}
4598 @var{condition}@dots{})) ; @r{usually a @code{match_test}}
4599 @end group
4600 @end smallexample
4601 @c the semicolons line up in the formatted manual
4602
4603 It is fine to use names beginning with other letters for constraints
4604 that match @code{const_double}s or @code{const_int}s.
4605
4606 Each docstring in a constraint definition should be one or more complete
4607 sentences, marked up in Texinfo format. @emph{They are currently unused.}
4608 In the future they will be copied into the GCC manual, in @ref{Machine
4609 Constraints}, replacing the hand-maintained tables currently found in
4610 that section. Also, in the future the compiler may use this to give
4611 more helpful diagnostics when poor choice of @code{asm} constraints
4612 causes a reload failure.
4613
4614 If you put the pseudo-Texinfo directive @samp{@@internal} at the
4615 beginning of a docstring, then (in the future) it will appear only in
4616 the internals manual's version of the machine-specific constraint tables.
4617 Use this for constraints that should not appear in @code{asm} statements.
4618
4619 @node C Constraint Interface
4620 @subsection Testing constraints from C
4621 @cindex testing constraints
4622 @cindex constraints, testing
4623
4624 It is occasionally useful to test a constraint from C code rather than
4625 implicitly via the constraint string in a @code{match_operand}. The
4626 generated file @file{tm_p.h} declares a few interfaces for working
4627 with constraints. At present these are defined for all constraints
4628 except @code{g} (which is equivalent to @code{general_operand}).
4629
4630 Some valid constraint names are not valid C identifiers, so there is a
4631 mangling scheme for referring to them from C@. Constraint names that
4632 do not contain angle brackets or underscores are left unchanged.
4633 Underscores are doubled, each @samp{<} is replaced with @samp{_l}, and
4634 each @samp{>} with @samp{_g}. Here are some examples:
4635
4636 @c the @c's prevent double blank lines in the printed manual.
4637 @example
4638 @multitable {Original} {Mangled}
4639 @item @strong{Original} @tab @strong{Mangled} @c
4640 @item @code{x} @tab @code{x} @c
4641 @item @code{P42x} @tab @code{P42x} @c
4642 @item @code{P4_x} @tab @code{P4__x} @c
4643 @item @code{P4>x} @tab @code{P4_gx} @c
4644 @item @code{P4>>} @tab @code{P4_g_g} @c
4645 @item @code{P4_g>} @tab @code{P4__g_g} @c
4646 @end multitable
4647 @end example
4648
4649 Throughout this section, the variable @var{c} is either a constraint
4650 in the abstract sense, or a constant from @code{enum constraint_num};
4651 the variable @var{m} is a mangled constraint name (usually as part of
4652 a larger identifier).
4653
4654 @deftp Enum constraint_num
4655 For each constraint except @code{g}, there is a corresponding
4656 enumeration constant: @samp{CONSTRAINT_} plus the mangled name of the
4657 constraint. Functions that take an @code{enum constraint_num} as an
4658 argument expect one of these constants.
4659 @end deftp
4660
4661 @deftypefun {inline bool} satisfies_constraint_@var{m} (rtx @var{exp})
4662 For each non-register constraint @var{m} except @code{g}, there is
4663 one of these functions; it returns @code{true} if @var{exp} satisfies the
4664 constraint. These functions are only visible if @file{rtl.h} was included
4665 before @file{tm_p.h}.
4666 @end deftypefun
4667
4668 @deftypefun bool constraint_satisfied_p (rtx @var{exp}, enum constraint_num @var{c})
4669 Like the @code{satisfies_constraint_@var{m}} functions, but the
4670 constraint to test is given as an argument, @var{c}. If @var{c}
4671 specifies a register constraint, this function will always return
4672 @code{false}.
4673 @end deftypefun
4674
4675 @deftypefun {enum reg_class} reg_class_for_constraint (enum constraint_num @var{c})
4676 Returns the register class associated with @var{c}. If @var{c} is not
4677 a register constraint, or those registers are not available for the
4678 currently selected subtarget, returns @code{NO_REGS}.
4679 @end deftypefun
4680
4681 Here is an example use of @code{satisfies_constraint_@var{m}}. In
4682 peephole optimizations (@pxref{Peephole Definitions}), operand
4683 constraint strings are ignored, so if there are relevant constraints,
4684 they must be tested in the C condition. In the example, the
4685 optimization is applied if operand 2 does @emph{not} satisfy the
4686 @samp{K} constraint. (This is a simplified version of a peephole
4687 definition from the i386 machine description.)
4688
4689 @smallexample
4690 (define_peephole2
4691 [(match_scratch:SI 3 "r")
4692 (set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "")
4693 (mult:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "memory_operand" "")
4694 (match_operand:SI 2 "immediate_operand" "")))]
4695
4696 "!satisfies_constraint_K (operands[2])"
4697
4698 [(set (match_dup 3) (match_dup 1))
4699 (set (match_dup 0) (mult:SI (match_dup 3) (match_dup 2)))]
4700
4701 "")
4702 @end smallexample
4703
4704 @node Standard Names
4705 @section Standard Pattern Names For Generation
4706 @cindex standard pattern names
4707 @cindex pattern names
4708 @cindex names, pattern
4709
4710 Here is a table of the instruction names that are meaningful in the RTL
4711 generation pass of the compiler. Giving one of these names to an
4712 instruction pattern tells the RTL generation pass that it can use the
4713 pattern to accomplish a certain task.
4714
4715 @table @asis
4716 @cindex @code{mov@var{m}} instruction pattern
4717 @item @samp{mov@var{m}}
4718 Here @var{m} stands for a two-letter machine mode name, in lowercase.
4719 This instruction pattern moves data with that machine mode from operand
4720 1 to operand 0. For example, @samp{movsi} moves full-word data.
4721
4722 If operand 0 is a @code{subreg} with mode @var{m} of a register whose
4723 own mode is wider than @var{m}, the effect of this instruction is
4724 to store the specified value in the part of the register that corresponds
4725 to mode @var{m}. Bits outside of @var{m}, but which are within the
4726 same target word as the @code{subreg} are undefined. Bits which are
4727 outside the target word are left unchanged.
4728
4729 This class of patterns is special in several ways. First of all, each
4730 of these names up to and including full word size @emph{must} be defined,
4731 because there is no other way to copy a datum from one place to another.
4732 If there are patterns accepting operands in larger modes,
4733 @samp{mov@var{m}} must be defined for integer modes of those sizes.
4734
4735 Second, these patterns are not used solely in the RTL generation pass.
4736 Even the reload pass can generate move insns to copy values from stack
4737 slots into temporary registers. When it does so, one of the operands is
4738 a hard register and the other is an operand that can need to be reloaded
4739 into a register.
4740
4741 @findex force_reg
4742 Therefore, when given such a pair of operands, the pattern must generate
4743 RTL which needs no reloading and needs no temporary registers---no
4744 registers other than the operands. For example, if you support the
4745 pattern with a @code{define_expand}, then in such a case the
4746 @code{define_expand} mustn't call @code{force_reg} or any other such
4747 function which might generate new pseudo registers.
4748
4749 This requirement exists even for subword modes on a RISC machine where
4750 fetching those modes from memory normally requires several insns and
4751 some temporary registers.
4752
4753 @findex change_address
4754 During reload a memory reference with an invalid address may be passed
4755 as an operand. Such an address will be replaced with a valid address
4756 later in the reload pass. In this case, nothing may be done with the
4757 address except to use it as it stands. If it is copied, it will not be
4758 replaced with a valid address. No attempt should be made to make such
4759 an address into a valid address and no routine (such as
4760 @code{change_address}) that will do so may be called. Note that
4761 @code{general_operand} will fail when applied to such an address.
4762
4763 @findex reload_in_progress
4764 The global variable @code{reload_in_progress} (which must be explicitly
4765 declared if required) can be used to determine whether such special
4766 handling is required.
4767
4768 The variety of operands that have reloads depends on the rest of the
4769 machine description, but typically on a RISC machine these can only be
4770 pseudo registers that did not get hard registers, while on other
4771 machines explicit memory references will get optional reloads.
4772
4773 If a scratch register is required to move an object to or from memory,
4774 it can be allocated using @code{gen_reg_rtx} prior to life analysis.
4775
4776 If there are cases which need scratch registers during or after reload,
4777 you must provide an appropriate secondary_reload target hook.
4778
4779 @findex can_create_pseudo_p
4780 The macro @code{can_create_pseudo_p} can be used to determine if it
4781 is unsafe to create new pseudo registers. If this variable is nonzero, then
4782 it is unsafe to call @code{gen_reg_rtx} to allocate a new pseudo.
4783
4784 The constraints on a @samp{mov@var{m}} must permit moving any hard
4785 register to any other hard register provided that
4786 @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} permits mode @var{m} in both registers and
4787 @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their classes returns a value
4788 of 2.
4789
4790 It is obligatory to support floating point @samp{mov@var{m}}
4791 instructions into and out of any registers that can hold fixed point
4792 values, because unions and structures (which have modes @code{SImode} or
4793 @code{DImode}) can be in those registers and they may have floating
4794 point members.
4795
4796 There may also be a need to support fixed point @samp{mov@var{m}}
4797 instructions in and out of floating point registers. Unfortunately, I
4798 have forgotten why this was so, and I don't know whether it is still
4799 true. If @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} rejects fixed point values in
4800 floating point registers, then the constraints of the fixed point
4801 @samp{mov@var{m}} instructions must be designed to avoid ever trying to
4802 reload into a floating point register.
4803
4804 @cindex @code{reload_in} instruction pattern
4805 @cindex @code{reload_out} instruction pattern
4806 @item @samp{reload_in@var{m}}
4807 @itemx @samp{reload_out@var{m}}
4808 These named patterns have been obsoleted by the target hook
4809 @code{secondary_reload}.
4810
4811 Like @samp{mov@var{m}}, but used when a scratch register is required to
4812 move between operand 0 and operand 1. Operand 2 describes the scratch
4813 register. See the discussion of the @code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS}
4814 macro in @pxref{Register Classes}.
4815
4816 There are special restrictions on the form of the @code{match_operand}s
4817 used in these patterns. First, only the predicate for the reload
4818 operand is examined, i.e., @code{reload_in} examines operand 1, but not
4819 the predicates for operand 0 or 2. Second, there may be only one
4820 alternative in the constraints. Third, only a single register class
4821 letter may be used for the constraint; subsequent constraint letters
4822 are ignored. As a special exception, an empty constraint string
4823 matches the @code{ALL_REGS} register class. This may relieve ports
4824 of the burden of defining an @code{ALL_REGS} constraint letter just
4825 for these patterns.
4826
4827 @cindex @code{movstrict@var{m}} instruction pattern
4828 @item @samp{movstrict@var{m}}
4829 Like @samp{mov@var{m}} except that if operand 0 is a @code{subreg}
4830 with mode @var{m} of a register whose natural mode is wider,
4831 the @samp{movstrict@var{m}} instruction is guaranteed not to alter
4832 any of the register except the part which belongs to mode @var{m}.
4833
4834 @cindex @code{movmisalign@var{m}} instruction pattern
4835 @item @samp{movmisalign@var{m}}
4836 This variant of a move pattern is designed to load or store a value
4837 from a memory address that is not naturally aligned for its mode.
4838 For a store, the memory will be in operand 0; for a load, the memory
4839 will be in operand 1. The other operand is guaranteed not to be a
4840 memory, so that it's easy to tell whether this is a load or store.
4841
4842 This pattern is used by the autovectorizer, and when expanding a
4843 @code{MISALIGNED_INDIRECT_REF} expression.
4844
4845 @cindex @code{load_multiple} instruction pattern
4846 @item @samp{load_multiple}
4847 Load several consecutive memory locations into consecutive registers.
4848 Operand 0 is the first of the consecutive registers, operand 1
4849 is the first memory location, and operand 2 is a constant: the
4850 number of consecutive registers.
4851
4852 Define this only if the target machine really has such an instruction;
4853 do not define this if the most efficient way of loading consecutive
4854 registers from memory is to do them one at a time.
4855
4856 On some machines, there are restrictions as to which consecutive
4857 registers can be stored into memory, such as particular starting or
4858 ending register numbers or only a range of valid counts. For those
4859 machines, use a @code{define_expand} (@pxref{Expander Definitions})
4860 and make the pattern fail if the restrictions are not met.
4861
4862 Write the generated insn as a @code{parallel} with elements being a
4863 @code{set} of one register from the appropriate memory location (you may
4864 also need @code{use} or @code{clobber} elements). Use a
4865 @code{match_parallel} (@pxref{RTL Template}) to recognize the insn. See
4866 @file{rs6000.md} for examples of the use of this insn pattern.
4867
4868 @cindex @samp{store_multiple} instruction pattern
4869 @item @samp{store_multiple}
4870 Similar to @samp{load_multiple}, but store several consecutive registers
4871 into consecutive memory locations. Operand 0 is the first of the
4872 consecutive memory locations, operand 1 is the first register, and
4873 operand 2 is a constant: the number of consecutive registers.
4874
4875 @cindex @code{vec_load_lanes@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
4876 @item @samp{vec_load_lanes@var{m}@var{n}}
4877 Perform an interleaved load of several vectors from memory operand 1
4878 into register operand 0. Both operands have mode @var{m}. The register
4879 operand is viewed as holding consecutive vectors of mode @var{n},
4880 while the memory operand is a flat array that contains the same number
4881 of elements. The operation is equivalent to:
4882
4883 @smallexample
4884 int c = GET_MODE_SIZE (@var{m}) / GET_MODE_SIZE (@var{n});
4885 for (j = 0; j < GET_MODE_NUNITS (@var{n}); j++)
4886 for (i = 0; i < c; i++)
4887 operand0[i][j] = operand1[j * c + i];
4888 @end smallexample
4889
4890 For example, @samp{vec_load_lanestiv4hi} loads 8 16-bit values
4891 from memory into a register of mode @samp{TI}@. The register
4892 contains two consecutive vectors of mode @samp{V4HI}@.
4893
4894 This pattern can only be used if:
4895 @smallexample
4896 TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (@var{n}, @var{c})
4897 @end smallexample
4898 is true. GCC assumes that, if a target supports this kind of
4899 instruction for some mode @var{n}, it also supports unaligned
4900 loads for vectors of mode @var{n}.
4901
4902 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
4903
4904 @cindex @code{vec_mask_load_lanes@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
4905 @item @samp{vec_mask_load_lanes@var{m}@var{n}}
4906 Like @samp{vec_load_lanes@var{m}@var{n}}, but takes an additional
4907 mask operand (operand 2) that specifies which elements of the destination
4908 vectors should be loaded. Other elements of the destination
4909 vectors are set to zero. The operation is equivalent to:
4910
4911 @smallexample
4912 int c = GET_MODE_SIZE (@var{m}) / GET_MODE_SIZE (@var{n});
4913 for (j = 0; j < GET_MODE_NUNITS (@var{n}); j++)
4914 if (operand2[j])
4915 for (i = 0; i < c; i++)
4916 operand0[i][j] = operand1[j * c + i];
4917 else
4918 for (i = 0; i < c; i++)
4919 operand0[i][j] = 0;
4920 @end smallexample
4921
4922 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
4923
4924 @cindex @code{vec_store_lanes@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
4925 @item @samp{vec_store_lanes@var{m}@var{n}}
4926 Equivalent to @samp{vec_load_lanes@var{m}@var{n}}, with the memory
4927 and register operands reversed. That is, the instruction is
4928 equivalent to:
4929
4930 @smallexample
4931 int c = GET_MODE_SIZE (@var{m}) / GET_MODE_SIZE (@var{n});
4932 for (j = 0; j < GET_MODE_NUNITS (@var{n}); j++)
4933 for (i = 0; i < c; i++)
4934 operand0[j * c + i] = operand1[i][j];
4935 @end smallexample
4936
4937 for a memory operand 0 and register operand 1.
4938
4939 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
4940
4941 @cindex @code{vec_mask_store_lanes@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
4942 @item @samp{vec_mask_store_lanes@var{m}@var{n}}
4943 Like @samp{vec_store_lanes@var{m}@var{n}}, but takes an additional
4944 mask operand (operand 2) that specifies which elements of the source
4945 vectors should be stored. The operation is equivalent to:
4946
4947 @smallexample
4948 int c = GET_MODE_SIZE (@var{m}) / GET_MODE_SIZE (@var{n});
4949 for (j = 0; j < GET_MODE_NUNITS (@var{n}); j++)
4950 if (operand2[j])
4951 for (i = 0; i < c; i++)
4952 operand0[j * c + i] = operand1[i][j];
4953 @end smallexample
4954
4955 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
4956
4957 @cindex @code{gather_load@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
4958 @item @samp{gather_load@var{m}@var{n}}
4959 Load several separate memory locations into a vector of mode @var{m}.
4960 Operand 1 is a scalar base address and operand 2 is a vector of mode @var{n}
4961 containing offsets from that base. Operand 0 is a destination vector with
4962 the same number of elements as @var{n}. For each element index @var{i}:
4963
4964 @itemize @bullet
4965 @item
4966 extend the offset element @var{i} to address width, using zero
4967 extension if operand 3 is 1 and sign extension if operand 3 is zero;
4968 @item
4969 multiply the extended offset by operand 4;
4970 @item
4971 add the result to the base; and
4972 @item
4973 load the value at that address into element @var{i} of operand 0.
4974 @end itemize
4975
4976 The value of operand 3 does not matter if the offsets are already
4977 address width.
4978
4979 @cindex @code{mask_gather_load@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
4980 @item @samp{mask_gather_load@var{m}@var{n}}
4981 Like @samp{gather_load@var{m}@var{n}}, but takes an extra mask operand as
4982 operand 5. Bit @var{i} of the mask is set if element @var{i}
4983 of the result should be loaded from memory and clear if element @var{i}
4984 of the result should be set to zero.
4985
4986 @cindex @code{scatter_store@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
4987 @item @samp{scatter_store@var{m}@var{n}}
4988 Store a vector of mode @var{m} into several distinct memory locations.
4989 Operand 0 is a scalar base address and operand 1 is a vector of mode
4990 @var{n} containing offsets from that base. Operand 4 is the vector of
4991 values that should be stored, which has the same number of elements as
4992 @var{n}. For each element index @var{i}:
4993
4994 @itemize @bullet
4995 @item
4996 extend the offset element @var{i} to address width, using zero
4997 extension if operand 2 is 1 and sign extension if operand 2 is zero;
4998 @item
4999 multiply the extended offset by operand 3;
5000 @item
5001 add the result to the base; and
5002 @item
5003 store element @var{i} of operand 4 to that address.
5004 @end itemize
5005
5006 The value of operand 2 does not matter if the offsets are already
5007 address width.
5008
5009 @cindex @code{mask_scatter_store@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
5010 @item @samp{mask_scatter_store@var{m}@var{n}}
5011 Like @samp{scatter_store@var{m}@var{n}}, but takes an extra mask operand as
5012 operand 5. Bit @var{i} of the mask is set if element @var{i}
5013 of the result should be stored to memory.
5014
5015 @cindex @code{vec_set@var{m}} instruction pattern
5016 @item @samp{vec_set@var{m}}
5017 Set given field in the vector value. Operand 0 is the vector to modify,
5018 operand 1 is new value of field and operand 2 specify the field index.
5019
5020 @cindex @code{vec_extract@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
5021 @item @samp{vec_extract@var{m}@var{n}}
5022 Extract given field from the vector value. Operand 1 is the vector, operand 2
5023 specify field index and operand 0 place to store value into. The
5024 @var{n} mode is the mode of the field or vector of fields that should be
5025 extracted, should be either element mode of the vector mode @var{m}, or
5026 a vector mode with the same element mode and smaller number of elements.
5027 If @var{n} is a vector mode, the index is counted in units of that mode.
5028
5029 @cindex @code{vec_init@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
5030 @item @samp{vec_init@var{m}@var{n}}
5031 Initialize the vector to given values. Operand 0 is the vector to initialize
5032 and operand 1 is parallel containing values for individual fields. The
5033 @var{n} mode is the mode of the elements, should be either element mode of
5034 the vector mode @var{m}, or a vector mode with the same element mode and
5035 smaller number of elements.
5036
5037 @cindex @code{vec_duplicate@var{m}} instruction pattern
5038 @item @samp{vec_duplicate@var{m}}
5039 Initialize vector output operand 0 so that each element has the value given
5040 by scalar input operand 1. The vector has mode @var{m} and the scalar has
5041 the mode appropriate for one element of @var{m}.
5042
5043 This pattern only handles duplicates of non-constant inputs. Constant
5044 vectors go through the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern instead.
5045
5046 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5047
5048 @cindex @code{vec_series@var{m}} instruction pattern
5049 @item @samp{vec_series@var{m}}
5050 Initialize vector output operand 0 so that element @var{i} is equal to
5051 operand 1 plus @var{i} times operand 2. In other words, create a linear
5052 series whose base value is operand 1 and whose step is operand 2.
5053
5054 The vector output has mode @var{m} and the scalar inputs have the mode
5055 appropriate for one element of @var{m}. This pattern is not used for
5056 floating-point vectors, in order to avoid having to specify the
5057 rounding behavior for @var{i} > 1.
5058
5059 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5060
5061 @cindex @code{while_ult@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
5062 @item @code{while_ult@var{m}@var{n}}
5063 Set operand 0 to a mask that is true while incrementing operand 1
5064 gives a value that is less than operand 2. Operand 0 has mode @var{n}
5065 and operands 1 and 2 are scalar integers of mode @var{m}.
5066 The operation is equivalent to:
5067
5068 @smallexample
5069 operand0[0] = operand1 < operand2;
5070 for (i = 1; i < GET_MODE_NUNITS (@var{n}); i++)
5071 operand0[i] = operand0[i - 1] && (operand1 + i < operand2);
5072 @end smallexample
5073
5074 @cindex @code{check_raw_ptrs@var{m}} instruction pattern
5075 @item @samp{check_raw_ptrs@var{m}}
5076 Check whether, given two pointers @var{a} and @var{b} and a length @var{len},
5077 a write of @var{len} bytes at @var{a} followed by a read of @var{len} bytes
5078 at @var{b} can be split into interleaved byte accesses
5079 @samp{@var{a}[0], @var{b}[0], @var{a}[1], @var{b}[1], @dots{}}
5080 without affecting the dependencies between the bytes. Set operand 0
5081 to true if the split is possible and false otherwise.
5082
5083 Operands 1, 2 and 3 provide the values of @var{a}, @var{b} and @var{len}
5084 respectively. Operand 4 is a constant integer that provides the known
5085 common alignment of @var{a} and @var{b}. All inputs have mode @var{m}.
5086
5087 This split is possible if:
5088
5089 @smallexample
5090 @var{a} == @var{b} || @var{a} + @var{len} <= @var{b} || @var{b} + @var{len} <= @var{a}
5091 @end smallexample
5092
5093 You should only define this pattern if the target has a way of accelerating
5094 the test without having to do the individual comparisons.
5095
5096 @cindex @code{check_war_ptrs@var{m}} instruction pattern
5097 @item @samp{check_war_ptrs@var{m}}
5098 Like @samp{check_raw_ptrs@var{m}}, but with the read and write swapped round.
5099 The split is possible in this case if:
5100
5101 @smallexample
5102 @var{b} <= @var{a} || @var{a} + @var{len} <= @var{b}
5103 @end smallexample
5104
5105 @cindex @code{vec_cmp@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
5106 @item @samp{vec_cmp@var{m}@var{n}}
5107 Output a vector comparison. Operand 0 of mode @var{n} is the destination for
5108 predicate in operand 1 which is a signed vector comparison with operands of
5109 mode @var{m} in operands 2 and 3. Predicate is computed by element-wise
5110 evaluation of the vector comparison with a truth value of all-ones and a false
5111 value of all-zeros.
5112
5113 @cindex @code{vec_cmpu@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
5114 @item @samp{vec_cmpu@var{m}@var{n}}
5115 Similar to @code{vec_cmp@var{m}@var{n}} but perform unsigned vector comparison.
5116
5117 @cindex @code{vec_cmpeq@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
5118 @item @samp{vec_cmpeq@var{m}@var{n}}
5119 Similar to @code{vec_cmp@var{m}@var{n}} but perform equality or non-equality
5120 vector comparison only. If @code{vec_cmp@var{m}@var{n}}
5121 or @code{vec_cmpu@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern is supported,
5122 it will be preferred over @code{vec_cmpeq@var{m}@var{n}}, so there is
5123 no need to define this instruction pattern if the others are supported.
5124
5125 @cindex @code{vcond@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
5126 @item @samp{vcond@var{m}@var{n}}
5127 Output a conditional vector move. Operand 0 is the destination to
5128 receive a combination of operand 1 and operand 2, which are of mode @var{m},
5129 dependent on the outcome of the predicate in operand 3 which is a signed
5130 vector comparison with operands of mode @var{n} in operands 4 and 5. The
5131 modes @var{m} and @var{n} should have the same size. Operand 0
5132 will be set to the value @var{op1} & @var{msk} | @var{op2} & ~@var{msk}
5133 where @var{msk} is computed by element-wise evaluation of the vector
5134 comparison with a truth value of all-ones and a false value of all-zeros.
5135
5136 @cindex @code{vcondu@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
5137 @item @samp{vcondu@var{m}@var{n}}
5138 Similar to @code{vcond@var{m}@var{n}} but performs unsigned vector
5139 comparison.
5140
5141 @cindex @code{vcondeq@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
5142 @item @samp{vcondeq@var{m}@var{n}}
5143 Similar to @code{vcond@var{m}@var{n}} but performs equality or
5144 non-equality vector comparison only. If @code{vcond@var{m}@var{n}}
5145 or @code{vcondu@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern is supported,
5146 it will be preferred over @code{vcondeq@var{m}@var{n}}, so there is
5147 no need to define this instruction pattern if the others are supported.
5148
5149 @cindex @code{vcond_mask_@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
5150 @item @samp{vcond_mask_@var{m}@var{n}}
5151 Similar to @code{vcond@var{m}@var{n}} but operand 3 holds a pre-computed
5152 result of vector comparison.
5153
5154 @cindex @code{maskload@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
5155 @item @samp{maskload@var{m}@var{n}}
5156 Perform a masked load of vector from memory operand 1 of mode @var{m}
5157 into register operand 0. Mask is provided in register operand 2 of
5158 mode @var{n}.
5159
5160 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5161
5162 @cindex @code{maskstore@var{m}@var{n}} instruction pattern
5163 @item @samp{maskstore@var{m}@var{n}}
5164 Perform a masked store of vector from register operand 1 of mode @var{m}
5165 into memory operand 0. Mask is provided in register operand 2 of
5166 mode @var{n}.
5167
5168 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5169
5170 @cindex @code{len_load_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5171 @item @samp{len_load_@var{m}}
5172 Load the number of vector elements specified by operand 2 from memory
5173 operand 1 into vector register operand 0, setting the other elements of
5174 operand 0 to undefined values. Operands 0 and 1 have mode @var{m},
5175 which must be a vector mode. Operand 2 has whichever integer mode the
5176 target prefers. If operand 2 exceeds the number of elements in mode
5177 @var{m}, the behavior is undefined. If the target prefers the length
5178 to be measured in bytes rather than elements, it should only implement
5179 this pattern for vectors of @code{QI} elements.
5180
5181 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5182
5183 @cindex @code{len_store_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5184 @item @samp{len_store_@var{m}}
5185 Store the number of vector elements specified by operand 2 from vector
5186 register operand 1 into memory operand 0, leaving the other elements of
5187 operand 0 unchanged. Operands 0 and 1 have mode @var{m}, which must be
5188 a vector mode. Operand 2 has whichever integer mode the target prefers.
5189 If operand 2 exceeds the number of elements in mode @var{m}, the behavior
5190 is undefined. If the target prefers the length to be measured in bytes
5191 rather than elements, it should only implement this pattern for vectors
5192 of @code{QI} elements.
5193
5194 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5195
5196 @cindex @code{vec_perm@var{m}} instruction pattern
5197 @item @samp{vec_perm@var{m}}
5198 Output a (variable) vector permutation. Operand 0 is the destination
5199 to receive elements from operand 1 and operand 2, which are of mode
5200 @var{m}. Operand 3 is the @dfn{selector}. It is an integral mode
5201 vector of the same width and number of elements as mode @var{m}.
5202
5203 The input elements are numbered from 0 in operand 1 through
5204 @math{2*@var{N}-1} in operand 2. The elements of the selector must
5205 be computed modulo @math{2*@var{N}}. Note that if
5206 @code{rtx_equal_p(operand1, operand2)}, this can be implemented
5207 with just operand 1 and selector elements modulo @var{N}.
5208
5209 In order to make things easy for a number of targets, if there is no
5210 @samp{vec_perm} pattern for mode @var{m}, but there is for mode @var{q}
5211 where @var{q} is a vector of @code{QImode} of the same width as @var{m},
5212 the middle-end will lower the mode @var{m} @code{VEC_PERM_EXPR} to
5213 mode @var{q}.
5214
5215 See also @code{TARGET_VECTORIZER_VEC_PERM_CONST}, which performs
5216 the analogous operation for constant selectors.
5217
5218 @cindex @code{push@var{m}1} instruction pattern
5219 @item @samp{push@var{m}1}
5220 Output a push instruction. Operand 0 is value to push. Used only when
5221 @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} is defined. For historical reason, this pattern may be
5222 missing and in such case an @code{mov} expander is used instead, with a
5223 @code{MEM} expression forming the push operation. The @code{mov} expander
5224 method is deprecated.
5225
5226 @cindex @code{add@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5227 @item @samp{add@var{m}3}
5228 Add operand 2 and operand 1, storing the result in operand 0. All operands
5229 must have mode @var{m}. This can be used even on two-address machines, by
5230 means of constraints requiring operands 1 and 0 to be the same location.
5231
5232 @cindex @code{ssadd@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5233 @cindex @code{usadd@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5234 @cindex @code{sub@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5235 @cindex @code{sssub@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5236 @cindex @code{ussub@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5237 @cindex @code{mul@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5238 @cindex @code{ssmul@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5239 @cindex @code{usmul@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5240 @cindex @code{div@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5241 @cindex @code{ssdiv@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5242 @cindex @code{udiv@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5243 @cindex @code{usdiv@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5244 @cindex @code{mod@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5245 @cindex @code{umod@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5246 @cindex @code{umin@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5247 @cindex @code{umax@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5248 @cindex @code{and@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5249 @cindex @code{ior@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5250 @cindex @code{xor@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5251 @item @samp{ssadd@var{m}3}, @samp{usadd@var{m}3}
5252 @itemx @samp{sub@var{m}3}, @samp{sssub@var{m}3}, @samp{ussub@var{m}3}
5253 @itemx @samp{mul@var{m}3}, @samp{ssmul@var{m}3}, @samp{usmul@var{m}3}
5254 @itemx @samp{div@var{m}3}, @samp{ssdiv@var{m}3}
5255 @itemx @samp{udiv@var{m}3}, @samp{usdiv@var{m}3}
5256 @itemx @samp{mod@var{m}3}, @samp{umod@var{m}3}
5257 @itemx @samp{umin@var{m}3}, @samp{umax@var{m}3}
5258 @itemx @samp{and@var{m}3}, @samp{ior@var{m}3}, @samp{xor@var{m}3}
5259 Similar, for other arithmetic operations.
5260
5261 @cindex @code{addv@var{m}4} instruction pattern
5262 @item @samp{addv@var{m}4}
5263 Like @code{add@var{m}3} but takes a @code{code_label} as operand 3 and
5264 emits code to jump to it if signed overflow occurs during the addition.
5265 This pattern is used to implement the built-in functions performing
5266 signed integer addition with overflow checking.
5267
5268 @cindex @code{subv@var{m}4} instruction pattern
5269 @cindex @code{mulv@var{m}4} instruction pattern
5270 @item @samp{subv@var{m}4}, @samp{mulv@var{m}4}
5271 Similar, for other signed arithmetic operations.
5272
5273 @cindex @code{uaddv@var{m}4} instruction pattern
5274 @item @samp{uaddv@var{m}4}
5275 Like @code{addv@var{m}4} but for unsigned addition. That is to
5276 say, the operation is the same as signed addition but the jump
5277 is taken only on unsigned overflow.
5278
5279 @cindex @code{usubv@var{m}4} instruction pattern
5280 @cindex @code{umulv@var{m}4} instruction pattern
5281 @item @samp{usubv@var{m}4}, @samp{umulv@var{m}4}
5282 Similar, for other unsigned arithmetic operations.
5283
5284 @cindex @code{addptr@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5285 @item @samp{addptr@var{m}3}
5286 Like @code{add@var{m}3} but is guaranteed to only be used for address
5287 calculations. The expanded code is not allowed to clobber the
5288 condition code. It only needs to be defined if @code{add@var{m}3}
5289 sets the condition code. If adds used for address calculations and
5290 normal adds are not compatible it is required to expand a distinct
5291 pattern (e.g.@: using an unspec). The pattern is used by LRA to emit
5292 address calculations. @code{add@var{m}3} is used if
5293 @code{addptr@var{m}3} is not defined.
5294
5295 @cindex @code{fma@var{m}4} instruction pattern
5296 @item @samp{fma@var{m}4}
5297 Multiply operand 2 and operand 1, then add operand 3, storing the
5298 result in operand 0 without doing an intermediate rounding step. All
5299 operands must have mode @var{m}. This pattern is used to implement
5300 the @code{fma}, @code{fmaf}, and @code{fmal} builtin functions from
5301 the ISO C99 standard.
5302
5303 @cindex @code{fms@var{m}4} instruction pattern
5304 @item @samp{fms@var{m}4}
5305 Like @code{fma@var{m}4}, except operand 3 subtracted from the
5306 product instead of added to the product. This is represented
5307 in the rtl as
5308
5309 @smallexample
5310 (fma:@var{m} @var{op1} @var{op2} (neg:@var{m} @var{op3}))
5311 @end smallexample
5312
5313 @cindex @code{fnma@var{m}4} instruction pattern
5314 @item @samp{fnma@var{m}4}
5315 Like @code{fma@var{m}4} except that the intermediate product
5316 is negated before being added to operand 3. This is represented
5317 in the rtl as
5318
5319 @smallexample
5320 (fma:@var{m} (neg:@var{m} @var{op1}) @var{op2} @var{op3})
5321 @end smallexample
5322
5323 @cindex @code{fnms@var{m}4} instruction pattern
5324 @item @samp{fnms@var{m}4}
5325 Like @code{fms@var{m}4} except that the intermediate product
5326 is negated before subtracting operand 3. This is represented
5327 in the rtl as
5328
5329 @smallexample
5330 (fma:@var{m} (neg:@var{m} @var{op1}) @var{op2} (neg:@var{m} @var{op3}))
5331 @end smallexample
5332
5333 @cindex @code{min@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5334 @cindex @code{max@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5335 @item @samp{smin@var{m}3}, @samp{smax@var{m}3}
5336 Signed minimum and maximum operations. When used with floating point,
5337 if both operands are zeros, or if either operand is @code{NaN}, then
5338 it is unspecified which of the two operands is returned as the result.
5339
5340 @cindex @code{fmin@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5341 @cindex @code{fmax@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5342 @item @samp{fmin@var{m}3}, @samp{fmax@var{m}3}
5343 IEEE-conformant minimum and maximum operations. If one operand is a quiet
5344 @code{NaN}, then the other operand is returned. If both operands are quiet
5345 @code{NaN}, then a quiet @code{NaN} is returned. In the case when gcc supports
5346 signaling @code{NaN} (-fsignaling-nans) an invalid floating point exception is
5347 raised and a quiet @code{NaN} is returned.
5348
5349 All operands have mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector
5350 floating-point mode. These patterns are not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5351
5352 @cindex @code{reduc_smin_scal_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5353 @cindex @code{reduc_smax_scal_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5354 @item @samp{reduc_smin_scal_@var{m}}, @samp{reduc_smax_scal_@var{m}}
5355 Find the signed minimum/maximum of the elements of a vector. The vector is
5356 operand 1, and operand 0 is the scalar result, with mode equal to the mode of
5357 the elements of the input vector.
5358
5359 @cindex @code{reduc_umin_scal_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5360 @cindex @code{reduc_umax_scal_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5361 @item @samp{reduc_umin_scal_@var{m}}, @samp{reduc_umax_scal_@var{m}}
5362 Find the unsigned minimum/maximum of the elements of a vector. The vector is
5363 operand 1, and operand 0 is the scalar result, with mode equal to the mode of
5364 the elements of the input vector.
5365
5366 @cindex @code{reduc_plus_scal_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5367 @item @samp{reduc_plus_scal_@var{m}}
5368 Compute the sum of the elements of a vector. The vector is operand 1, and
5369 operand 0 is the scalar result, with mode equal to the mode of the elements of
5370 the input vector.
5371
5372 @cindex @code{reduc_and_scal_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5373 @item @samp{reduc_and_scal_@var{m}}
5374 @cindex @code{reduc_ior_scal_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5375 @itemx @samp{reduc_ior_scal_@var{m}}
5376 @cindex @code{reduc_xor_scal_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5377 @itemx @samp{reduc_xor_scal_@var{m}}
5378 Compute the bitwise @code{AND}/@code{IOR}/@code{XOR} reduction of the elements
5379 of a vector of mode @var{m}. Operand 1 is the vector input and operand 0
5380 is the scalar result. The mode of the scalar result is the same as one
5381 element of @var{m}.
5382
5383 @cindex @code{extract_last_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5384 @item @code{extract_last_@var{m}}
5385 Find the last set bit in mask operand 1 and extract the associated element
5386 of vector operand 2. Store the result in scalar operand 0. Operand 2
5387 has vector mode @var{m} while operand 0 has the mode appropriate for one
5388 element of @var{m}. Operand 1 has the usual mask mode for vectors of mode
5389 @var{m}; see @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_GET_MASK_MODE}.
5390
5391 @cindex @code{fold_extract_last_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5392 @item @code{fold_extract_last_@var{m}}
5393 If any bits of mask operand 2 are set, find the last set bit, extract
5394 the associated element from vector operand 3, and store the result
5395 in operand 0. Store operand 1 in operand 0 otherwise. Operand 3
5396 has mode @var{m} and operands 0 and 1 have the mode appropriate for
5397 one element of @var{m}. Operand 2 has the usual mask mode for vectors
5398 of mode @var{m}; see @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_GET_MASK_MODE}.
5399
5400 @cindex @code{fold_left_plus_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5401 @item @code{fold_left_plus_@var{m}}
5402 Take scalar operand 1 and successively add each element from vector
5403 operand 2. Store the result in scalar operand 0. The vector has
5404 mode @var{m} and the scalars have the mode appropriate for one
5405 element of @var{m}. The operation is strictly in-order: there is
5406 no reassociation.
5407
5408 @cindex @code{mask_fold_left_plus_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5409 @item @code{mask_fold_left_plus_@var{m}}
5410 Like @samp{fold_left_plus_@var{m}}, but takes an additional mask operand
5411 (operand 3) that specifies which elements of the source vector should be added.
5412
5413 @cindex @code{sdot_prod@var{m}} instruction pattern
5414 @item @samp{sdot_prod@var{m}}
5415 @cindex @code{udot_prod@var{m}} instruction pattern
5416 @itemx @samp{udot_prod@var{m}}
5417 Compute the sum of the products of two signed/unsigned elements.
5418 Operand 1 and operand 2 are of the same mode. Their product, which is of a
5419 wider mode, is computed and added to operand 3. Operand 3 is of a mode equal or
5420 wider than the mode of the product. The result is placed in operand 0, which
5421 is of the same mode as operand 3.
5422
5423 @cindex @code{ssad@var{m}} instruction pattern
5424 @item @samp{ssad@var{m}}
5425 @cindex @code{usad@var{m}} instruction pattern
5426 @item @samp{usad@var{m}}
5427 Compute the sum of absolute differences of two signed/unsigned elements.
5428 Operand 1 and operand 2 are of the same mode. Their absolute difference, which
5429 is of a wider mode, is computed and added to operand 3. Operand 3 is of a mode
5430 equal or wider than the mode of the absolute difference. The result is placed
5431 in operand 0, which is of the same mode as operand 3.
5432
5433 @cindex @code{widen_ssum@var{m3}} instruction pattern
5434 @item @samp{widen_ssum@var{m3}}
5435 @cindex @code{widen_usum@var{m3}} instruction pattern
5436 @itemx @samp{widen_usum@var{m3}}
5437 Operands 0 and 2 are of the same mode, which is wider than the mode of
5438 operand 1. Add operand 1 to operand 2 and place the widened result in
5439 operand 0. (This is used express accumulation of elements into an accumulator
5440 of a wider mode.)
5441
5442 @cindex @code{smulhs@var{m3}} instruction pattern
5443 @item @samp{smulhs@var{m3}}
5444 @cindex @code{umulhs@var{m3}} instruction pattern
5445 @itemx @samp{umulhs@var{m3}}
5446 Signed/unsigned multiply high with scale. This is equivalent to the C code:
5447 @smallexample
5448 narrow op0, op1, op2;
5449 @dots{}
5450 op0 = (narrow) (((wide) op1 * (wide) op2) >> (N / 2 - 1));
5451 @end smallexample
5452 where the sign of @samp{narrow} determines whether this is a signed
5453 or unsigned operation, and @var{N} is the size of @samp{wide} in bits.
5454
5455 @cindex @code{smulhrs@var{m3}} instruction pattern
5456 @item @samp{smulhrs@var{m3}}
5457 @cindex @code{umulhrs@var{m3}} instruction pattern
5458 @itemx @samp{umulhrs@var{m3}}
5459 Signed/unsigned multiply high with round and scale. This is
5460 equivalent to the C code:
5461 @smallexample
5462 narrow op0, op1, op2;
5463 @dots{}
5464 op0 = (narrow) (((((wide) op1 * (wide) op2) >> (N / 2 - 2)) + 1) >> 1);
5465 @end smallexample
5466 where the sign of @samp{narrow} determines whether this is a signed
5467 or unsigned operation, and @var{N} is the size of @samp{wide} in bits.
5468
5469 @cindex @code{sdiv_pow2@var{m3}} instruction pattern
5470 @item @samp{sdiv_pow2@var{m3}}
5471 @cindex @code{sdiv_pow2@var{m3}} instruction pattern
5472 @itemx @samp{sdiv_pow2@var{m3}}
5473 Signed division by power-of-2 immediate. Equivalent to:
5474 @smallexample
5475 signed op0, op1;
5476 @dots{}
5477 op0 = op1 / (1 << imm);
5478 @end smallexample
5479
5480 @cindex @code{vec_shl_insert_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5481 @item @samp{vec_shl_insert_@var{m}}
5482 Shift the elements in vector input operand 1 left one element (i.e.@:
5483 away from element 0) and fill the vacated element 0 with the scalar
5484 in operand 2. Store the result in vector output operand 0. Operands
5485 0 and 1 have mode @var{m} and operand 2 has the mode appropriate for
5486 one element of @var{m}.
5487
5488 @cindex @code{vec_shl_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5489 @item @samp{vec_shl_@var{m}}
5490 Whole vector left shift in bits, i.e.@: away from element 0.
5491 Operand 1 is a vector to be shifted.
5492 Operand 2 is an integer shift amount in bits.
5493 Operand 0 is where the resulting shifted vector is stored.
5494 The output and input vectors should have the same modes.
5495
5496 @cindex @code{vec_shr_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5497 @item @samp{vec_shr_@var{m}}
5498 Whole vector right shift in bits, i.e.@: towards element 0.
5499 Operand 1 is a vector to be shifted.
5500 Operand 2 is an integer shift amount in bits.
5501 Operand 0 is where the resulting shifted vector is stored.
5502 The output and input vectors should have the same modes.
5503
5504 @cindex @code{vec_pack_trunc_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5505 @item @samp{vec_pack_trunc_@var{m}}
5506 Narrow (demote) and merge the elements of two vectors. Operands 1 and 2
5507 are vectors of the same mode having N integral or floating point elements
5508 of size S@. Operand 0 is the resulting vector in which 2*N elements of
5509 size S/2 are concatenated after narrowing them down using truncation.
5510
5511 @cindex @code{vec_pack_sbool_trunc_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5512 @item @samp{vec_pack_sbool_trunc_@var{m}}
5513 Narrow and merge the elements of two vectors. Operands 1 and 2 are vectors
5514 of the same type having N boolean elements. Operand 0 is the resulting
5515 vector in which 2*N elements are concatenated. The last operand (operand 3)
5516 is the number of elements in the output vector 2*N as a @code{CONST_INT}.
5517 This instruction pattern is used when all the vector input and output
5518 operands have the same scalar mode @var{m} and thus using
5519 @code{vec_pack_trunc_@var{m}} would be ambiguous.
5520
5521 @cindex @code{vec_pack_ssat_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5522 @cindex @code{vec_pack_usat_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5523 @item @samp{vec_pack_ssat_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_pack_usat_@var{m}}
5524 Narrow (demote) and merge the elements of two vectors. Operands 1 and 2
5525 are vectors of the same mode having N integral elements of size S.
5526 Operand 0 is the resulting vector in which the elements of the two input
5527 vectors are concatenated after narrowing them down using signed/unsigned
5528 saturating arithmetic.
5529
5530 @cindex @code{vec_pack_sfix_trunc_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5531 @cindex @code{vec_pack_ufix_trunc_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5532 @item @samp{vec_pack_sfix_trunc_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_pack_ufix_trunc_@var{m}}
5533 Narrow, convert to signed/unsigned integral type and merge the elements
5534 of two vectors. Operands 1 and 2 are vectors of the same mode having N
5535 floating point elements of size S@. Operand 0 is the resulting vector
5536 in which 2*N elements of size S/2 are concatenated.
5537
5538 @cindex @code{vec_packs_float_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5539 @cindex @code{vec_packu_float_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5540 @item @samp{vec_packs_float_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_packu_float_@var{m}}
5541 Narrow, convert to floating point type and merge the elements
5542 of two vectors. Operands 1 and 2 are vectors of the same mode having N
5543 signed/unsigned integral elements of size S@. Operand 0 is the resulting vector
5544 in which 2*N elements of size S/2 are concatenated.
5545
5546 @cindex @code{vec_unpacks_hi_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5547 @cindex @code{vec_unpacks_lo_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5548 @item @samp{vec_unpacks_hi_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_unpacks_lo_@var{m}}
5549 Extract and widen (promote) the high/low part of a vector of signed
5550 integral or floating point elements. The input vector (operand 1) has N
5551 elements of size S@. Widen (promote) the high/low elements of the vector
5552 using signed or floating point extension and place the resulting N/2
5553 values of size 2*S in the output vector (operand 0).
5554
5555 @cindex @code{vec_unpacku_hi_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5556 @cindex @code{vec_unpacku_lo_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5557 @item @samp{vec_unpacku_hi_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_unpacku_lo_@var{m}}
5558 Extract and widen (promote) the high/low part of a vector of unsigned
5559 integral elements. The input vector (operand 1) has N elements of size S.
5560 Widen (promote) the high/low elements of the vector using zero extension and
5561 place the resulting N/2 values of size 2*S in the output vector (operand 0).
5562
5563 @cindex @code{vec_unpacks_sbool_hi_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5564 @cindex @code{vec_unpacks_sbool_lo_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5565 @item @samp{vec_unpacks_sbool_hi_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_unpacks_sbool_lo_@var{m}}
5566 Extract the high/low part of a vector of boolean elements that have scalar
5567 mode @var{m}. The input vector (operand 1) has N elements, the output
5568 vector (operand 0) has N/2 elements. The last operand (operand 2) is the
5569 number of elements of the input vector N as a @code{CONST_INT}. These
5570 patterns are used if both the input and output vectors have the same scalar
5571 mode @var{m} and thus using @code{vec_unpacks_hi_@var{m}} or
5572 @code{vec_unpacks_lo_@var{m}} would be ambiguous.
5573
5574 @cindex @code{vec_unpacks_float_hi_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5575 @cindex @code{vec_unpacks_float_lo_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5576 @cindex @code{vec_unpacku_float_hi_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5577 @cindex @code{vec_unpacku_float_lo_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5578 @item @samp{vec_unpacks_float_hi_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_unpacks_float_lo_@var{m}}
5579 @itemx @samp{vec_unpacku_float_hi_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_unpacku_float_lo_@var{m}}
5580 Extract, convert to floating point type and widen the high/low part of a
5581 vector of signed/unsigned integral elements. The input vector (operand 1)
5582 has N elements of size S@. Convert the high/low elements of the vector using
5583 floating point conversion and place the resulting N/2 values of size 2*S in
5584 the output vector (operand 0).
5585
5586 @cindex @code{vec_unpack_sfix_trunc_hi_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5587 @cindex @code{vec_unpack_sfix_trunc_lo_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5588 @cindex @code{vec_unpack_ufix_trunc_hi_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5589 @cindex @code{vec_unpack_ufix_trunc_lo_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5590 @item @samp{vec_unpack_sfix_trunc_hi_@var{m}},
5591 @itemx @samp{vec_unpack_sfix_trunc_lo_@var{m}}
5592 @itemx @samp{vec_unpack_ufix_trunc_hi_@var{m}}
5593 @itemx @samp{vec_unpack_ufix_trunc_lo_@var{m}}
5594 Extract, convert to signed/unsigned integer type and widen the high/low part of a
5595 vector of floating point elements. The input vector (operand 1)
5596 has N elements of size S@. Convert the high/low elements of the vector
5597 to integers and place the resulting N/2 values of size 2*S in
5598 the output vector (operand 0).
5599
5600 @cindex @code{vec_widen_umult_hi_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5601 @cindex @code{vec_widen_umult_lo_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5602 @cindex @code{vec_widen_smult_hi_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5603 @cindex @code{vec_widen_smult_lo_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5604 @cindex @code{vec_widen_umult_even_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5605 @cindex @code{vec_widen_umult_odd_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5606 @cindex @code{vec_widen_smult_even_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5607 @cindex @code{vec_widen_smult_odd_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5608 @item @samp{vec_widen_umult_hi_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_widen_umult_lo_@var{m}}
5609 @itemx @samp{vec_widen_smult_hi_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_widen_smult_lo_@var{m}}
5610 @itemx @samp{vec_widen_umult_even_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_widen_umult_odd_@var{m}}
5611 @itemx @samp{vec_widen_smult_even_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_widen_smult_odd_@var{m}}
5612 Signed/Unsigned widening multiplication. The two inputs (operands 1 and 2)
5613 are vectors with N signed/unsigned elements of size S@. Multiply the high/low
5614 or even/odd elements of the two vectors, and put the N/2 products of size 2*S
5615 in the output vector (operand 0). A target shouldn't implement even/odd pattern
5616 pair if it is less efficient than lo/hi one.
5617
5618 @cindex @code{vec_widen_ushiftl_hi_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5619 @cindex @code{vec_widen_ushiftl_lo_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5620 @cindex @code{vec_widen_sshiftl_hi_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5621 @cindex @code{vec_widen_sshiftl_lo_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5622 @item @samp{vec_widen_ushiftl_hi_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_widen_ushiftl_lo_@var{m}}
5623 @itemx @samp{vec_widen_sshiftl_hi_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_widen_sshiftl_lo_@var{m}}
5624 Signed/Unsigned widening shift left. The first input (operand 1) is a vector
5625 with N signed/unsigned elements of size S@. Operand 2 is a constant. Shift
5626 the high/low elements of operand 1, and put the N/2 results of size 2*S in the
5627 output vector (operand 0).
5628
5629 @cindex @code{vec_widen_saddl_hi_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5630 @cindex @code{vec_widen_saddl_lo_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5631 @cindex @code{vec_widen_uaddl_hi_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5632 @cindex @code{vec_widen_uaddl_lo_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5633 @item @samp{vec_widen_uaddl_hi_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_widen_uaddl_lo_@var{m}}
5634 @itemx @samp{vec_widen_saddl_hi_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_widen_saddl_lo_@var{m}}
5635 Signed/Unsigned widening add long. Operands 1 and 2 are vectors with N
5636 signed/unsigned elements of size S@. Add the high/low elements of 1 and 2
5637 together, widen the resulting elements and put the N/2 results of size 2*S in
5638 the output vector (operand 0).
5639
5640 @cindex @code{vec_widen_ssubl_hi_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5641 @cindex @code{vec_widen_ssubl_lo_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5642 @cindex @code{vec_widen_usubl_hi_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5643 @cindex @code{vec_widen_usubl_lo_@var{m}} instruction pattern
5644 @item @samp{vec_widen_usubl_hi_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_widen_usubl_lo_@var{m}}
5645 @itemx @samp{vec_widen_ssubl_hi_@var{m}}, @samp{vec_widen_ssubl_lo_@var{m}}
5646 Signed/Unsigned widening subtract long. Operands 1 and 2 are vectors with N
5647 signed/unsigned elements of size S@. Subtract the high/low elements of 2 from
5648 1 and widen the resulting elements. Put the N/2 results of size 2*S in the
5649 output vector (operand 0).
5650
5651 @cindex @code{mulhisi3} instruction pattern
5652 @item @samp{mulhisi3}
5653 Multiply operands 1 and 2, which have mode @code{HImode}, and store
5654 a @code{SImode} product in operand 0.
5655
5656 @cindex @code{mulqihi3} instruction pattern
5657 @cindex @code{mulsidi3} instruction pattern
5658 @item @samp{mulqihi3}, @samp{mulsidi3}
5659 Similar widening-multiplication instructions of other widths.
5660
5661 @cindex @code{umulqihi3} instruction pattern
5662 @cindex @code{umulhisi3} instruction pattern
5663 @cindex @code{umulsidi3} instruction pattern
5664 @item @samp{umulqihi3}, @samp{umulhisi3}, @samp{umulsidi3}
5665 Similar widening-multiplication instructions that do unsigned
5666 multiplication.
5667
5668 @cindex @code{usmulqihi3} instruction pattern
5669 @cindex @code{usmulhisi3} instruction pattern
5670 @cindex @code{usmulsidi3} instruction pattern
5671 @item @samp{usmulqihi3}, @samp{usmulhisi3}, @samp{usmulsidi3}
5672 Similar widening-multiplication instructions that interpret the first
5673 operand as unsigned and the second operand as signed, then do a signed
5674 multiplication.
5675
5676 @cindex @code{smul@var{m}3_highpart} instruction pattern
5677 @item @samp{smul@var{m}3_highpart}
5678 Perform a signed multiplication of operands 1 and 2, which have mode
5679 @var{m}, and store the most significant half of the product in operand 0.
5680 The least significant half of the product is discarded.
5681
5682 @cindex @code{umul@var{m}3_highpart} instruction pattern
5683 @item @samp{umul@var{m}3_highpart}
5684 Similar, but the multiplication is unsigned.
5685
5686 @cindex @code{madd@var{m}@var{n}4} instruction pattern
5687 @item @samp{madd@var{m}@var{n}4}
5688 Multiply operands 1 and 2, sign-extend them to mode @var{n}, add
5689 operand 3, and store the result in operand 0. Operands 1 and 2
5690 have mode @var{m} and operands 0 and 3 have mode @var{n}.
5691 Both modes must be integer or fixed-point modes and @var{n} must be twice
5692 the size of @var{m}.
5693
5694 In other words, @code{madd@var{m}@var{n}4} is like
5695 @code{mul@var{m}@var{n}3} except that it also adds operand 3.
5696
5697 These instructions are not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5698
5699 @cindex @code{umadd@var{m}@var{n}4} instruction pattern
5700 @item @samp{umadd@var{m}@var{n}4}
5701 Like @code{madd@var{m}@var{n}4}, but zero-extend the multiplication
5702 operands instead of sign-extending them.
5703
5704 @cindex @code{ssmadd@var{m}@var{n}4} instruction pattern
5705 @item @samp{ssmadd@var{m}@var{n}4}
5706 Like @code{madd@var{m}@var{n}4}, but all involved operations must be
5707 signed-saturating.
5708
5709 @cindex @code{usmadd@var{m}@var{n}4} instruction pattern
5710 @item @samp{usmadd@var{m}@var{n}4}
5711 Like @code{umadd@var{m}@var{n}4}, but all involved operations must be
5712 unsigned-saturating.
5713
5714 @cindex @code{msub@var{m}@var{n}4} instruction pattern
5715 @item @samp{msub@var{m}@var{n}4}
5716 Multiply operands 1 and 2, sign-extend them to mode @var{n}, subtract the
5717 result from operand 3, and store the result in operand 0. Operands 1 and 2
5718 have mode @var{m} and operands 0 and 3 have mode @var{n}.
5719 Both modes must be integer or fixed-point modes and @var{n} must be twice
5720 the size of @var{m}.
5721
5722 In other words, @code{msub@var{m}@var{n}4} is like
5723 @code{mul@var{m}@var{n}3} except that it also subtracts the result
5724 from operand 3.
5725
5726 These instructions are not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5727
5728 @cindex @code{umsub@var{m}@var{n}4} instruction pattern
5729 @item @samp{umsub@var{m}@var{n}4}
5730 Like @code{msub@var{m}@var{n}4}, but zero-extend the multiplication
5731 operands instead of sign-extending them.
5732
5733 @cindex @code{ssmsub@var{m}@var{n}4} instruction pattern
5734 @item @samp{ssmsub@var{m}@var{n}4}
5735 Like @code{msub@var{m}@var{n}4}, but all involved operations must be
5736 signed-saturating.
5737
5738 @cindex @code{usmsub@var{m}@var{n}4} instruction pattern
5739 @item @samp{usmsub@var{m}@var{n}4}
5740 Like @code{umsub@var{m}@var{n}4}, but all involved operations must be
5741 unsigned-saturating.
5742
5743 @cindex @code{divmod@var{m}4} instruction pattern
5744 @item @samp{divmod@var{m}4}
5745 Signed division that produces both a quotient and a remainder.
5746 Operand 1 is divided by operand 2 to produce a quotient stored
5747 in operand 0 and a remainder stored in operand 3.
5748
5749 For machines with an instruction that produces both a quotient and a
5750 remainder, provide a pattern for @samp{divmod@var{m}4} but do not
5751 provide patterns for @samp{div@var{m}3} and @samp{mod@var{m}3}. This
5752 allows optimization in the relatively common case when both the quotient
5753 and remainder are computed.
5754
5755 If an instruction that just produces a quotient or just a remainder
5756 exists and is more efficient than the instruction that produces both,
5757 write the output routine of @samp{divmod@var{m}4} to call
5758 @code{find_reg_note} and look for a @code{REG_UNUSED} note on the
5759 quotient or remainder and generate the appropriate instruction.
5760
5761 @cindex @code{udivmod@var{m}4} instruction pattern
5762 @item @samp{udivmod@var{m}4}
5763 Similar, but does unsigned division.
5764
5765 @anchor{shift patterns}
5766 @cindex @code{ashl@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5767 @cindex @code{ssashl@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5768 @cindex @code{usashl@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5769 @item @samp{ashl@var{m}3}, @samp{ssashl@var{m}3}, @samp{usashl@var{m}3}
5770 Arithmetic-shift operand 1 left by a number of bits specified by operand
5771 2, and store the result in operand 0. Here @var{m} is the mode of
5772 operand 0 and operand 1; operand 2's mode is specified by the
5773 instruction pattern, and the compiler will convert the operand to that
5774 mode before generating the instruction. The shift or rotate expander
5775 or instruction pattern should explicitly specify the mode of the operand 2,
5776 it should never be @code{VOIDmode}. The meaning of out-of-range shift
5777 counts can optionally be specified by @code{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}.
5778 @xref{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}. Operand 2 is always a scalar type.
5779
5780 @cindex @code{ashr@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5781 @cindex @code{lshr@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5782 @cindex @code{rotl@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5783 @cindex @code{rotr@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5784 @item @samp{ashr@var{m}3}, @samp{lshr@var{m}3}, @samp{rotl@var{m}3}, @samp{rotr@var{m}3}
5785 Other shift and rotate instructions, analogous to the
5786 @code{ashl@var{m}3} instructions. Operand 2 is always a scalar type.
5787
5788 @cindex @code{vashl@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5789 @cindex @code{vashr@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5790 @cindex @code{vlshr@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5791 @cindex @code{vrotl@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5792 @cindex @code{vrotr@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5793 @item @samp{vashl@var{m}3}, @samp{vashr@var{m}3}, @samp{vlshr@var{m}3}, @samp{vrotl@var{m}3}, @samp{vrotr@var{m}3}
5794 Vector shift and rotate instructions that take vectors as operand 2
5795 instead of a scalar type.
5796
5797 @cindex @code{avg@var{m}3_floor} instruction pattern
5798 @cindex @code{uavg@var{m}3_floor} instruction pattern
5799 @item @samp{avg@var{m}3_floor}
5800 @itemx @samp{uavg@var{m}3_floor}
5801 Signed and unsigned average instructions. These instructions add
5802 operands 1 and 2 without truncation, divide the result by 2,
5803 round towards -Inf, and store the result in operand 0. This is
5804 equivalent to the C code:
5805 @smallexample
5806 narrow op0, op1, op2;
5807 @dots{}
5808 op0 = (narrow) (((wide) op1 + (wide) op2) >> 1);
5809 @end smallexample
5810 where the sign of @samp{narrow} determines whether this is a signed
5811 or unsigned operation.
5812
5813 @cindex @code{avg@var{m}3_ceil} instruction pattern
5814 @cindex @code{uavg@var{m}3_ceil} instruction pattern
5815 @item @samp{avg@var{m}3_ceil}
5816 @itemx @samp{uavg@var{m}3_ceil}
5817 Like @samp{avg@var{m}3_floor} and @samp{uavg@var{m}3_floor}, but round
5818 towards +Inf. This is equivalent to the C code:
5819 @smallexample
5820 narrow op0, op1, op2;
5821 @dots{}
5822 op0 = (narrow) (((wide) op1 + (wide) op2 + 1) >> 1);
5823 @end smallexample
5824
5825 @cindex @code{bswap@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5826 @item @samp{bswap@var{m}2}
5827 Reverse the order of bytes of operand 1 and store the result in operand 0.
5828
5829 @cindex @code{neg@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5830 @cindex @code{ssneg@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5831 @cindex @code{usneg@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5832 @item @samp{neg@var{m}2}, @samp{ssneg@var{m}2}, @samp{usneg@var{m}2}
5833 Negate operand 1 and store the result in operand 0.
5834
5835 @cindex @code{negv@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5836 @item @samp{negv@var{m}3}
5837 Like @code{neg@var{m}2} but takes a @code{code_label} as operand 2 and
5838 emits code to jump to it if signed overflow occurs during the negation.
5839
5840 @cindex @code{abs@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5841 @item @samp{abs@var{m}2}
5842 Store the absolute value of operand 1 into operand 0.
5843
5844 @cindex @code{sqrt@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5845 @item @samp{sqrt@var{m}2}
5846 Store the square root of operand 1 into operand 0. Both operands have
5847 mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
5848
5849 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5850
5851 @cindex @code{rsqrt@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5852 @item @samp{rsqrt@var{m}2}
5853 Store the reciprocal of the square root of operand 1 into operand 0.
5854 Both operands have mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector
5855 floating-point mode.
5856
5857 On most architectures this pattern is only approximate, so either
5858 its C condition or the @code{TARGET_OPTAB_SUPPORTED_P} hook should
5859 check for the appropriate math flags. (Using the C condition is
5860 more direct, but using @code{TARGET_OPTAB_SUPPORTED_P} can be useful
5861 if a target-specific built-in also uses the @samp{rsqrt@var{m}2}
5862 pattern.)
5863
5864 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5865
5866 @cindex @code{fmod@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5867 @item @samp{fmod@var{m}3}
5868 Store the remainder of dividing operand 1 by operand 2 into
5869 operand 0, rounded towards zero to an integer. All operands have
5870 mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
5871
5872 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5873
5874 @cindex @code{remainder@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5875 @item @samp{remainder@var{m}3}
5876 Store the remainder of dividing operand 1 by operand 2 into
5877 operand 0, rounded to the nearest integer. All operands have
5878 mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
5879
5880 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5881
5882 @cindex @code{scalb@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5883 @item @samp{scalb@var{m}3}
5884 Raise @code{FLT_RADIX} to the power of operand 2, multiply it by
5885 operand 1, and store the result in operand 0. All operands have
5886 mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
5887
5888 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5889
5890 @cindex @code{ldexp@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5891 @item @samp{ldexp@var{m}3}
5892 Raise 2 to the power of operand 2, multiply it by operand 1, and store
5893 the result in operand 0. Operands 0 and 1 have mode @var{m}, which is
5894 a scalar or vector floating-point mode. Operand 2's mode has
5895 the same number of elements as @var{m} and each element is wide
5896 enough to store an @code{int}. The integers are signed.
5897
5898 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5899
5900 @cindex @code{cos@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5901 @item @samp{cos@var{m}2}
5902 Store the cosine of operand 1 into operand 0. Both operands have
5903 mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
5904
5905 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5906
5907 @cindex @code{sin@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5908 @item @samp{sin@var{m}2}
5909 Store the sine of operand 1 into operand 0. Both operands have
5910 mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
5911
5912 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5913
5914 @cindex @code{sincos@var{m}3} instruction pattern
5915 @item @samp{sincos@var{m}3}
5916 Store the cosine of operand 2 into operand 0 and the sine of
5917 operand 2 into operand 1. All operands have mode @var{m},
5918 which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
5919
5920 Targets that can calculate the sine and cosine simultaneously can
5921 implement this pattern as opposed to implementing individual
5922 @code{sin@var{m}2} and @code{cos@var{m}2} patterns. The @code{sin}
5923 and @code{cos} built-in functions will then be expanded to the
5924 @code{sincos@var{m}3} pattern, with one of the output values
5925 left unused.
5926
5927 @cindex @code{tan@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5928 @item @samp{tan@var{m}2}
5929 Store the tangent of operand 1 into operand 0. Both operands have
5930 mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
5931
5932 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5933
5934 @cindex @code{asin@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5935 @item @samp{asin@var{m}2}
5936 Store the arc sine of operand 1 into operand 0. Both operands have
5937 mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
5938
5939 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5940
5941 @cindex @code{acos@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5942 @item @samp{acos@var{m}2}
5943 Store the arc cosine of operand 1 into operand 0. Both operands have
5944 mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
5945
5946 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5947
5948 @cindex @code{atan@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5949 @item @samp{atan@var{m}2}
5950 Store the arc tangent of operand 1 into operand 0. Both operands have
5951 mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
5952
5953 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5954
5955 @cindex @code{exp@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5956 @item @samp{exp@var{m}2}
5957 Raise e (the base of natural logarithms) to the power of operand 1
5958 and store the result in operand 0. Both operands have mode @var{m},
5959 which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
5960
5961 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5962
5963 @cindex @code{expm1@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5964 @item @samp{expm1@var{m}2}
5965 Raise e (the base of natural logarithms) to the power of operand 1,
5966 subtract 1, and store the result in operand 0. Both operands have
5967 mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
5968
5969 For inputs close to zero, the pattern is expected to be more
5970 accurate than a separate @code{exp@var{m}2} and @code{sub@var{m}3}
5971 would be.
5972
5973 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5974
5975 @cindex @code{exp10@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5976 @item @samp{exp10@var{m}2}
5977 Raise 10 to the power of operand 1 and store the result in operand 0.
5978 Both operands have mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector
5979 floating-point mode.
5980
5981 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5982
5983 @cindex @code{exp2@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5984 @item @samp{exp2@var{m}2}
5985 Raise 2 to the power of operand 1 and store the result in operand 0.
5986 Both operands have mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector
5987 floating-point mode.
5988
5989 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5990
5991 @cindex @code{log@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5992 @item @samp{log@var{m}2}
5993 Store the natural logarithm of operand 1 into operand 0. Both operands
5994 have mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
5995
5996 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
5997
5998 @cindex @code{log1p@var{m}2} instruction pattern
5999 @item @samp{log1p@var{m}2}
6000 Add 1 to operand 1, compute the natural logarithm, and store
6001 the result in operand 0. Both operands have mode @var{m}, which is
6002 a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
6003
6004 For inputs close to zero, the pattern is expected to be more
6005 accurate than a separate @code{add@var{m}3} and @code{log@var{m}2}
6006 would be.
6007
6008 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
6009
6010 @cindex @code{log10@var{m}2} instruction pattern
6011 @item @samp{log10@var{m}2}
6012 Store the base-10 logarithm of operand 1 into operand 0. Both operands
6013 have mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
6014
6015 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
6016
6017 @cindex @code{log2@var{m}2} instruction pattern
6018 @item @samp{log2@var{m}2}
6019 Store the base-2 logarithm of operand 1 into operand 0. Both operands
6020 have mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
6021
6022 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
6023
6024 @cindex @code{logb@var{m}2} instruction pattern
6025 @item @samp{logb@var{m}2}
6026 Store the base-@code{FLT_RADIX} logarithm of operand 1 into operand 0.
6027 Both operands have mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector
6028 floating-point mode.
6029
6030 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
6031
6032 @cindex @code{significand@var{m}2} instruction pattern
6033 @item @samp{significand@var{m}2}
6034 Store the significand of floating-point operand 1 in operand 0.
6035 Both operands have mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector
6036 floating-point mode.
6037
6038 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
6039
6040 @cindex @code{pow@var{m}3} instruction pattern
6041 @item @samp{pow@var{m}3}
6042 Store the value of operand 1 raised to the exponent operand 2
6043 into operand 0. All operands have mode @var{m}, which is a scalar
6044 or vector floating-point mode.
6045
6046 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
6047
6048 @cindex @code{atan2@var{m}3} instruction pattern
6049 @item @samp{atan2@var{m}3}
6050 Store the arc tangent (inverse tangent) of operand 1 divided by
6051 operand 2 into operand 0, using the signs of both arguments to
6052 determine the quadrant of the result. All operands have mode
6053 @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
6054
6055 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
6056
6057 @cindex @code{floor@var{m}2} instruction pattern
6058 @item @samp{floor@var{m}2}
6059 Store the largest integral value not greater than operand 1 in operand 0.
6060 Both operands have mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector
6061 floating-point mode. If @option{-ffp-int-builtin-inexact} is in
6062 effect, the ``inexact'' exception may be raised for noninteger
6063 operands; otherwise, it may not.
6064
6065 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
6066
6067 @cindex @code{btrunc@var{m}2} instruction pattern
6068 @item @samp{btrunc@var{m}2}
6069 Round operand 1 to an integer, towards zero, and store the result in
6070 operand 0. Both operands have mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or
6071 vector floating-point mode. If @option{-ffp-int-builtin-inexact} is
6072 in effect, the ``inexact'' exception may be raised for noninteger
6073 operands; otherwise, it may not.
6074
6075 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
6076
6077 @cindex @code{round@var{m}2} instruction pattern
6078 @item @samp{round@var{m}2}
6079 Round operand 1 to the nearest integer, rounding away from zero in the
6080 event of a tie, and store the result in operand 0. Both operands have
6081 mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode. If
6082 @option{-ffp-int-builtin-inexact} is in effect, the ``inexact''
6083 exception may be raised for noninteger operands; otherwise, it may
6084 not.
6085
6086 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
6087
6088 @cindex @code{ceil@var{m}2} instruction pattern
6089 @item @samp{ceil@var{m}2}
6090 Store the smallest integral value not less than operand 1 in operand 0.
6091 Both operands have mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector
6092 floating-point mode. If @option{-ffp-int-builtin-inexact} is in
6093 effect, the ``inexact'' exception may be raised for noninteger
6094 operands; otherwise, it may not.
6095
6096 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
6097
6098 @cindex @code{nearbyint@var{m}2} instruction pattern
6099 @item @samp{nearbyint@var{m}2}
6100 Round operand 1 to an integer, using the current rounding mode, and
6101 store the result in operand 0. Do not raise an inexact condition when
6102 the result is different from the argument. Both operands have mode
6103 @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
6104
6105 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
6106
6107 @cindex @code{rint@var{m}2} instruction pattern
6108 @item @samp{rint@var{m}2}
6109 Round operand 1 to an integer, using the current rounding mode, and
6110 store the result in operand 0. Raise an inexact condition when
6111 the result is different from the argument. Both operands have mode
6112 @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector floating-point mode.
6113
6114 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
6115
6116 @cindex @code{lrint@var{m}@var{n}2}
6117 @item @samp{lrint@var{m}@var{n}2}
6118 Convert operand 1 (valid for floating point mode @var{m}) to fixed
6119 point mode @var{n} as a signed number according to the current
6120 rounding mode and store in operand 0 (which has mode @var{n}).
6121
6122 @cindex @code{lround@var{m}@var{n}2}
6123 @item @samp{lround@var{m}@var{n}2}
6124 Convert operand 1 (valid for floating point mode @var{m}) to fixed
6125 point mode @var{n} as a signed number rounding to nearest and away
6126 from zero and store in operand 0 (which has mode @var{n}).
6127
6128 @cindex @code{lfloor@var{m}@var{n}2}
6129 @item @samp{lfloor@var{m}@var{n}2}
6130 Convert operand 1 (valid for floating point mode @var{m}) to fixed
6131 point mode @var{n} as a signed number rounding down and store in
6132 operand 0 (which has mode @var{n}).
6133
6134 @cindex @code{lceil@var{m}@var{n}2}
6135 @item @samp{lceil@var{m}@var{n}2}
6136 Convert operand 1 (valid for floating point mode @var{m}) to fixed
6137 point mode @var{n} as a signed number rounding up and store in
6138 operand 0 (which has mode @var{n}).
6139
6140 @cindex @code{copysign@var{m}3} instruction pattern
6141 @item @samp{copysign@var{m}3}
6142 Store a value with the magnitude of operand 1 and the sign of operand
6143 2 into operand 0. All operands have mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or
6144 vector floating-point mode.
6145
6146 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
6147
6148 @cindex @code{xorsign@var{m}3} instruction pattern
6149 @item @samp{xorsign@var{m}3}
6150 Equivalent to @samp{op0 = op1 * copysign (1.0, op2)}: store a value with
6151 the magnitude of operand 1 and the sign of operand 2 into operand 0.
6152 All operands have mode @var{m}, which is a scalar or vector
6153 floating-point mode.
6154
6155 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
6156
6157 @cindex @code{cadd90@var{m}3} instruction pattern
6158 @item @samp{cadd90@var{m}3}
6159 Perform vector add and subtract on even/odd number pairs. The operation being
6160 matched is semantically described as
6161
6162 @smallexample
6163 for (int i = 0; i < N; i += 2)
6164 @{
6165 c[i] = a[i] - b[i+1];
6166 c[i+1] = a[i+1] + b[i];
6167 @}
6168 @end smallexample
6169
6170 This operation is semantically equivalent to performing a vector addition of
6171 complex numbers in operand 1 with operand 2 rotated by 90 degrees around
6172 the argand plane and storing the result in operand 0.
6173
6174 In GCC lane ordering the real part of the number must be in the even lanes with
6175 the imaginary part in the odd lanes.
6176
6177 The operation is only supported for vector modes @var{m}.
6178
6179 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
6180
6181 @cindex @code{cadd270@var{m}3} instruction pattern
6182 @item @samp{cadd270@var{m}3}
6183 Perform vector add and subtract on even/odd number pairs. The operation being
6184 matched is semantically described as
6185
6186 @smallexample
6187 for (int i = 0; i < N; i += 2)
6188 @{
6189 c[i] = a[i] + b[i+1];
6190 c[i+1] = a[i+1] - b[i];
6191 @}
6192 @end smallexample
6193
6194 This operation is semantically equivalent to performing a vector addition of
6195 complex numbers in operand 1 with operand 2 rotated by 270 degrees around
6196 the argand plane and storing the result in operand 0.
6197
6198 In GCC lane ordering the real part of the number must be in the even lanes with
6199 the imaginary part in the odd lanes.
6200
6201 The operation is only supported for vector modes @var{m}.
6202
6203 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
6204
6205 @cindex @code{ffs@var{m}2} instruction pattern
6206 @item @samp{ffs@var{m}2}
6207 Store into operand 0 one plus the index of the least significant 1-bit
6208 of operand 1. If operand 1 is zero, store zero.
6209
6210 @var{m} is either a scalar or vector integer mode. When it is a scalar,
6211 operand 1 has mode @var{m} but operand 0 can have whatever scalar
6212 integer mode is suitable for the target. The compiler will insert
6213 conversion instructions as necessary (typically to convert the result
6214 to the same width as @code{int}). When @var{m} is a vector, both
6215 operands must have mode @var{m}.
6216
6217 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
6218
6219 @cindex @code{clrsb@var{m}2} instruction pattern
6220 @item @samp{clrsb@var{m}2}
6221 Count leading redundant sign bits.
6222 Store into operand 0 the number of redundant sign bits in operand 1, starting
6223 at the most significant bit position.
6224 A redundant sign bit is defined as any sign bit after the first. As such,
6225 this count will be one less than the count of leading sign bits.
6226
6227 @var{m} is either a scalar or vector integer mode. When it is a scalar,
6228 operand 1 has mode @var{m} but operand 0 can have whatever scalar
6229 integer mode is suitable for the target. The compiler will insert
6230 conversion instructions as necessary (typically to convert the result
6231 to the same width as @code{int}). When @var{m} is a vector, both
6232 operands must have mode @var{m}.
6233
6234 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
6235
6236 @cindex @code{clz@var{m}2} instruction pattern
6237 @item @samp{clz@var{m}2}
6238 Store into operand 0 the number of leading 0-bits in operand 1, starting
6239 at the most significant bit position. If operand 1 is 0, the
6240 @code{CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO} (@pxref{Misc}) macro defines if
6241 the result is undefined or has a useful value.
6242
6243 @var{m} is either a scalar or vector integer mode. When it is a scalar,
6244 operand 1 has mode @var{m} but operand 0 can have whatever scalar
6245 integer mode is suitable for the target. The compiler will insert
6246 conversion instructions as necessary (typically to convert the result
6247 to the same width as @code{int}). When @var{m} is a vector, both
6248 operands must have mode @var{m}.
6249
6250 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
6251
6252 @cindex @code{ctz@var{m}2} instruction pattern
6253 @item @samp{ctz@var{m}2}
6254 Store into operand 0 the number of trailing 0-bits in operand 1, starting
6255 at the least significant bit position. If operand 1 is 0, the
6256 @code{CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO} (@pxref{Misc}) macro defines if
6257 the result is undefined or has a useful value.
6258
6259 @var{m} is either a scalar or vector integer mode. When it is a scalar,
6260 operand 1 has mode @var{m} but operand 0 can have whatever scalar
6261 integer mode is suitable for the target. The compiler will insert
6262 conversion instructions as necessary (typically to convert the result
6263 to the same width as @code{int}). When @var{m} is a vector, both
6264 operands must have mode @var{m}.
6265
6266 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
6267
6268 @cindex @code{popcount@var{m}2} instruction pattern
6269 @item @samp{popcount@var{m}2}
6270 Store into operand 0 the number of 1-bits in operand 1.
6271
6272 @var{m} is either a scalar or vector integer mode. When it is a scalar,
6273 operand 1 has mode @var{m} but operand 0 can have whatever scalar
6274 integer mode is suitable for the target. The compiler will insert
6275 conversion instructions as necessary (typically to convert the result
6276 to the same width as @code{int}). When @var{m} is a vector, both
6277 operands must have mode @var{m}.
6278
6279 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
6280
6281 @cindex @code{parity@var{m}2} instruction pattern
6282 @item @samp{parity@var{m}2}
6283 Store into operand 0 the parity of operand 1, i.e.@: the number of 1-bits
6284 in operand 1 modulo 2.
6285
6286 @var{m} is either a scalar or vector integer mode. When it is a scalar,
6287 operand 1 has mode @var{m} but operand 0 can have whatever scalar
6288 integer mode is suitable for the target. The compiler will insert
6289 conversion instructions as necessary (typically to convert the result
6290 to the same width as @code{int}). When @var{m} is a vector, both
6291 operands must have mode @var{m}.
6292
6293 This pattern is not allowed to @code{FAIL}.
6294
6295 @cindex @code{one_cmpl@var{m}2} instruction pattern
6296 @item @samp{one_cmpl@var{m}2}
6297 Store the bitwise-complement of operand 1 into operand 0.
6298
6299 @cindex @code{cpymem@var{m}} instruction pattern
6300 @item @samp{cpymem@var{m}}
6301 Block copy instruction. The destination and source blocks of memory
6302 are the first two operands, and both are @code{mem:BLK}s with an
6303 address in mode @code{Pmode}.
6304
6305 The number of bytes to copy is the third operand, in mode @var{m}.
6306 Usually, you specify @code{Pmode} for @var{m}. However, if you can
6307 generate better code knowing the range of valid lengths is smaller than
6308 those representable in a full Pmode pointer, you should provide
6309 a pattern with a
6310 mode corresponding to the range of values you can handle efficiently
6311 (e.g., @code{QImode} for values in the range 0--127; note we avoid numbers
6312 that appear negative) and also a pattern with @code{Pmode}.
6313
6314 The fourth operand is the known shared alignment of the source and
6315 destination, in the form of a @code{const_int} rtx. Thus, if the
6316 compiler knows that both source and destination are word-aligned,
6317 it may provide the value 4 for this operand.
6318
6319 Optional operands 5 and 6 specify expected alignment and size of block
6320 respectively. The expected alignment differs from alignment in operand 4
6321 in a way that the blocks are not required to be aligned according to it in
6322 all cases. This expected alignment is also in bytes, just like operand 4.
6323 Expected size, when unknown, is set to @code{(const_int -1)}.
6324
6325 Descriptions of multiple @code{cpymem@var{m}} patterns can only be
6326 beneficial if the patterns for smaller modes have fewer restrictions
6327 on their first, second and fourth operands. Note that the mode @var{m}
6328 in @code{cpymem@var{m}} does not impose any restriction on the mode of
6329 individually copied data units in the block.
6330
6331 The @code{cpymem@var{m}} patterns need not give special consideration
6332 to the possibility that the source and destination strings might
6333 overlap. These patterns are used to do inline expansion of
6334 @code{__builtin_memcpy}.
6335
6336 @cindex @code{movmem@var{m}} instruction pattern
6337 @item @samp{movmem@var{m}}
6338 Block move instruction. The destination and source blocks of memory
6339 are the first two operands, and both are @code{mem:BLK}s with an
6340 address in mode @code{Pmode}.
6341
6342 The number of bytes to copy is the third operand, in mode @var{m}.
6343 Usually, you specify @code{Pmode} for @var{m}. However, if you can
6344 generate better code knowing the range of valid lengths is smaller than
6345 those representable in a full Pmode pointer, you should provide
6346 a pattern with a
6347 mode corresponding to the range of values you can handle efficiently
6348 (e.g., @code{QImode} for values in the range 0--127; note we avoid numbers
6349 that appear negative) and also a pattern with @code{Pmode}.
6350
6351 The fourth operand is the known shared alignment of the source and
6352 destination, in the form of a @code{const_int} rtx. Thus, if the
6353 compiler knows that both source and destination are word-aligned,
6354 it may provide the value 4 for this operand.
6355
6356 Optional operands 5 and 6 specify expected alignment and size of block
6357 respectively. The expected alignment differs from alignment in operand 4
6358 in a way that the blocks are not required to be aligned according to it in
6359 all cases. This expected alignment is also in bytes, just like operand 4.
6360 Expected size, when unknown, is set to @code{(const_int -1)}.
6361
6362 Descriptions of multiple @code{movmem@var{m}} patterns can only be
6363 beneficial if the patterns for smaller modes have fewer restrictions
6364 on their first, second and fourth operands. Note that the mode @var{m}
6365 in @code{movmem@var{m}} does not impose any restriction on the mode of
6366 individually copied data units in the block.
6367
6368 The @code{movmem@var{m}} patterns must correctly handle the case where
6369 the source and destination strings overlap. These patterns are used to
6370 do inline expansion of @code{__builtin_memmove}.
6371
6372 @cindex @code{movstr} instruction pattern
6373 @item @samp{movstr}
6374 String copy instruction, with @code{stpcpy} semantics. Operand 0 is
6375 an output operand in mode @code{Pmode}. The addresses of the
6376 destination and source strings are operands 1 and 2, and both are
6377 @code{mem:BLK}s with addresses in mode @code{Pmode}. The execution of
6378 the expansion of this pattern should store in operand 0 the address in
6379 which the @code{NUL} terminator was stored in the destination string.
6380
6381 This pattern has also several optional operands that are same as in
6382 @code{setmem}.
6383
6384 @cindex @code{setmem@var{m}} instruction pattern
6385 @item @samp{setmem@var{m}}
6386 Block set instruction. The destination string is the first operand,
6387 given as a @code{mem:BLK} whose address is in mode @code{Pmode}. The
6388 number of bytes to set is the second operand, in mode @var{m}. The value to
6389 initialize the memory with is the third operand. Targets that only support the
6390 clearing of memory should reject any value that is not the constant 0. See
6391 @samp{cpymem@var{m}} for a discussion of the choice of mode.
6392
6393 The fourth operand is the known alignment of the destination, in the form
6394 of a @code{const_int} rtx. Thus, if the compiler knows that the
6395 destination is word-aligned, it may provide the value 4 for this
6396 operand.
6397
6398 Optional operands 5 and 6 specify expected alignment and size of block
6399 respectively. The expected alignment differs from alignment in operand 4
6400 in a way that the blocks are not required to be aligned according to it in
6401 all cases. This expected alignment is also in bytes, just like operand 4.
6402 Expected size, when unknown, is set to @code{(const_int -1)}.
6403 Operand 7 is the minimal size of the block and operand 8 is the
6404 maximal size of the block (NULL if it cannot be represented as CONST_INT).
6405 Operand 9 is the probable maximal size (i.e.@: we cannot rely on it for
6406 correctness, but it can be used for choosing proper code sequence for a
6407 given size).
6408
6409 The use for multiple @code{setmem@var{m}} is as for @code{cpymem@var{m}}.
6410
6411 @cindex @code{cmpstrn@var{m}} instruction pattern
6412 @item @samp{cmpstrn@var{m}}
6413 String compare instruction, with five operands. Operand 0 is the output;
6414 it has mode @var{m}. The remaining four operands are like the operands
6415 of @samp{cpymem@var{m}}. The two memory blocks specified are compared
6416 byte by byte in lexicographic order starting at the beginning of each
6417 string. The instruction is not allowed to prefetch more than one byte
6418 at a time since either string may end in the first byte and reading past
6419 that may access an invalid page or segment and cause a fault. The
6420 comparison terminates early if the fetched bytes are different or if
6421 they are equal to zero. The effect of the instruction is to store a
6422 value in operand 0 whose sign indicates the result of the comparison.
6423
6424 @cindex @code{cmpstr@var{m}} instruction pattern
6425 @item @samp{cmpstr@var{m}}
6426 String compare instruction, without known maximum length. Operand 0 is the
6427 output; it has mode @var{m}. The second and third operand are the blocks of
6428 memory to be compared; both are @code{mem:BLK} with an address in mode
6429 @code{Pmode}.
6430
6431 The fourth operand is the known shared alignment of the source and
6432 destination, in the form of a @code{const_int} rtx. Thus, if the
6433 compiler knows that both source and destination are word-aligned,
6434 it may provide the value 4 for this operand.
6435
6436 The two memory blocks specified are compared byte by byte in lexicographic
6437 order starting at the beginning of each string. The instruction is not allowed
6438 to prefetch more than one byte at a time since either string may end in the
6439 first byte and reading past that may access an invalid page or segment and
6440 cause a fault. The comparison will terminate when the fetched bytes
6441 are different or if they are equal to zero. The effect of the
6442 instruction is to store a value in operand 0 whose sign indicates the
6443 result of the comparison.
6444
6445 @cindex @code{cmpmem@var{m}} instruction pattern
6446 @item @samp{cmpmem@var{m}}
6447 Block compare instruction, with five operands like the operands
6448 of @samp{cmpstr@var{m}}. The two memory blocks specified are compared
6449 byte by byte in lexicographic order starting at the beginning of each
6450 block. Unlike @samp{cmpstr@var{m}} the instruction can prefetch
6451 any bytes in the two memory blocks. Also unlike @samp{cmpstr@var{m}}
6452 the comparison will not stop if both bytes are zero. The effect of
6453 the instruction is to store a value in operand 0 whose sign indicates
6454 the result of the comparison.
6455
6456 @cindex @code{strlen@var{m}} instruction pattern
6457 @item @samp{strlen@var{m}}
6458 Compute the length of a string, with three operands.
6459 Operand 0 is the result (of mode @var{m}), operand 1 is
6460 a @code{mem} referring to the first character of the string,
6461 operand 2 is the character to search for (normally zero),
6462 and operand 3 is a constant describing the known alignment
6463 of the beginning of the string.
6464
6465 @cindex @code{float@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
6466 @item @samp{float@var{m}@var{n}2}
6467 Convert signed integer operand 1 (valid for fixed point mode @var{m}) to
6468 floating point mode @var{n} and store in operand 0 (which has mode
6469 @var{n}).
6470
6471 @cindex @code{floatuns@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
6472 @item @samp{floatuns@var{m}@var{n}2}
6473 Convert unsigned integer operand 1 (valid for fixed point mode @var{m})
6474 to floating point mode @var{n} and store in operand 0 (which has mode
6475 @var{n}).
6476
6477 @cindex @code{fix@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
6478 @item @samp{fix@var{m}@var{n}2}
6479 Convert operand 1 (valid for floating point mode @var{m}) to fixed
6480 point mode @var{n} as a signed number and store in operand 0 (which
6481 has mode @var{n}). This instruction's result is defined only when
6482 the value of operand 1 is an integer.
6483
6484 If the machine description defines this pattern, it also needs to
6485 define the @code{ftrunc} pattern.
6486
6487 @cindex @code{fixuns@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
6488 @item @samp{fixuns@var{m}@var{n}2}
6489 Convert operand 1 (valid for floating point mode @var{m}) to fixed
6490 point mode @var{n} as an unsigned number and store in operand 0 (which
6491 has mode @var{n}). This instruction's result is defined only when the
6492 value of operand 1 is an integer.
6493
6494 @cindex @code{ftrunc@var{m}2} instruction pattern
6495 @item @samp{ftrunc@var{m}2}
6496 Convert operand 1 (valid for floating point mode @var{m}) to an
6497 integer value, still represented in floating point mode @var{m}, and
6498 store it in operand 0 (valid for floating point mode @var{m}).
6499
6500 @cindex @code{fix_trunc@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
6501 @item @samp{fix_trunc@var{m}@var{n}2}
6502 Like @samp{fix@var{m}@var{n}2} but works for any floating point value
6503 of mode @var{m} by converting the value to an integer.
6504
6505 @cindex @code{fixuns_trunc@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
6506 @item @samp{fixuns_trunc@var{m}@var{n}2}
6507 Like @samp{fixuns@var{m}@var{n}2} but works for any floating point
6508 value of mode @var{m} by converting the value to an integer.
6509
6510 @cindex @code{trunc@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
6511 @item @samp{trunc@var{m}@var{n}2}
6512 Truncate operand 1 (valid for mode @var{m}) to mode @var{n} and
6513 store in operand 0 (which has mode @var{n}). Both modes must be fixed
6514 point or both floating point.
6515
6516 @cindex @code{extend@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
6517 @item @samp{extend@var{m}@var{n}2}
6518 Sign-extend operand 1 (valid for mode @var{m}) to mode @var{n} and
6519 store in operand 0 (which has mode @var{n}). Both modes must be fixed
6520 point or both floating point.
6521
6522 @cindex @code{zero_extend@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
6523 @item @samp{zero_extend@var{m}@var{n}2}
6524 Zero-extend operand 1 (valid for mode @var{m}) to mode @var{n} and
6525 store in operand 0 (which has mode @var{n}). Both modes must be fixed
6526 point.
6527
6528 @cindex @code{fract@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
6529 @item @samp{fract@var{m}@var{n}2}
6530 Convert operand 1 of mode @var{m} to mode @var{n} and store in
6531 operand 0 (which has mode @var{n}). Mode @var{m} and mode @var{n}
6532 could be fixed-point to fixed-point, signed integer to fixed-point,
6533 fixed-point to signed integer, floating-point to fixed-point,
6534 or fixed-point to floating-point.
6535 When overflows or underflows happen, the results are undefined.
6536
6537 @cindex @code{satfract@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
6538 @item @samp{satfract@var{m}@var{n}2}
6539 Convert operand 1 of mode @var{m} to mode @var{n} and store in
6540 operand 0 (which has mode @var{n}). Mode @var{m} and mode @var{n}
6541 could be fixed-point to fixed-point, signed integer to fixed-point,
6542 or floating-point to fixed-point.
6543 When overflows or underflows happen, the instruction saturates the
6544 results to the maximum or the minimum.
6545
6546 @cindex @code{fractuns@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
6547 @item @samp{fractuns@var{m}@var{n}2}
6548 Convert operand 1 of mode @var{m} to mode @var{n} and store in
6549 operand 0 (which has mode @var{n}). Mode @var{m} and mode @var{n}
6550 could be unsigned integer to fixed-point, or
6551 fixed-point to unsigned integer.
6552 When overflows or underflows happen, the results are undefined.
6553
6554 @cindex @code{satfractuns@var{m}@var{n}2} instruction pattern
6555 @item @samp{satfractuns@var{m}@var{n}2}
6556 Convert unsigned integer operand 1 of mode @var{m} to fixed-point mode
6557 @var{n} and store in operand 0 (which has mode @var{n}).
6558 When overflows or underflows happen, the instruction saturates the
6559 results to the maximum or the minimum.
6560
6561 @cindex @code{extv@var{m}} instruction pattern
6562 @item @samp{extv@var{m}}
6563 Extract a bit-field from register operand 1, sign-extend it, and store
6564 it in operand 0. Operand 2 specifies the width of the field in bits
6565 and operand 3 the starting bit, which counts from the most significant
6566 bit if @samp{BITS_BIG_ENDIAN} is true and from the least significant bit
6567 otherwise.
6568
6569 Operands 0 and 1 both have mode @var{m}. Operands 2 and 3 have a
6570 target-specific mode.
6571
6572 @cindex @code{extvmisalign@var{m}} instruction pattern
6573 @item @samp{extvmisalign@var{m}}
6574 Extract a bit-field from memory operand 1, sign extend it, and store
6575 it in operand 0. Operand 2 specifies the width in bits and operand 3
6576 the starting bit. The starting bit is always somewhere in the first byte of
6577 operand 1; it counts from the most significant bit if @samp{BITS_BIG_ENDIAN}
6578 is true and from the least significant bit otherwise.
6579
6580 Operand 0 has mode @var{m} while operand 1 has @code{BLK} mode.
6581 Operands 2 and 3 have a target-specific mode.
6582
6583 The instruction must not read beyond the last byte of the bit-field.
6584
6585 @cindex @code{extzv@var{m}} instruction pattern
6586 @item @samp{extzv@var{m}}
6587 Like @samp{extv@var{m}} except that the bit-field value is zero-extended.
6588
6589 @cindex @code{extzvmisalign@var{m}} instruction pattern
6590 @item @samp{extzvmisalign@var{m}}
6591 Like @samp{extvmisalign@var{m}} except that the bit-field value is
6592 zero-extended.
6593
6594 @cindex @code{insv@var{m}} instruction pattern
6595 @item @samp{insv@var{m}}
6596 Insert operand 3 into a bit-field of register operand 0. Operand 1
6597 specifies the width of the field in bits and operand 2 the starting bit,
6598 which counts from the most significant bit if @samp{BITS_BIG_ENDIAN}
6599 is true and from the least significant bit otherwise.
6600
6601 Operands 0 and 3 both have mode @var{m}. Operands 1 and 2 have a
6602 target-specific mode.
6603
6604 @cindex @code{insvmisalign@var{m}} instruction pattern
6605 @item @samp{insvmisalign@var{m}}
6606 Insert operand 3 into a bit-field of memory operand 0. Operand 1
6607 specifies the width of the field in bits and operand 2 the starting bit.
6608 The starting bit is always somewhere in the first byte of operand 0;
6609 it counts from the most significant bit if @samp{BITS_BIG_ENDIAN}
6610 is true and from the least significant bit otherwise.
6611
6612 Operand 3 has mode @var{m} while operand 0 has @code{BLK} mode.
6613 Operands 1 and 2 have a target-specific mode.
6614
6615 The instruction must not read or write beyond the last byte of the bit-field.
6616
6617 @cindex @code{extv} instruction pattern
6618 @item @samp{extv}
6619 Extract a bit-field from operand 1 (a register or memory operand), where
6620 operand 2 specifies the width in bits and operand 3 the starting bit,
6621 and store it in operand 0. Operand 0 must have mode @code{word_mode}.
6622 Operand 1 may have mode @code{byte_mode} or @code{word_mode}; often
6623 @code{word_mode} is allowed only for registers. Operands 2 and 3 must
6624 be valid for @code{word_mode}.
6625
6626 The RTL generation pass generates this instruction only with constants
6627 for operands 2 and 3 and the constant is never zero for operand 2.
6628
6629 The bit-field value is sign-extended to a full word integer
6630 before it is stored in operand 0.
6631
6632 This pattern is deprecated; please use @samp{extv@var{m}} and
6633 @code{extvmisalign@var{m}} instead.
6634
6635 @cindex @code{extzv} instruction pattern
6636 @item @samp{extzv}
6637 Like @samp{extv} except that the bit-field value is zero-extended.
6638
6639 This pattern is deprecated; please use @samp{extzv@var{m}} and
6640 @code{extzvmisalign@var{m}} instead.
6641
6642 @cindex @code{insv} instruction pattern
6643 @item @samp{insv}
6644 Store operand 3 (which must be valid for @code{word_mode}) into a
6645 bit-field in operand 0, where operand 1 specifies the width in bits and
6646 operand 2 the starting bit. Operand 0 may have mode @code{byte_mode} or
6647 @code{word_mode}; often @code{word_mode} is allowed only for registers.
6648 Operands 1 and 2 must be valid for @code{word_mode}.
6649
6650 The RTL generation pass generates this instruction only with constants
6651 for operands 1 and 2 and the constant is never zero for operand 1.
6652
6653 This pattern is deprecated; please use @samp{insv@var{m}} and
6654 @code{insvmisalign@var{m}} instead.
6655
6656 @cindex @code{mov@var{mode}cc} instruction pattern
6657 @item @samp{mov@var{mode}cc}
6658 Conditionally move operand 2 or operand 3 into operand 0 according to the
6659 comparison in operand 1. If the comparison is true, operand 2 is moved
6660 into operand 0, otherwise operand 3 is moved.
6661
6662 The mode of the operands being compared need not be the same as the operands
6663 being moved. Some machines, sparc64 for example, have instructions that
6664 conditionally move an integer value based on the floating point condition
6665 codes and vice versa.
6666
6667 If the machine does not have conditional move instructions, do not
6668 define these patterns.
6669
6670 @cindex @code{add@var{mode}cc} instruction pattern
6671 @item @samp{add@var{mode}cc}
6672 Similar to @samp{mov@var{mode}cc} but for conditional addition. Conditionally
6673 move operand 2 or (operands 2 + operand 3) into operand 0 according to the
6674 comparison in operand 1. If the comparison is false, operand 2 is moved into
6675 operand 0, otherwise (operand 2 + operand 3) is moved.
6676
6677 @cindex @code{cond_add@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6678 @cindex @code{cond_sub@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6679 @cindex @code{cond_mul@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6680 @cindex @code{cond_div@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6681 @cindex @code{cond_udiv@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6682 @cindex @code{cond_mod@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6683 @cindex @code{cond_umod@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6684 @cindex @code{cond_and@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6685 @cindex @code{cond_ior@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6686 @cindex @code{cond_xor@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6687 @cindex @code{cond_smin@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6688 @cindex @code{cond_smax@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6689 @cindex @code{cond_umin@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6690 @cindex @code{cond_umax@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6691 @item @samp{cond_add@var{mode}}
6692 @itemx @samp{cond_sub@var{mode}}
6693 @itemx @samp{cond_mul@var{mode}}
6694 @itemx @samp{cond_div@var{mode}}
6695 @itemx @samp{cond_udiv@var{mode}}
6696 @itemx @samp{cond_mod@var{mode}}
6697 @itemx @samp{cond_umod@var{mode}}
6698 @itemx @samp{cond_and@var{mode}}
6699 @itemx @samp{cond_ior@var{mode}}
6700 @itemx @samp{cond_xor@var{mode}}
6701 @itemx @samp{cond_smin@var{mode}}
6702 @itemx @samp{cond_smax@var{mode}}
6703 @itemx @samp{cond_umin@var{mode}}
6704 @itemx @samp{cond_umax@var{mode}}
6705 When operand 1 is true, perform an operation on operands 2 and 3 and
6706 store the result in operand 0, otherwise store operand 4 in operand 0.
6707 The operation works elementwise if the operands are vectors.
6708
6709 The scalar case is equivalent to:
6710
6711 @smallexample
6712 op0 = op1 ? op2 @var{op} op3 : op4;
6713 @end smallexample
6714
6715 while the vector case is equivalent to:
6716
6717 @smallexample
6718 for (i = 0; i < GET_MODE_NUNITS (@var{m}); i++)
6719 op0[i] = op1[i] ? op2[i] @var{op} op3[i] : op4[i];
6720 @end smallexample
6721
6722 where, for example, @var{op} is @code{+} for @samp{cond_add@var{mode}}.
6723
6724 When defined for floating-point modes, the contents of @samp{op3[i]}
6725 are not interpreted if @samp{op1[i]} is false, just like they would not
6726 be in a normal C @samp{?:} condition.
6727
6728 Operands 0, 2, 3 and 4 all have mode @var{m}. Operand 1 is a scalar
6729 integer if @var{m} is scalar, otherwise it has the mode returned by
6730 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_GET_MASK_MODE}.
6731
6732 @cindex @code{cond_fma@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6733 @cindex @code{cond_fms@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6734 @cindex @code{cond_fnma@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6735 @cindex @code{cond_fnms@var{mode}} instruction pattern
6736 @item @samp{cond_fma@var{mode}}
6737 @itemx @samp{cond_fms@var{mode}}
6738 @itemx @samp{cond_fnma@var{mode}}
6739 @itemx @samp{cond_fnms@var{mode}}
6740 Like @samp{cond_add@var{m}}, except that the conditional operation
6741 takes 3 operands rather than two. For example, the vector form of
6742 @samp{cond_fma@var{mode}} is equivalent to:
6743
6744 @smallexample
6745 for (i = 0; i < GET_MODE_NUNITS (@var{m}); i++)
6746 op0[i] = op1[i] ? fma (op2[i], op3[i], op4[i]) : op5[i];
6747 @end smallexample
6748
6749 @cindex @code{neg@var{mode}cc} instruction pattern
6750 @item @samp{neg@var{mode}cc}
6751 Similar to @samp{mov@var{mode}cc} but for conditional negation. Conditionally
6752 move the negation of operand 2 or the unchanged operand 3 into operand 0
6753 according to the comparison in operand 1. If the comparison is true, the negation
6754 of operand 2 is moved into operand 0, otherwise operand 3 is moved.
6755
6756 @cindex @code{not@var{mode}cc} instruction pattern
6757 @item @samp{not@var{mode}cc}
6758 Similar to @samp{neg@var{mode}cc} but for conditional complement.
6759 Conditionally move the bitwise complement of operand 2 or the unchanged
6760 operand 3 into operand 0 according to the comparison in operand 1.
6761 If the comparison is true, the complement of operand 2 is moved into
6762 operand 0, otherwise operand 3 is moved.
6763
6764 @cindex @code{cstore@var{mode}4} instruction pattern
6765 @item @samp{cstore@var{mode}4}
6766 Store zero or nonzero in operand 0 according to whether a comparison
6767 is true. Operand 1 is a comparison operator. Operand 2 and operand 3
6768 are the first and second operand of the comparison, respectively.
6769 You specify the mode that operand 0 must have when you write the
6770 @code{match_operand} expression. The compiler automatically sees which
6771 mode you have used and supplies an operand of that mode.
6772
6773 The value stored for a true condition must have 1 as its low bit, or
6774 else must be negative. Otherwise the instruction is not suitable and
6775 you should omit it from the machine description. You describe to the
6776 compiler exactly which value is stored by defining the macro
6777 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} (@pxref{Misc}). If a description cannot be
6778 found that can be used for all the possible comparison operators, you
6779 should pick one and use a @code{define_expand} to map all results
6780 onto the one you chose.
6781
6782 These operations may @code{FAIL}, but should do so only in relatively
6783 uncommon cases; if they would @code{FAIL} for common cases involving
6784 integer comparisons, it is best to restrict the predicates to not
6785 allow these operands. Likewise if a given comparison operator will
6786 always fail, independent of the operands (for floating-point modes, the
6787 @code{ordered_comparison_operator} predicate is often useful in this case).
6788
6789 If this pattern is omitted, the compiler will generate a conditional
6790 branch---for example, it may copy a constant one to the target and branching
6791 around an assignment of zero to the target---or a libcall. If the predicate
6792 for operand 1 only rejects some operators, it will also try reordering the
6793 operands and/or inverting the result value (e.g.@: by an exclusive OR).
6794 These possibilities could be cheaper or equivalent to the instructions
6795 used for the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern followed by those required
6796 to convert a positive result from @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} to 1; in this
6797 case, you can and should make operand 1's predicate reject some operators
6798 in the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern, or remove the pattern altogether
6799 from the machine description.
6800
6801 @cindex @code{cbranch@var{mode}4} instruction pattern
6802 @item @samp{cbranch@var{mode}4}
6803 Conditional branch instruction combined with a compare instruction.
6804 Operand 0 is a comparison operator. Operand 1 and operand 2 are the
6805 first and second operands of the comparison, respectively. Operand 3
6806 is the @code{code_label} to jump to.
6807
6808 @cindex @code{jump} instruction pattern
6809 @item @samp{jump}
6810 A jump inside a function; an unconditional branch. Operand 0 is the
6811 @code{code_label} to jump to. This pattern name is mandatory on all
6812 machines.
6813
6814 @cindex @code{call} instruction pattern
6815 @item @samp{call}
6816 Subroutine call instruction returning no value. Operand 0 is the
6817 function to call; operand 1 is the number of bytes of arguments pushed
6818 as a @code{const_int}; operand 2 is the number of registers used as
6819 operands.
6820
6821 On most machines, operand 2 is not actually stored into the RTL
6822 pattern. It is supplied for the sake of some RISC machines which need
6823 to put this information into the assembler code; they can put it in
6824 the RTL instead of operand 1.
6825
6826 Operand 0 should be a @code{mem} RTX whose address is the address of the
6827 function. Note, however, that this address can be a @code{symbol_ref}
6828 expression even if it would not be a legitimate memory address on the
6829 target machine. If it is also not a valid argument for a call
6830 instruction, the pattern for this operation should be a
6831 @code{define_expand} (@pxref{Expander Definitions}) that places the
6832 address into a register and uses that register in the call instruction.
6833
6834 @cindex @code{call_value} instruction pattern
6835 @item @samp{call_value}
6836 Subroutine call instruction returning a value. Operand 0 is the hard
6837 register in which the value is returned. There are three more
6838 operands, the same as the three operands of the @samp{call}
6839 instruction (but with numbers increased by one).
6840
6841 Subroutines that return @code{BLKmode} objects use the @samp{call}
6842 insn.
6843
6844 @cindex @code{call_pop} instruction pattern
6845 @cindex @code{call_value_pop} instruction pattern
6846 @item @samp{call_pop}, @samp{call_value_pop}
6847 Similar to @samp{call} and @samp{call_value}, except used if defined and
6848 if @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is nonzero. They should emit a @code{parallel}
6849 that contains both the function call and a @code{set} to indicate the
6850 adjustment made to the frame pointer.
6851
6852 For machines where @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} can be nonzero, the use of these
6853 patterns increases the number of functions for which the frame pointer
6854 can be eliminated, if desired.
6855
6856 @cindex @code{untyped_call} instruction pattern
6857 @item @samp{untyped_call}
6858 Subroutine call instruction returning a value of any type. Operand 0 is
6859 the function to call; operand 1 is a memory location where the result of
6860 calling the function is to be stored; operand 2 is a @code{parallel}
6861 expression where each element is a @code{set} expression that indicates
6862 the saving of a function return value into the result block.
6863
6864 This instruction pattern should be defined to support
6865 @code{__builtin_apply} on machines where special instructions are needed
6866 to call a subroutine with arbitrary arguments or to save the value
6867 returned. This instruction pattern is required on machines that have
6868 multiple registers that can hold a return value
6869 (i.e.@: @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} is true for more than one register).
6870
6871 @cindex @code{return} instruction pattern
6872 @item @samp{return}
6873 Subroutine return instruction. This instruction pattern name should be
6874 defined only if a single instruction can do all the work of returning
6875 from a function.
6876
6877 Like the @samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, this pattern is also used after the
6878 RTL generation phase. In this case it is to support machines where
6879 multiple instructions are usually needed to return from a function, but
6880 some class of functions only requires one instruction to implement a
6881 return. Normally, the applicable functions are those which do not need
6882 to save any registers or allocate stack space.
6883
6884 It is valid for this pattern to expand to an instruction using
6885 @code{simple_return} if no epilogue is required.
6886
6887 @cindex @code{simple_return} instruction pattern
6888 @item @samp{simple_return}
6889 Subroutine return instruction. This instruction pattern name should be
6890 defined only if a single instruction can do all the work of returning
6891 from a function on a path where no epilogue is required. This pattern
6892 is very similar to the @code{return} instruction pattern, but it is emitted
6893 only by the shrink-wrapping optimization on paths where the function
6894 prologue has not been executed, and a function return should occur without
6895 any of the effects of the epilogue. Additional uses may be introduced on
6896 paths where both the prologue and the epilogue have executed.
6897
6898 @findex reload_completed
6899 @findex leaf_function_p
6900 For such machines, the condition specified in this pattern should only
6901 be true when @code{reload_completed} is nonzero and the function's
6902 epilogue would only be a single instruction. For machines with register
6903 windows, the routine @code{leaf_function_p} may be used to determine if
6904 a register window push is required.
6905
6906 Machines that have conditional return instructions should define patterns
6907 such as
6908
6909 @smallexample
6910 (define_insn ""
6911 [(set (pc)
6912 (if_then_else (match_operator
6913 0 "comparison_operator"
6914 [(cc0) (const_int 0)])
6915 (return)
6916 (pc)))]
6917 "@var{condition}"
6918 "@dots{}")
6919 @end smallexample
6920
6921 where @var{condition} would normally be the same condition specified on the
6922 named @samp{return} pattern.
6923
6924 @cindex @code{untyped_return} instruction pattern
6925 @item @samp{untyped_return}
6926 Untyped subroutine return instruction. This instruction pattern should
6927 be defined to support @code{__builtin_return} on machines where special
6928 instructions are needed to return a value of any type.
6929
6930 Operand 0 is a memory location where the result of calling a function
6931 with @code{__builtin_apply} is stored; operand 1 is a @code{parallel}
6932 expression where each element is a @code{set} expression that indicates
6933 the restoring of a function return value from the result block.
6934
6935 @cindex @code{nop} instruction pattern
6936 @item @samp{nop}
6937 No-op instruction. This instruction pattern name should always be defined
6938 to output a no-op in assembler code. @code{(const_int 0)} will do as an
6939 RTL pattern.
6940
6941 @cindex @code{indirect_jump} instruction pattern
6942 @item @samp{indirect_jump}
6943 An instruction to jump to an address which is operand zero.
6944 This pattern name is mandatory on all machines.
6945
6946 @cindex @code{casesi} instruction pattern
6947 @item @samp{casesi}
6948 Instruction to jump through a dispatch table, including bounds checking.
6949 This instruction takes five operands:
6950
6951 @enumerate
6952 @item
6953 The index to dispatch on, which has mode @code{SImode}.
6954
6955 @item
6956 The lower bound for indices in the table, an integer constant.
6957
6958 @item
6959 The total range of indices in the table---the largest index
6960 minus the smallest one (both inclusive).
6961
6962 @item
6963 A label that precedes the table itself.
6964
6965 @item
6966 A label to jump to if the index has a value outside the bounds.
6967 @end enumerate
6968
6969 The table is an @code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec} inside of a
6970 @code{jump_table_data}. The number of elements in the table is one plus the
6971 difference between the upper bound and the lower bound.
6972
6973 @cindex @code{tablejump} instruction pattern
6974 @item @samp{tablejump}
6975 Instruction to jump to a variable address. This is a low-level
6976 capability which can be used to implement a dispatch table when there
6977 is no @samp{casesi} pattern.
6978
6979 This pattern requires two operands: the address or offset, and a label
6980 which should immediately precede the jump table. If the macro
6981 @code{CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE} evaluates to a nonzero value then the first
6982 operand is an offset which counts from the address of the table; otherwise,
6983 it is an absolute address to jump to. In either case, the first operand has
6984 mode @code{Pmode}.
6985
6986 The @samp{tablejump} insn is always the last insn before the jump
6987 table it uses. Its assembler code normally has no need to use the
6988 second operand, but you should incorporate it in the RTL pattern so
6989 that the jump optimizer will not delete the table as unreachable code.
6990
6991
6992 @cindex @code{doloop_end} instruction pattern
6993 @item @samp{doloop_end}
6994 Conditional branch instruction that decrements a register and
6995 jumps if the register is nonzero. Operand 0 is the register to
6996 decrement and test; operand 1 is the label to jump to if the
6997 register is nonzero.
6998 @xref{Looping Patterns}.
6999
7000 This optional instruction pattern should be defined for machines with
7001 low-overhead looping instructions as the loop optimizer will try to
7002 modify suitable loops to utilize it. The target hook
7003 @code{TARGET_CAN_USE_DOLOOP_P} controls the conditions under which
7004 low-overhead loops can be used.
7005
7006 @cindex @code{doloop_begin} instruction pattern
7007 @item @samp{doloop_begin}
7008 Companion instruction to @code{doloop_end} required for machines that
7009 need to perform some initialization, such as loading a special counter
7010 register. Operand 1 is the associated @code{doloop_end} pattern and
7011 operand 0 is the register that it decrements.
7012
7013 If initialization insns do not always need to be emitted, use a
7014 @code{define_expand} (@pxref{Expander Definitions}) and make it fail.
7015
7016 @cindex @code{canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare} instruction pattern
7017 @item @samp{canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare}
7018 Canonicalize the function pointer in operand 1 and store the result
7019 into operand 0.
7020
7021 Operand 0 is always a @code{reg} and has mode @code{Pmode}; operand 1
7022 may be a @code{reg}, @code{mem}, @code{symbol_ref}, @code{const_int}, etc
7023 and also has mode @code{Pmode}.
7024
7025 Canonicalization of a function pointer usually involves computing
7026 the address of the function which would be called if the function
7027 pointer were used in an indirect call.
7028
7029 Only define this pattern if function pointers on the target machine
7030 can have different values but still call the same function when
7031 used in an indirect call.
7032
7033 @cindex @code{save_stack_block} instruction pattern
7034 @cindex @code{save_stack_function} instruction pattern
7035 @cindex @code{save_stack_nonlocal} instruction pattern
7036 @cindex @code{restore_stack_block} instruction pattern
7037 @cindex @code{restore_stack_function} instruction pattern
7038 @cindex @code{restore_stack_nonlocal} instruction pattern
7039 @item @samp{save_stack_block}
7040 @itemx @samp{save_stack_function}
7041 @itemx @samp{save_stack_nonlocal}
7042 @itemx @samp{restore_stack_block}
7043 @itemx @samp{restore_stack_function}
7044 @itemx @samp{restore_stack_nonlocal}
7045 Most machines save and restore the stack pointer by copying it to or
7046 from an object of mode @code{Pmode}. Do not define these patterns on
7047 such machines.
7048
7049 Some machines require special handling for stack pointer saves and
7050 restores. On those machines, define the patterns corresponding to the
7051 non-standard cases by using a @code{define_expand} (@pxref{Expander
7052 Definitions}) that produces the required insns. The three types of
7053 saves and restores are:
7054
7055 @enumerate
7056 @item
7057 @samp{save_stack_block} saves the stack pointer at the start of a block
7058 that allocates a variable-sized object, and @samp{restore_stack_block}
7059 restores the stack pointer when the block is exited.
7060
7061 @item
7062 @samp{save_stack_function} and @samp{restore_stack_function} do a
7063 similar job for the outermost block of a function and are used when the
7064 function allocates variable-sized objects or calls @code{alloca}. Only
7065 the epilogue uses the restored stack pointer, allowing a simpler save or
7066 restore sequence on some machines.
7067
7068 @item
7069 @samp{save_stack_nonlocal} is used in functions that contain labels
7070 branched to by nested functions. It saves the stack pointer in such a
7071 way that the inner function can use @samp{restore_stack_nonlocal} to
7072 restore the stack pointer. The compiler generates code to restore the
7073 frame and argument pointer registers, but some machines require saving
7074 and restoring additional data such as register window information or
7075 stack backchains. Place insns in these patterns to save and restore any
7076 such required data.
7077 @end enumerate
7078
7079 When saving the stack pointer, operand 0 is the save area and operand 1
7080 is the stack pointer. The mode used to allocate the save area defaults
7081 to @code{Pmode} but you can override that choice by defining the
7082 @code{STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE} macro (@pxref{Storage Layout}). You must
7083 specify an integral mode, or @code{VOIDmode} if no save area is needed
7084 for a particular type of save (either because no save is needed or
7085 because a machine-specific save area can be used). Operand 0 is the
7086 stack pointer and operand 1 is the save area for restore operations. If
7087 @samp{save_stack_block} is defined, operand 0 must not be
7088 @code{VOIDmode} since these saves can be arbitrarily nested.
7089
7090 A save area is a @code{mem} that is at a constant offset from
7091 @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx} when the stack pointer is saved for use by
7092 nonlocal gotos and a @code{reg} in the other two cases.
7093
7094 @cindex @code{allocate_stack} instruction pattern
7095 @item @samp{allocate_stack}
7096 Subtract (or add if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is undefined) operand 1 from
7097 the stack pointer to create space for dynamically allocated data.
7098
7099 Store the resultant pointer to this space into operand 0. If you
7100 are allocating space from the main stack, do this by emitting a
7101 move insn to copy @code{virtual_stack_dynamic_rtx} to operand 0.
7102 If you are allocating the space elsewhere, generate code to copy the
7103 location of the space to operand 0. In the latter case, you must
7104 ensure this space gets freed when the corresponding space on the main
7105 stack is free.
7106
7107 Do not define this pattern if all that must be done is the subtraction.
7108 Some machines require other operations such as stack probes or
7109 maintaining the back chain. Define this pattern to emit those
7110 operations in addition to updating the stack pointer.
7111
7112 @cindex @code{check_stack} instruction pattern
7113 @item @samp{check_stack}
7114 If stack checking (@pxref{Stack Checking}) cannot be done on your system by
7115 probing the stack, define this pattern to perform the needed check and signal
7116 an error if the stack has overflowed. The single operand is the address in
7117 the stack farthest from the current stack pointer that you need to validate.
7118 Normally, on platforms where this pattern is needed, you would obtain the
7119 stack limit from a global or thread-specific variable or register.
7120
7121 @cindex @code{probe_stack_address} instruction pattern
7122 @item @samp{probe_stack_address}
7123 If stack checking (@pxref{Stack Checking}) can be done on your system by
7124 probing the stack but without the need to actually access it, define this
7125 pattern and signal an error if the stack has overflowed. The single operand
7126 is the memory address in the stack that needs to be probed.
7127
7128 @cindex @code{probe_stack} instruction pattern
7129 @item @samp{probe_stack}
7130 If stack checking (@pxref{Stack Checking}) can be done on your system by
7131 probing the stack but doing it with a ``store zero'' instruction is not valid
7132 or optimal, define this pattern to do the probing differently and signal an
7133 error if the stack has overflowed. The single operand is the memory reference
7134 in the stack that needs to be probed.
7135
7136 @cindex @code{nonlocal_goto} instruction pattern
7137 @item @samp{nonlocal_goto}
7138 Emit code to generate a non-local goto, e.g., a jump from one function
7139 to a label in an outer function. This pattern has four arguments,
7140 each representing a value to be used in the jump. The first
7141 argument is to be loaded into the frame pointer, the second is
7142 the address to branch to (code to dispatch to the actual label),
7143 the third is the address of a location where the stack is saved,
7144 and the last is the address of the label, to be placed in the
7145 location for the incoming static chain.
7146
7147 On most machines you need not define this pattern, since GCC will
7148 already generate the correct code, which is to load the frame pointer
7149 and static chain, restore the stack (using the
7150 @samp{restore_stack_nonlocal} pattern, if defined), and jump indirectly
7151 to the dispatcher. You need only define this pattern if this code will
7152 not work on your machine.
7153
7154 @cindex @code{nonlocal_goto_receiver} instruction pattern
7155 @item @samp{nonlocal_goto_receiver}
7156 This pattern, if defined, contains code needed at the target of a
7157 nonlocal goto after the code already generated by GCC@. You will not
7158 normally need to define this pattern. A typical reason why you might
7159 need this pattern is if some value, such as a pointer to a global table,
7160 must be restored when the frame pointer is restored. Note that a nonlocal
7161 goto only occurs within a unit-of-translation, so a global table pointer
7162 that is shared by all functions of a given module need not be restored.
7163 There are no arguments.
7164
7165 @cindex @code{exception_receiver} instruction pattern
7166 @item @samp{exception_receiver}
7167 This pattern, if defined, contains code needed at the site of an
7168 exception handler that isn't needed at the site of a nonlocal goto. You
7169 will not normally need to define this pattern. A typical reason why you
7170 might need this pattern is if some value, such as a pointer to a global
7171 table, must be restored after control flow is branched to the handler of
7172 an exception. There are no arguments.
7173
7174 @cindex @code{builtin_setjmp_setup} instruction pattern
7175 @item @samp{builtin_setjmp_setup}
7176 This pattern, if defined, contains additional code needed to initialize
7177 the @code{jmp_buf}. You will not normally need to define this pattern.
7178 A typical reason why you might need this pattern is if some value, such
7179 as a pointer to a global table, must be restored. Though it is
7180 preferred that the pointer value be recalculated if possible (given the
7181 address of a label for instance). The single argument is a pointer to
7182 the @code{jmp_buf}. Note that the buffer is five words long and that
7183 the first three are normally used by the generic mechanism.
7184
7185 @cindex @code{builtin_setjmp_receiver} instruction pattern
7186 @item @samp{builtin_setjmp_receiver}
7187 This pattern, if defined, contains code needed at the site of a
7188 built-in setjmp that isn't needed at the site of a nonlocal goto. You
7189 will not normally need to define this pattern. A typical reason why you
7190 might need this pattern is if some value, such as a pointer to a global
7191 table, must be restored. It takes one argument, which is the label
7192 to which builtin_longjmp transferred control; this pattern may be emitted
7193 at a small offset from that label.
7194
7195 @cindex @code{builtin_longjmp} instruction pattern
7196 @item @samp{builtin_longjmp}
7197 This pattern, if defined, performs the entire action of the longjmp.
7198 You will not normally need to define this pattern unless you also define
7199 @code{builtin_setjmp_setup}. The single argument is a pointer to the
7200 @code{jmp_buf}.
7201
7202 @cindex @code{eh_return} instruction pattern
7203 @item @samp{eh_return}
7204 This pattern, if defined, affects the way @code{__builtin_eh_return},
7205 and thence the call frame exception handling library routines, are
7206 built. It is intended to handle non-trivial actions needed along
7207 the abnormal return path.
7208
7209 The address of the exception handler to which the function should return
7210 is passed as operand to this pattern. It will normally need to copied by
7211 the pattern to some special register or memory location.
7212 If the pattern needs to determine the location of the target call
7213 frame in order to do so, it may use @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX},
7214 if defined; it will have already been assigned.
7215
7216 If this pattern is not defined, the default action will be to simply
7217 copy the return address to @code{EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX}. Either
7218 that macro or this pattern needs to be defined if call frame exception
7219 handling is to be used.
7220
7221 @cindex @code{prologue} instruction pattern
7222 @anchor{prologue instruction pattern}
7223 @item @samp{prologue}
7224 This pattern, if defined, emits RTL for entry to a function. The function
7225 entry is responsible for setting up the stack frame, initializing the frame
7226 pointer register, saving callee saved registers, etc.
7227
7228 Using a prologue pattern is generally preferred over defining
7229 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} to emit assembly code for the prologue.
7230
7231 The @code{prologue} pattern is particularly useful for targets which perform
7232 instruction scheduling.
7233
7234 @cindex @code{window_save} instruction pattern
7235 @anchor{window_save instruction pattern}
7236 @item @samp{window_save}
7237 This pattern, if defined, emits RTL for a register window save. It should
7238 be defined if the target machine has register windows but the window events
7239 are decoupled from calls to subroutines. The canonical example is the SPARC
7240 architecture.
7241
7242 @cindex @code{epilogue} instruction pattern
7243 @anchor{epilogue instruction pattern}
7244 @item @samp{epilogue}
7245 This pattern emits RTL for exit from a function. The function
7246 exit is responsible for deallocating the stack frame, restoring callee saved
7247 registers and emitting the return instruction.
7248
7249 Using an epilogue pattern is generally preferred over defining
7250 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to emit assembly code for the epilogue.
7251
7252 The @code{epilogue} pattern is particularly useful for targets which perform
7253 instruction scheduling or which have delay slots for their return instruction.
7254
7255 @cindex @code{sibcall_epilogue} instruction pattern
7256 @item @samp{sibcall_epilogue}
7257 This pattern, if defined, emits RTL for exit from a function without the final
7258 branch back to the calling function. This pattern will be emitted before any
7259 sibling call (aka tail call) sites.
7260
7261 The @code{sibcall_epilogue} pattern must not clobber any arguments used for
7262 parameter passing or any stack slots for arguments passed to the current
7263 function.
7264
7265 @cindex @code{trap} instruction pattern
7266 @item @samp{trap}
7267 This pattern, if defined, signals an error, typically by causing some
7268 kind of signal to be raised.
7269
7270 @cindex @code{ctrap@var{MM}4} instruction pattern
7271 @item @samp{ctrap@var{MM}4}
7272 Conditional trap instruction. Operand 0 is a piece of RTL which
7273 performs a comparison, and operands 1 and 2 are the arms of the
7274 comparison. Operand 3 is the trap code, an integer.
7275
7276 A typical @code{ctrap} pattern looks like
7277
7278 @smallexample
7279 (define_insn "ctrapsi4"
7280 [(trap_if (match_operator 0 "trap_operator"
7281 [(match_operand 1 "register_operand")
7282 (match_operand 2 "immediate_operand")])
7283 (match_operand 3 "const_int_operand" "i"))]
7284 ""
7285 "@dots{}")
7286 @end smallexample
7287
7288 @cindex @code{prefetch} instruction pattern
7289 @item @samp{prefetch}
7290 This pattern, if defined, emits code for a non-faulting data prefetch
7291 instruction. Operand 0 is the address of the memory to prefetch. Operand 1
7292 is a constant 1 if the prefetch is preparing for a write to the memory
7293 address, or a constant 0 otherwise. Operand 2 is the expected degree of
7294 temporal locality of the data and is a value between 0 and 3, inclusive; 0
7295 means that the data has no temporal locality, so it need not be left in the
7296 cache after the access; 3 means that the data has a high degree of temporal
7297 locality and should be left in all levels of cache possible; 1 and 2 mean,
7298 respectively, a low or moderate degree of temporal locality.
7299
7300 Targets that do not support write prefetches or locality hints can ignore
7301 the values of operands 1 and 2.
7302
7303 @cindex @code{blockage} instruction pattern
7304 @item @samp{blockage}
7305 This pattern defines a pseudo insn that prevents the instruction
7306 scheduler and other passes from moving instructions and using register
7307 equivalences across the boundary defined by the blockage insn.
7308 This needs to be an UNSPEC_VOLATILE pattern or a volatile ASM.
7309
7310 @cindex @code{memory_blockage} instruction pattern
7311 @item @samp{memory_blockage}
7312 This pattern, if defined, represents a compiler memory barrier, and will be
7313 placed at points across which RTL passes may not propagate memory accesses.
7314 This instruction needs to read and write volatile BLKmode memory. It does
7315 not need to generate any machine instruction. If this pattern is not defined,
7316 the compiler falls back to emitting an instruction corresponding
7317 to @code{asm volatile ("" ::: "memory")}.
7318
7319 @cindex @code{memory_barrier} instruction pattern
7320 @item @samp{memory_barrier}
7321 If the target memory model is not fully synchronous, then this pattern
7322 should be defined to an instruction that orders both loads and stores
7323 before the instruction with respect to loads and stores after the instruction.
7324 This pattern has no operands.
7325
7326 @cindex @code{speculation_barrier} instruction pattern
7327 @item @samp{speculation_barrier}
7328 If the target can support speculative execution, then this pattern should
7329 be defined to an instruction that will block subsequent execution until
7330 any prior speculation conditions has been resolved. The pattern must also
7331 ensure that the compiler cannot move memory operations past the barrier,
7332 so it needs to be an UNSPEC_VOLATILE pattern. The pattern has no
7333 operands.
7334
7335 If this pattern is not defined then the default expansion of
7336 @code{__builtin_speculation_safe_value} will emit a warning. You can
7337 suppress this warning by defining this pattern with a final condition
7338 of @code{0} (zero), which tells the compiler that a speculation
7339 barrier is not needed for this target.
7340
7341 @cindex @code{sync_compare_and_swap@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7342 @item @samp{sync_compare_and_swap@var{mode}}
7343 This pattern, if defined, emits code for an atomic compare-and-swap
7344 operation. Operand 1 is the memory on which the atomic operation is
7345 performed. Operand 2 is the ``old'' value to be compared against the
7346 current contents of the memory location. Operand 3 is the ``new'' value
7347 to store in the memory if the compare succeeds. Operand 0 is the result
7348 of the operation; it should contain the contents of the memory
7349 before the operation. If the compare succeeds, this should obviously be
7350 a copy of operand 2.
7351
7352 This pattern must show that both operand 0 and operand 1 are modified.
7353
7354 This pattern must issue any memory barrier instructions such that all
7355 memory operations before the atomic operation occur before the atomic
7356 operation and all memory operations after the atomic operation occur
7357 after the atomic operation.
7358
7359 For targets where the success or failure of the compare-and-swap
7360 operation is available via the status flags, it is possible to
7361 avoid a separate compare operation and issue the subsequent
7362 branch or store-flag operation immediately after the compare-and-swap.
7363 To this end, GCC will look for a @code{MODE_CC} set in the
7364 output of @code{sync_compare_and_swap@var{mode}}; if the machine
7365 description includes such a set, the target should also define special
7366 @code{cbranchcc4} and/or @code{cstorecc4} instructions. GCC will then
7367 be able to take the destination of the @code{MODE_CC} set and pass it
7368 to the @code{cbranchcc4} or @code{cstorecc4} pattern as the first
7369 operand of the comparison (the second will be @code{(const_int 0)}).
7370
7371 For targets where the operating system may provide support for this
7372 operation via library calls, the @code{sync_compare_and_swap_optab}
7373 may be initialized to a function with the same interface as the
7374 @code{__sync_val_compare_and_swap_@var{n}} built-in. If the entire
7375 set of @var{__sync} builtins are supported via library calls, the
7376 target can initialize all of the optabs at once with
7377 @code{init_sync_libfuncs}.
7378 For the purposes of C++11 @code{std::atomic::is_lock_free}, it is
7379 assumed that these library calls do @emph{not} use any kind of
7380 interruptable locking.
7381
7382 @cindex @code{sync_add@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7383 @cindex @code{sync_sub@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7384 @cindex @code{sync_ior@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7385 @cindex @code{sync_and@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7386 @cindex @code{sync_xor@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7387 @cindex @code{sync_nand@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7388 @item @samp{sync_add@var{mode}}, @samp{sync_sub@var{mode}}
7389 @itemx @samp{sync_ior@var{mode}}, @samp{sync_and@var{mode}}
7390 @itemx @samp{sync_xor@var{mode}}, @samp{sync_nand@var{mode}}
7391 These patterns emit code for an atomic operation on memory.
7392 Operand 0 is the memory on which the atomic operation is performed.
7393 Operand 1 is the second operand to the binary operator.
7394
7395 This pattern must issue any memory barrier instructions such that all
7396 memory operations before the atomic operation occur before the atomic
7397 operation and all memory operations after the atomic operation occur
7398 after the atomic operation.
7399
7400 If these patterns are not defined, the operation will be constructed
7401 from a compare-and-swap operation, if defined.
7402
7403 @cindex @code{sync_old_add@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7404 @cindex @code{sync_old_sub@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7405 @cindex @code{sync_old_ior@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7406 @cindex @code{sync_old_and@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7407 @cindex @code{sync_old_xor@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7408 @cindex @code{sync_old_nand@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7409 @item @samp{sync_old_add@var{mode}}, @samp{sync_old_sub@var{mode}}
7410 @itemx @samp{sync_old_ior@var{mode}}, @samp{sync_old_and@var{mode}}
7411 @itemx @samp{sync_old_xor@var{mode}}, @samp{sync_old_nand@var{mode}}
7412 These patterns emit code for an atomic operation on memory,
7413 and return the value that the memory contained before the operation.
7414 Operand 0 is the result value, operand 1 is the memory on which the
7415 atomic operation is performed, and operand 2 is the second operand
7416 to the binary operator.
7417
7418 This pattern must issue any memory barrier instructions such that all
7419 memory operations before the atomic operation occur before the atomic
7420 operation and all memory operations after the atomic operation occur
7421 after the atomic operation.
7422
7423 If these patterns are not defined, the operation will be constructed
7424 from a compare-and-swap operation, if defined.
7425
7426 @cindex @code{sync_new_add@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7427 @cindex @code{sync_new_sub@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7428 @cindex @code{sync_new_ior@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7429 @cindex @code{sync_new_and@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7430 @cindex @code{sync_new_xor@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7431 @cindex @code{sync_new_nand@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7432 @item @samp{sync_new_add@var{mode}}, @samp{sync_new_sub@var{mode}}
7433 @itemx @samp{sync_new_ior@var{mode}}, @samp{sync_new_and@var{mode}}
7434 @itemx @samp{sync_new_xor@var{mode}}, @samp{sync_new_nand@var{mode}}
7435 These patterns are like their @code{sync_old_@var{op}} counterparts,
7436 except that they return the value that exists in the memory location
7437 after the operation, rather than before the operation.
7438
7439 @cindex @code{sync_lock_test_and_set@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7440 @item @samp{sync_lock_test_and_set@var{mode}}
7441 This pattern takes two forms, based on the capabilities of the target.
7442 In either case, operand 0 is the result of the operand, operand 1 is
7443 the memory on which the atomic operation is performed, and operand 2
7444 is the value to set in the lock.
7445
7446 In the ideal case, this operation is an atomic exchange operation, in
7447 which the previous value in memory operand is copied into the result
7448 operand, and the value operand is stored in the memory operand.
7449
7450 For less capable targets, any value operand that is not the constant 1
7451 should be rejected with @code{FAIL}. In this case the target may use
7452 an atomic test-and-set bit operation. The result operand should contain
7453 1 if the bit was previously set and 0 if the bit was previously clear.
7454 The true contents of the memory operand are implementation defined.
7455
7456 This pattern must issue any memory barrier instructions such that the
7457 pattern as a whole acts as an acquire barrier, that is all memory
7458 operations after the pattern do not occur until the lock is acquired.
7459
7460 If this pattern is not defined, the operation will be constructed from
7461 a compare-and-swap operation, if defined.
7462
7463 @cindex @code{sync_lock_release@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7464 @item @samp{sync_lock_release@var{mode}}
7465 This pattern, if defined, releases a lock set by
7466 @code{sync_lock_test_and_set@var{mode}}. Operand 0 is the memory
7467 that contains the lock; operand 1 is the value to store in the lock.
7468
7469 If the target doesn't implement full semantics for
7470 @code{sync_lock_test_and_set@var{mode}}, any value operand which is not
7471 the constant 0 should be rejected with @code{FAIL}, and the true contents
7472 of the memory operand are implementation defined.
7473
7474 This pattern must issue any memory barrier instructions such that the
7475 pattern as a whole acts as a release barrier, that is the lock is
7476 released only after all previous memory operations have completed.
7477
7478 If this pattern is not defined, then a @code{memory_barrier} pattern
7479 will be emitted, followed by a store of the value to the memory operand.
7480
7481 @cindex @code{atomic_compare_and_swap@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7482 @item @samp{atomic_compare_and_swap@var{mode}}
7483 This pattern, if defined, emits code for an atomic compare-and-swap
7484 operation with memory model semantics. Operand 2 is the memory on which
7485 the atomic operation is performed. Operand 0 is an output operand which
7486 is set to true or false based on whether the operation succeeded. Operand
7487 1 is an output operand which is set to the contents of the memory before
7488 the operation was attempted. Operand 3 is the value that is expected to
7489 be in memory. Operand 4 is the value to put in memory if the expected
7490 value is found there. Operand 5 is set to 1 if this compare and swap is to
7491 be treated as a weak operation. Operand 6 is the memory model to be used
7492 if the operation is a success. Operand 7 is the memory model to be used
7493 if the operation fails.
7494
7495 If memory referred to in operand 2 contains the value in operand 3, then
7496 operand 4 is stored in memory pointed to by operand 2 and fencing based on
7497 the memory model in operand 6 is issued.
7498
7499 If memory referred to in operand 2 does not contain the value in operand 3,
7500 then fencing based on the memory model in operand 7 is issued.
7501
7502 If a target does not support weak compare-and-swap operations, or the port
7503 elects not to implement weak operations, the argument in operand 5 can be
7504 ignored. Note a strong implementation must be provided.
7505
7506 If this pattern is not provided, the @code{__atomic_compare_exchange}
7507 built-in functions will utilize the legacy @code{sync_compare_and_swap}
7508 pattern with an @code{__ATOMIC_SEQ_CST} memory model.
7509
7510 @cindex @code{atomic_load@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7511 @item @samp{atomic_load@var{mode}}
7512 This pattern implements an atomic load operation with memory model
7513 semantics. Operand 1 is the memory address being loaded from. Operand 0
7514 is the result of the load. Operand 2 is the memory model to be used for
7515 the load operation.
7516
7517 If not present, the @code{__atomic_load} built-in function will either
7518 resort to a normal load with memory barriers, or a compare-and-swap
7519 operation if a normal load would not be atomic.
7520
7521 @cindex @code{atomic_store@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7522 @item @samp{atomic_store@var{mode}}
7523 This pattern implements an atomic store operation with memory model
7524 semantics. Operand 0 is the memory address being stored to. Operand 1
7525 is the value to be written. Operand 2 is the memory model to be used for
7526 the operation.
7527
7528 If not present, the @code{__atomic_store} built-in function will attempt to
7529 perform a normal store and surround it with any required memory fences. If
7530 the store would not be atomic, then an @code{__atomic_exchange} is
7531 attempted with the result being ignored.
7532
7533 @cindex @code{atomic_exchange@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7534 @item @samp{atomic_exchange@var{mode}}
7535 This pattern implements an atomic exchange operation with memory model
7536 semantics. Operand 1 is the memory location the operation is performed on.
7537 Operand 0 is an output operand which is set to the original value contained
7538 in the memory pointed to by operand 1. Operand 2 is the value to be
7539 stored. Operand 3 is the memory model to be used.
7540
7541 If this pattern is not present, the built-in function
7542 @code{__atomic_exchange} will attempt to preform the operation with a
7543 compare and swap loop.
7544
7545 @cindex @code{atomic_add@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7546 @cindex @code{atomic_sub@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7547 @cindex @code{atomic_or@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7548 @cindex @code{atomic_and@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7549 @cindex @code{atomic_xor@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7550 @cindex @code{atomic_nand@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7551 @item @samp{atomic_add@var{mode}}, @samp{atomic_sub@var{mode}}
7552 @itemx @samp{atomic_or@var{mode}}, @samp{atomic_and@var{mode}}
7553 @itemx @samp{atomic_xor@var{mode}}, @samp{atomic_nand@var{mode}}
7554 These patterns emit code for an atomic operation on memory with memory
7555 model semantics. Operand 0 is the memory on which the atomic operation is
7556 performed. Operand 1 is the second operand to the binary operator.
7557 Operand 2 is the memory model to be used by the operation.
7558
7559 If these patterns are not defined, attempts will be made to use legacy
7560 @code{sync} patterns, or equivalent patterns which return a result. If
7561 none of these are available a compare-and-swap loop will be used.
7562
7563 @cindex @code{atomic_fetch_add@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7564 @cindex @code{atomic_fetch_sub@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7565 @cindex @code{atomic_fetch_or@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7566 @cindex @code{atomic_fetch_and@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7567 @cindex @code{atomic_fetch_xor@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7568 @cindex @code{atomic_fetch_nand@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7569 @item @samp{atomic_fetch_add@var{mode}}, @samp{atomic_fetch_sub@var{mode}}
7570 @itemx @samp{atomic_fetch_or@var{mode}}, @samp{atomic_fetch_and@var{mode}}
7571 @itemx @samp{atomic_fetch_xor@var{mode}}, @samp{atomic_fetch_nand@var{mode}}
7572 These patterns emit code for an atomic operation on memory with memory
7573 model semantics, and return the original value. Operand 0 is an output
7574 operand which contains the value of the memory location before the
7575 operation was performed. Operand 1 is the memory on which the atomic
7576 operation is performed. Operand 2 is the second operand to the binary
7577 operator. Operand 3 is the memory model to be used by the operation.
7578
7579 If these patterns are not defined, attempts will be made to use legacy
7580 @code{sync} patterns. If none of these are available a compare-and-swap
7581 loop will be used.
7582
7583 @cindex @code{atomic_add_fetch@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7584 @cindex @code{atomic_sub_fetch@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7585 @cindex @code{atomic_or_fetch@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7586 @cindex @code{atomic_and_fetch@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7587 @cindex @code{atomic_xor_fetch@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7588 @cindex @code{atomic_nand_fetch@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7589 @item @samp{atomic_add_fetch@var{mode}}, @samp{atomic_sub_fetch@var{mode}}
7590 @itemx @samp{atomic_or_fetch@var{mode}}, @samp{atomic_and_fetch@var{mode}}
7591 @itemx @samp{atomic_xor_fetch@var{mode}}, @samp{atomic_nand_fetch@var{mode}}
7592 These patterns emit code for an atomic operation on memory with memory
7593 model semantics and return the result after the operation is performed.
7594 Operand 0 is an output operand which contains the value after the
7595 operation. Operand 1 is the memory on which the atomic operation is
7596 performed. Operand 2 is the second operand to the binary operator.
7597 Operand 3 is the memory model to be used by the operation.
7598
7599 If these patterns are not defined, attempts will be made to use legacy
7600 @code{sync} patterns, or equivalent patterns which return the result before
7601 the operation followed by the arithmetic operation required to produce the
7602 result. If none of these are available a compare-and-swap loop will be
7603 used.
7604
7605 @cindex @code{atomic_test_and_set} instruction pattern
7606 @item @samp{atomic_test_and_set}
7607 This pattern emits code for @code{__builtin_atomic_test_and_set}.
7608 Operand 0 is an output operand which is set to true if the previous
7609 previous contents of the byte was "set", and false otherwise. Operand 1
7610 is the @code{QImode} memory to be modified. Operand 2 is the memory
7611 model to be used.
7612
7613 The specific value that defines "set" is implementation defined, and
7614 is normally based on what is performed by the native atomic test and set
7615 instruction.
7616
7617 @cindex @code{atomic_bit_test_and_set@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7618 @cindex @code{atomic_bit_test_and_complement@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7619 @cindex @code{atomic_bit_test_and_reset@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7620 @item @samp{atomic_bit_test_and_set@var{mode}}
7621 @itemx @samp{atomic_bit_test_and_complement@var{mode}}
7622 @itemx @samp{atomic_bit_test_and_reset@var{mode}}
7623 These patterns emit code for an atomic bitwise operation on memory with memory
7624 model semantics, and return the original value of the specified bit.
7625 Operand 0 is an output operand which contains the value of the specified bit
7626 from the memory location before the operation was performed. Operand 1 is the
7627 memory on which the atomic operation is performed. Operand 2 is the bit within
7628 the operand, starting with least significant bit. Operand 3 is the memory model
7629 to be used by the operation. Operand 4 is a flag - it is @code{const1_rtx}
7630 if operand 0 should contain the original value of the specified bit in the
7631 least significant bit of the operand, and @code{const0_rtx} if the bit should
7632 be in its original position in the operand.
7633 @code{atomic_bit_test_and_set@var{mode}} atomically sets the specified bit after
7634 remembering its original value, @code{atomic_bit_test_and_complement@var{mode}}
7635 inverts the specified bit and @code{atomic_bit_test_and_reset@var{mode}} clears
7636 the specified bit.
7637
7638 If these patterns are not defined, attempts will be made to use
7639 @code{atomic_fetch_or@var{mode}}, @code{atomic_fetch_xor@var{mode}} or
7640 @code{atomic_fetch_and@var{mode}} instruction patterns, or their @code{sync}
7641 counterparts. If none of these are available a compare-and-swap
7642 loop will be used.
7643
7644 @cindex @code{mem_thread_fence} instruction pattern
7645 @item @samp{mem_thread_fence}
7646 This pattern emits code required to implement a thread fence with
7647 memory model semantics. Operand 0 is the memory model to be used.
7648
7649 For the @code{__ATOMIC_RELAXED} model no instructions need to be issued
7650 and this expansion is not invoked.
7651
7652 The compiler always emits a compiler memory barrier regardless of what
7653 expanding this pattern produced.
7654
7655 If this pattern is not defined, the compiler falls back to expanding the
7656 @code{memory_barrier} pattern, then to emitting @code{__sync_synchronize}
7657 library call, and finally to just placing a compiler memory barrier.
7658
7659 @cindex @code{get_thread_pointer@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7660 @cindex @code{set_thread_pointer@var{mode}} instruction pattern
7661 @item @samp{get_thread_pointer@var{mode}}
7662 @itemx @samp{set_thread_pointer@var{mode}}
7663 These patterns emit code that reads/sets the TLS thread pointer. Currently,
7664 these are only needed if the target needs to support the
7665 @code{__builtin_thread_pointer} and @code{__builtin_set_thread_pointer}
7666 builtins.
7667
7668 The get/set patterns have a single output/input operand respectively,
7669 with @var{mode} intended to be @code{Pmode}.
7670
7671 @cindex @code{stack_protect_combined_set} instruction pattern
7672 @item @samp{stack_protect_combined_set}
7673 This pattern, if defined, moves a @code{ptr_mode} value from an address
7674 whose declaration RTX is given in operand 1 to the memory in operand 0
7675 without leaving the value in a register afterward. If several
7676 instructions are needed by the target to perform the operation (eg. to
7677 load the address from a GOT entry then load the @code{ptr_mode} value
7678 and finally store it), it is the backend's responsibility to ensure no
7679 intermediate result gets spilled. This is to avoid leaking the value
7680 some place that an attacker might use to rewrite the stack guard slot
7681 after having clobbered it.
7682
7683 If this pattern is not defined, then the address declaration is
7684 expanded first in the standard way and a @code{stack_protect_set}
7685 pattern is then generated to move the value from that address to the
7686 address in operand 0.
7687
7688 @cindex @code{stack_protect_set} instruction pattern
7689 @item @samp{stack_protect_set}
7690 This pattern, if defined, moves a @code{ptr_mode} value from the valid
7691 memory location in operand 1 to the memory in operand 0 without leaving
7692 the value in a register afterward. This is to avoid leaking the value
7693 some place that an attacker might use to rewrite the stack guard slot
7694 after having clobbered it.
7695
7696 Note: on targets where the addressing modes do not allow to load
7697 directly from stack guard address, the address is expanded in a standard
7698 way first which could cause some spills.
7699
7700 If this pattern is not defined, then a plain move pattern is generated.
7701
7702 @cindex @code{stack_protect_combined_test} instruction pattern
7703 @item @samp{stack_protect_combined_test}
7704 This pattern, if defined, compares a @code{ptr_mode} value from an
7705 address whose declaration RTX is given in operand 1 with the memory in
7706 operand 0 without leaving the value in a register afterward and
7707 branches to operand 2 if the values were equal. If several
7708 instructions are needed by the target to perform the operation (eg. to
7709 load the address from a GOT entry then load the @code{ptr_mode} value
7710 and finally store it), it is the backend's responsibility to ensure no
7711 intermediate result gets spilled. This is to avoid leaking the value
7712 some place that an attacker might use to rewrite the stack guard slot
7713 after having clobbered it.
7714
7715 If this pattern is not defined, then the address declaration is
7716 expanded first in the standard way and a @code{stack_protect_test}
7717 pattern is then generated to compare the value from that address to the
7718 value at the memory in operand 0.
7719
7720 @cindex @code{stack_protect_test} instruction pattern
7721 @item @samp{stack_protect_test}
7722 This pattern, if defined, compares a @code{ptr_mode} value from the
7723 valid memory location in operand 1 with the memory in operand 0 without
7724 leaving the value in a register afterward and branches to operand 2 if
7725 the values were equal.
7726
7727 If this pattern is not defined, then a plain compare pattern and
7728 conditional branch pattern is used.
7729
7730 @cindex @code{clear_cache} instruction pattern
7731 @item @samp{clear_cache}
7732 This pattern, if defined, flushes the instruction cache for a region of
7733 memory. The region is bounded to by the Pmode pointers in operand 0
7734 inclusive and operand 1 exclusive.
7735
7736 If this pattern is not defined, a call to the library function
7737 @code{__clear_cache} is used.
7738
7739 @end table
7740
7741 @end ifset
7742 @c Each of the following nodes are wrapped in separate
7743 @c "@ifset INTERNALS" to work around memory limits for the default
7744 @c configuration in older tetex distributions. Known to not work:
7745 @c tetex-1.0.7, known to work: tetex-2.0.2.
7746 @ifset INTERNALS
7747 @node Pattern Ordering
7748 @section When the Order of Patterns Matters
7749 @cindex Pattern Ordering
7750 @cindex Ordering of Patterns
7751
7752 Sometimes an insn can match more than one instruction pattern. Then the
7753 pattern that appears first in the machine description is the one used.
7754 Therefore, more specific patterns (patterns that will match fewer things)
7755 and faster instructions (those that will produce better code when they
7756 do match) should usually go first in the description.
7757
7758 In some cases the effect of ordering the patterns can be used to hide
7759 a pattern when it is not valid. For example, the 68000 has an
7760 instruction for converting a fullword to floating point and another
7761 for converting a byte to floating point. An instruction converting
7762 an integer to floating point could match either one. We put the
7763 pattern to convert the fullword first to make sure that one will
7764 be used rather than the other. (Otherwise a large integer might
7765 be generated as a single-byte immediate quantity, which would not work.)
7766 Instead of using this pattern ordering it would be possible to make the
7767 pattern for convert-a-byte smart enough to deal properly with any
7768 constant value.
7769
7770 @end ifset
7771 @ifset INTERNALS
7772 @node Dependent Patterns
7773 @section Interdependence of Patterns
7774 @cindex Dependent Patterns
7775 @cindex Interdependence of Patterns
7776
7777 In some cases machines support instructions identical except for the
7778 machine mode of one or more operands. For example, there may be
7779 ``sign-extend halfword'' and ``sign-extend byte'' instructions whose
7780 patterns are
7781
7782 @smallexample
7783 (set (match_operand:SI 0 @dots{})
7784 (extend:SI (match_operand:HI 1 @dots{})))
7785
7786 (set (match_operand:SI 0 @dots{})
7787 (extend:SI (match_operand:QI 1 @dots{})))
7788 @end smallexample
7789
7790 @noindent
7791 Constant integers do not specify a machine mode, so an instruction to
7792 extend a constant value could match either pattern. The pattern it
7793 actually will match is the one that appears first in the file. For correct
7794 results, this must be the one for the widest possible mode (@code{HImode},
7795 here). If the pattern matches the @code{QImode} instruction, the results
7796 will be incorrect if the constant value does not actually fit that mode.
7797
7798 Such instructions to extend constants are rarely generated because they are
7799 optimized away, but they do occasionally happen in nonoptimized
7800 compilations.
7801
7802 If a constraint in a pattern allows a constant, the reload pass may
7803 replace a register with a constant permitted by the constraint in some
7804 cases. Similarly for memory references. Because of this substitution,
7805 you should not provide separate patterns for increment and decrement
7806 instructions. Instead, they should be generated from the same pattern
7807 that supports register-register add insns by examining the operands and
7808 generating the appropriate machine instruction.
7809
7810 @end ifset
7811 @ifset INTERNALS
7812 @node Jump Patterns
7813 @section Defining Jump Instruction Patterns
7814 @cindex jump instruction patterns
7815 @cindex defining jump instruction patterns
7816
7817 GCC does not assume anything about how the machine realizes jumps.
7818 The machine description should define a single pattern, usually
7819 a @code{define_expand}, which expands to all the required insns.
7820
7821 Usually, this would be a comparison insn to set the condition code
7822 and a separate branch insn testing the condition code and branching
7823 or not according to its value. For many machines, however,
7824 separating compares and branches is limiting, which is why the
7825 more flexible approach with one @code{define_expand} is used in GCC.
7826 The machine description becomes clearer for architectures that
7827 have compare-and-branch instructions but no condition code. It also
7828 works better when different sets of comparison operators are supported
7829 by different kinds of conditional branches (e.g.@: integer vs.@:
7830 floating-point), or by conditional branches with respect to conditional stores.
7831
7832 Two separate insns are always used if the machine description represents
7833 a condition code register using the legacy RTL expression @code{(cc0)},
7834 and on most machines that use a separate condition code register
7835 (@pxref{Condition Code}). For machines that use @code{(cc0)}, in
7836 fact, the set and use of the condition code must be separate and
7837 adjacent@footnote{@code{note} insns can separate them, though.}, thus
7838 allowing flags in @code{cc_status} to be used (@pxref{Condition Code}) and
7839 so that the comparison and branch insns could be located from each other
7840 by using the functions @code{prev_cc0_setter} and @code{next_cc0_user}.
7841
7842 Even in this case having a single entry point for conditional branches
7843 is advantageous, because it handles equally well the case where a single
7844 comparison instruction records the results of both signed and unsigned
7845 comparison of the given operands (with the branch insns coming in distinct
7846 signed and unsigned flavors) as in the x86 or SPARC, and the case where
7847 there are distinct signed and unsigned compare instructions and only
7848 one set of conditional branch instructions as in the PowerPC.
7849
7850 @end ifset
7851 @ifset INTERNALS
7852 @node Looping Patterns
7853 @section Defining Looping Instruction Patterns
7854 @cindex looping instruction patterns
7855 @cindex defining looping instruction patterns
7856
7857 Some machines have special jump instructions that can be utilized to
7858 make loops more efficient. A common example is the 68000 @samp{dbra}
7859 instruction which performs a decrement of a register and a branch if the
7860 result was greater than zero. Other machines, in particular digital
7861 signal processors (DSPs), have special block repeat instructions to
7862 provide low-overhead loop support. For example, the TI TMS320C3x/C4x
7863 DSPs have a block repeat instruction that loads special registers to
7864 mark the top and end of a loop and to count the number of loop
7865 iterations. This avoids the need for fetching and executing a
7866 @samp{dbra}-like instruction and avoids pipeline stalls associated with
7867 the jump.
7868
7869 GCC has two special named patterns to support low overhead looping.
7870 They are @samp{doloop_begin} and @samp{doloop_end}. These are emitted
7871 by the loop optimizer for certain well-behaved loops with a finite
7872 number of loop iterations using information collected during strength
7873 reduction.
7874
7875 The @samp{doloop_end} pattern describes the actual looping instruction
7876 (or the implicit looping operation) and the @samp{doloop_begin} pattern
7877 is an optional companion pattern that can be used for initialization
7878 needed for some low-overhead looping instructions.
7879
7880 Note that some machines require the actual looping instruction to be
7881 emitted at the top of the loop (e.g., the TMS320C3x/C4x DSPs). Emitting
7882 the true RTL for a looping instruction at the top of the loop can cause
7883 problems with flow analysis. So instead, a dummy @code{doloop} insn is
7884 emitted at the end of the loop. The machine dependent reorg pass checks
7885 for the presence of this @code{doloop} insn and then searches back to
7886 the top of the loop, where it inserts the true looping insn (provided
7887 there are no instructions in the loop which would cause problems). Any
7888 additional labels can be emitted at this point. In addition, if the
7889 desired special iteration counter register was not allocated, this
7890 machine dependent reorg pass could emit a traditional compare and jump
7891 instruction pair.
7892
7893 For the @samp{doloop_end} pattern, the loop optimizer allocates an
7894 additional pseudo register as an iteration counter. This pseudo
7895 register cannot be used within the loop (i.e., general induction
7896 variables cannot be derived from it), however, in many cases the loop
7897 induction variable may become redundant and removed by the flow pass.
7898
7899 The @samp{doloop_end} pattern must have a specific structure to be
7900 handled correctly by GCC. The example below is taken (slightly
7901 simplified) from the PDP-11 target:
7902
7903 @smallexample
7904 @group
7905 (define_expand "doloop_end"
7906 [(parallel [(set (pc)
7907 (if_then_else
7908 (ne (match_operand:HI 0 "nonimmediate_operand" "+r,!m")
7909 (const_int 1))
7910 (label_ref (match_operand 1 "" ""))
7911 (pc)))
7912 (set (match_dup 0)
7913 (plus:HI (match_dup 0)
7914 (const_int -1)))])]
7915 ""
7916 "@{
7917 if (GET_MODE (operands[0]) != HImode)
7918 FAIL;
7919 @}")
7920
7921 (define_insn "doloop_end_insn"
7922 [(set (pc)
7923 (if_then_else
7924 (ne (match_operand:HI 0 "nonimmediate_operand" "+r,!m")
7925 (const_int 1))
7926 (label_ref (match_operand 1 "" ""))
7927 (pc)))
7928 (set (match_dup 0)
7929 (plus:HI (match_dup 0)
7930 (const_int -1)))]
7931 ""
7932
7933 @{
7934 if (which_alternative == 0)
7935 return "sob %0,%l1";
7936
7937 /* emulate sob */
7938 output_asm_insn ("dec %0", operands);
7939 return "bne %l1";
7940 @})
7941 @end group
7942 @end smallexample
7943
7944 The first part of the pattern describes the branch condition. GCC
7945 supports three cases for the way the target machine handles the loop
7946 counter:
7947 @itemize @bullet
7948 @item Loop terminates when the loop register decrements to zero. This
7949 is represented by a @code{ne} comparison of the register (its old value)
7950 with constant 1 (as in the example above).
7951 @item Loop terminates when the loop register decrements to @minus{}1.
7952 This is represented by a @code{ne} comparison of the register with
7953 constant zero.
7954 @item Loop terminates when the loop register decrements to a negative
7955 value. This is represented by a @code{ge} comparison of the register
7956 with constant zero. For this case, GCC will attach a @code{REG_NONNEG}
7957 note to the @code{doloop_end} insn if it can determine that the register
7958 will be non-negative.
7959 @end itemize
7960
7961 Since the @code{doloop_end} insn is a jump insn that also has an output,
7962 the reload pass does not handle the output operand. Therefore, the
7963 constraint must allow for that operand to be in memory rather than a
7964 register. In the example shown above, that is handled (in the
7965 @code{doloop_end_insn} pattern) by using a loop instruction sequence
7966 that can handle memory operands when the memory alternative appears.
7967
7968 GCC does not check the mode of the loop register operand when generating
7969 the @code{doloop_end} pattern. If the pattern is only valid for some
7970 modes but not others, the pattern should be a @code{define_expand}
7971 pattern that checks the operand mode in the preparation code, and issues
7972 @code{FAIL} if an unsupported mode is found. The example above does
7973 this, since the machine instruction to be used only exists for
7974 @code{HImode}.
7975
7976 If the @code{doloop_end} pattern is a @code{define_expand}, there must
7977 also be a @code{define_insn} or @code{define_insn_and_split} matching
7978 the generated pattern. Otherwise, the compiler will fail during loop
7979 optimization.
7980
7981 @end ifset
7982 @ifset INTERNALS
7983 @node Insn Canonicalizations
7984 @section Canonicalization of Instructions
7985 @cindex canonicalization of instructions
7986 @cindex insn canonicalization
7987
7988 There are often cases where multiple RTL expressions could represent an
7989 operation performed by a single machine instruction. This situation is
7990 most commonly encountered with logical, branch, and multiply-accumulate
7991 instructions. In such cases, the compiler attempts to convert these
7992 multiple RTL expressions into a single canonical form to reduce the
7993 number of insn patterns required.
7994
7995 In addition to algebraic simplifications, following canonicalizations
7996 are performed:
7997
7998 @itemize @bullet
7999 @item
8000 For commutative and comparison operators, a constant is always made the
8001 second operand. If a machine only supports a constant as the second
8002 operand, only patterns that match a constant in the second operand need
8003 be supplied.
8004
8005 @item
8006 For associative operators, a sequence of operators will always chain
8007 to the left; for instance, only the left operand of an integer @code{plus}
8008 can itself be a @code{plus}. @code{and}, @code{ior}, @code{xor},
8009 @code{plus}, @code{mult}, @code{smin}, @code{smax}, @code{umin}, and
8010 @code{umax} are associative when applied to integers, and sometimes to
8011 floating-point.
8012
8013 @item
8014 @cindex @code{neg}, canonicalization of
8015 @cindex @code{not}, canonicalization of
8016 @cindex @code{mult}, canonicalization of
8017 @cindex @code{plus}, canonicalization of
8018 @cindex @code{minus}, canonicalization of
8019 For these operators, if only one operand is a @code{neg}, @code{not},
8020 @code{mult}, @code{plus}, or @code{minus} expression, it will be the
8021 first operand.
8022
8023 @item
8024 In combinations of @code{neg}, @code{mult}, @code{plus}, and
8025 @code{minus}, the @code{neg} operations (if any) will be moved inside
8026 the operations as far as possible. For instance,
8027 @code{(neg (mult A B))} is canonicalized as @code{(mult (neg A) B)}, but
8028 @code{(plus (mult (neg B) C) A)} is canonicalized as
8029 @code{(minus A (mult B C))}.
8030
8031 @cindex @code{compare}, canonicalization of
8032 @item
8033 For the @code{compare} operator, a constant is always the second operand
8034 if the first argument is a condition code register or @code{(cc0)}.
8035
8036 @item
8037 For instructions that inherently set a condition code register, the
8038 @code{compare} operator is always written as the first RTL expression of
8039 the @code{parallel} instruction pattern. For example,
8040
8041 @smallexample
8042 (define_insn ""
8043 [(set (reg:CCZ FLAGS_REG)
8044 (compare:CCZ
8045 (plus:SI
8046 (match_operand:SI 1 "register_operand" "%r")
8047 (match_operand:SI 2 "register_operand" "r"))
8048 (const_int 0)))
8049 (set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "=r")
8050 (plus:SI (match_dup 1) (match_dup 2)))]
8051 ""
8052 "addl %0, %1, %2")
8053 @end smallexample
8054
8055 @item
8056 An operand of @code{neg}, @code{not}, @code{mult}, @code{plus}, or
8057 @code{minus} is made the first operand under the same conditions as
8058 above.
8059
8060 @item
8061 @code{(ltu (plus @var{a} @var{b}) @var{b})} is converted to
8062 @code{(ltu (plus @var{a} @var{b}) @var{a})}. Likewise with @code{geu} instead
8063 of @code{ltu}.
8064
8065 @item
8066 @code{(minus @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))} is converted to
8067 @code{(plus @var{x} (const_int @var{-n}))}.
8068
8069 @item
8070 Within address computations (i.e., inside @code{mem}), a left shift is
8071 converted into the appropriate multiplication by a power of two.
8072
8073 @cindex @code{ior}, canonicalization of
8074 @cindex @code{and}, canonicalization of
8075 @cindex De Morgan's law
8076 @item
8077 De Morgan's Law is used to move bitwise negation inside a bitwise
8078 logical-and or logical-or operation. If this results in only one
8079 operand being a @code{not} expression, it will be the first one.
8080
8081 A machine that has an instruction that performs a bitwise logical-and of one
8082 operand with the bitwise negation of the other should specify the pattern
8083 for that instruction as
8084
8085 @smallexample
8086 (define_insn ""
8087 [(set (match_operand:@var{m} 0 @dots{})
8088 (and:@var{m} (not:@var{m} (match_operand:@var{m} 1 @dots{}))
8089 (match_operand:@var{m} 2 @dots{})))]
8090 "@dots{}"
8091 "@dots{}")
8092 @end smallexample
8093
8094 @noindent
8095 Similarly, a pattern for a ``NAND'' instruction should be written
8096
8097 @smallexample
8098 (define_insn ""
8099 [(set (match_operand:@var{m} 0 @dots{})
8100 (ior:@var{m} (not:@var{m} (match_operand:@var{m} 1 @dots{}))
8101 (not:@var{m} (match_operand:@var{m} 2 @dots{}))))]
8102 "@dots{}"
8103 "@dots{}")
8104 @end smallexample
8105
8106 In both cases, it is not necessary to include patterns for the many
8107 logically equivalent RTL expressions.
8108
8109 @cindex @code{xor}, canonicalization of
8110 @item
8111 The only possible RTL expressions involving both bitwise exclusive-or
8112 and bitwise negation are @code{(xor:@var{m} @var{x} @var{y})}
8113 and @code{(not:@var{m} (xor:@var{m} @var{x} @var{y}))}.
8114
8115 @item
8116 The sum of three items, one of which is a constant, will only appear in
8117 the form
8118
8119 @smallexample
8120 (plus:@var{m} (plus:@var{m} @var{x} @var{y}) @var{constant})
8121 @end smallexample
8122
8123 @cindex @code{zero_extract}, canonicalization of
8124 @cindex @code{sign_extract}, canonicalization of
8125 @item
8126 Equality comparisons of a group of bits (usually a single bit) with zero
8127 will be written using @code{zero_extract} rather than the equivalent
8128 @code{and} or @code{sign_extract} operations.
8129
8130 @cindex @code{mult}, canonicalization of
8131 @item
8132 @code{(sign_extend:@var{m1} (mult:@var{m2} (sign_extend:@var{m2} @var{x})
8133 (sign_extend:@var{m2} @var{y})))} is converted to @code{(mult:@var{m1}
8134 (sign_extend:@var{m1} @var{x}) (sign_extend:@var{m1} @var{y}))}, and likewise
8135 for @code{zero_extend}.
8136
8137 @item
8138 @code{(sign_extend:@var{m1} (mult:@var{m2} (ashiftrt:@var{m2}
8139 @var{x} @var{s}) (sign_extend:@var{m2} @var{y})))} is converted
8140 to @code{(mult:@var{m1} (sign_extend:@var{m1} (ashiftrt:@var{m2}
8141 @var{x} @var{s})) (sign_extend:@var{m1} @var{y}))}, and likewise for
8142 patterns using @code{zero_extend} and @code{lshiftrt}. If the second
8143 operand of @code{mult} is also a shift, then that is extended also.
8144 This transformation is only applied when it can be proven that the
8145 original operation had sufficient precision to prevent overflow.
8146
8147 @end itemize
8148
8149 Further canonicalization rules are defined in the function
8150 @code{commutative_operand_precedence} in @file{gcc/rtlanal.c}.
8151
8152 @end ifset
8153 @ifset INTERNALS
8154 @node Expander Definitions
8155 @section Defining RTL Sequences for Code Generation
8156 @cindex expander definitions
8157 @cindex code generation RTL sequences
8158 @cindex defining RTL sequences for code generation
8159
8160 On some target machines, some standard pattern names for RTL generation
8161 cannot be handled with single insn, but a sequence of RTL insns can
8162 represent them. For these target machines, you can write a
8163 @code{define_expand} to specify how to generate the sequence of RTL@.
8164
8165 @findex define_expand
8166 A @code{define_expand} is an RTL expression that looks almost like a
8167 @code{define_insn}; but, unlike the latter, a @code{define_expand} is used
8168 only for RTL generation and it can produce more than one RTL insn.
8169
8170 A @code{define_expand} RTX has four operands:
8171
8172 @itemize @bullet
8173 @item
8174 The name. Each @code{define_expand} must have a name, since the only
8175 use for it is to refer to it by name.
8176
8177 @item
8178 The RTL template. This is a vector of RTL expressions representing
8179 a sequence of separate instructions. Unlike @code{define_insn}, there
8180 is no implicit surrounding @code{PARALLEL}.
8181
8182 @item
8183 The condition, a string containing a C expression. This expression is
8184 used to express how the availability of this pattern depends on
8185 subclasses of target machine, selected by command-line options when GCC
8186 is run. This is just like the condition of a @code{define_insn} that
8187 has a standard name. Therefore, the condition (if present) may not
8188 depend on the data in the insn being matched, but only the
8189 target-machine-type flags. The compiler needs to test these conditions
8190 during initialization in order to learn exactly which named instructions
8191 are available in a particular run.
8192
8193 @item
8194 The preparation statements, a string containing zero or more C
8195 statements which are to be executed before RTL code is generated from
8196 the RTL template.
8197
8198 Usually these statements prepare temporary registers for use as
8199 internal operands in the RTL template, but they can also generate RTL
8200 insns directly by calling routines such as @code{emit_insn}, etc.
8201 Any such insns precede the ones that come from the RTL template.
8202
8203 @item
8204 Optionally, a vector containing the values of attributes. @xref{Insn
8205 Attributes}.
8206 @end itemize
8207
8208 Every RTL insn emitted by a @code{define_expand} must match some
8209 @code{define_insn} in the machine description. Otherwise, the compiler
8210 will crash when trying to generate code for the insn or trying to optimize
8211 it.
8212
8213 The RTL template, in addition to controlling generation of RTL insns,
8214 also describes the operands that need to be specified when this pattern
8215 is used. In particular, it gives a predicate for each operand.
8216
8217 A true operand, which needs to be specified in order to generate RTL from
8218 the pattern, should be described with a @code{match_operand} in its first
8219 occurrence in the RTL template. This enters information on the operand's
8220 predicate into the tables that record such things. GCC uses the
8221 information to preload the operand into a register if that is required for
8222 valid RTL code. If the operand is referred to more than once, subsequent
8223 references should use @code{match_dup}.
8224
8225 The RTL template may also refer to internal ``operands'' which are
8226 temporary registers or labels used only within the sequence made by the
8227 @code{define_expand}. Internal operands are substituted into the RTL
8228 template with @code{match_dup}, never with @code{match_operand}. The
8229 values of the internal operands are not passed in as arguments by the
8230 compiler when it requests use of this pattern. Instead, they are computed
8231 within the pattern, in the preparation statements. These statements
8232 compute the values and store them into the appropriate elements of
8233 @code{operands} so that @code{match_dup} can find them.
8234
8235 There are two special macros defined for use in the preparation statements:
8236 @code{DONE} and @code{FAIL}. Use them with a following semicolon,
8237 as a statement.
8238
8239 @table @code
8240
8241 @findex DONE
8242 @item DONE
8243 Use the @code{DONE} macro to end RTL generation for the pattern. The
8244 only RTL insns resulting from the pattern on this occasion will be
8245 those already emitted by explicit calls to @code{emit_insn} within the
8246 preparation statements; the RTL template will not be generated.
8247
8248 @findex FAIL
8249 @item FAIL
8250 Make the pattern fail on this occasion. When a pattern fails, it means
8251 that the pattern was not truly available. The calling routines in the
8252 compiler will try other strategies for code generation using other patterns.
8253
8254 Failure is currently supported only for binary (addition, multiplication,
8255 shifting, etc.) and bit-field (@code{extv}, @code{extzv}, and @code{insv})
8256 operations.
8257 @end table
8258
8259 If the preparation falls through (invokes neither @code{DONE} nor
8260 @code{FAIL}), then the @code{define_expand} acts like a
8261 @code{define_insn} in that the RTL template is used to generate the
8262 insn.
8263
8264 The RTL template is not used for matching, only for generating the
8265 initial insn list. If the preparation statement always invokes
8266 @code{DONE} or @code{FAIL}, the RTL template may be reduced to a simple
8267 list of operands, such as this example:
8268
8269 @smallexample
8270 @group
8271 (define_expand "addsi3"
8272 [(match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "")
8273 (match_operand:SI 1 "register_operand" "")
8274 (match_operand:SI 2 "register_operand" "")]
8275 @end group
8276 @group
8277 ""
8278 "
8279 @{
8280 handle_add (operands[0], operands[1], operands[2]);
8281 DONE;
8282 @}")
8283 @end group
8284 @end smallexample
8285
8286 Here is an example, the definition of left-shift for the SPUR chip:
8287
8288 @smallexample
8289 @group
8290 (define_expand "ashlsi3"
8291 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "")
8292 (ashift:SI
8293 @end group
8294 @group
8295 (match_operand:SI 1 "register_operand" "")
8296 (match_operand:SI 2 "nonmemory_operand" "")))]
8297 ""
8298 "
8299 @end group
8300 @end smallexample
8301
8302 @smallexample
8303 @group
8304 @{
8305 if (GET_CODE (operands[2]) != CONST_INT
8306 || (unsigned) INTVAL (operands[2]) > 3)
8307 FAIL;
8308 @}")
8309 @end group
8310 @end smallexample
8311
8312 @noindent
8313 This example uses @code{define_expand} so that it can generate an RTL insn
8314 for shifting when the shift-count is in the supported range of 0 to 3 but
8315 fail in other cases where machine insns aren't available. When it fails,
8316 the compiler tries another strategy using different patterns (such as, a
8317 library call).
8318
8319 If the compiler were able to handle nontrivial condition-strings in
8320 patterns with names, then it would be possible to use a
8321 @code{define_insn} in that case. Here is another case (zero-extension
8322 on the 68000) which makes more use of the power of @code{define_expand}:
8323
8324 @smallexample
8325 (define_expand "zero_extendhisi2"
8326 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "")
8327 (const_int 0))
8328 (set (strict_low_part
8329 (subreg:HI
8330 (match_dup 0)
8331 0))
8332 (match_operand:HI 1 "general_operand" ""))]
8333 ""
8334 "operands[1] = make_safe_from (operands[1], operands[0]);")
8335 @end smallexample
8336
8337 @noindent
8338 @findex make_safe_from
8339 Here two RTL insns are generated, one to clear the entire output operand
8340 and the other to copy the input operand into its low half. This sequence
8341 is incorrect if the input operand refers to [the old value of] the output
8342 operand, so the preparation statement makes sure this isn't so. The
8343 function @code{make_safe_from} copies the @code{operands[1]} into a
8344 temporary register if it refers to @code{operands[0]}. It does this
8345 by emitting another RTL insn.
8346
8347 Finally, a third example shows the use of an internal operand.
8348 Zero-extension on the SPUR chip is done by @code{and}-ing the result
8349 against a halfword mask. But this mask cannot be represented by a
8350 @code{const_int} because the constant value is too large to be legitimate
8351 on this machine. So it must be copied into a register with
8352 @code{force_reg} and then the register used in the @code{and}.
8353
8354 @smallexample
8355 (define_expand "zero_extendhisi2"
8356 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "")
8357 (and:SI (subreg:SI
8358 (match_operand:HI 1 "register_operand" "")
8359 0)
8360 (match_dup 2)))]
8361 ""
8362 "operands[2]
8363 = force_reg (SImode, GEN_INT (65535)); ")
8364 @end smallexample
8365
8366 @emph{Note:} If the @code{define_expand} is used to serve a
8367 standard binary or unary arithmetic operation or a bit-field operation,
8368 then the last insn it generates must not be a @code{code_label},
8369 @code{barrier} or @code{note}. It must be an @code{insn},
8370 @code{jump_insn} or @code{call_insn}. If you don't need a real insn
8371 at the end, emit an insn to copy the result of the operation into
8372 itself. Such an insn will generate no code, but it can avoid problems
8373 in the compiler.
8374
8375 @end ifset
8376 @ifset INTERNALS
8377 @node Insn Splitting
8378 @section Defining How to Split Instructions
8379 @cindex insn splitting
8380 @cindex instruction splitting
8381 @cindex splitting instructions
8382
8383 There are two cases where you should specify how to split a pattern
8384 into multiple insns. On machines that have instructions requiring
8385 delay slots (@pxref{Delay Slots}) or that have instructions whose
8386 output is not available for multiple cycles (@pxref{Processor pipeline
8387 description}), the compiler phases that optimize these cases need to
8388 be able to move insns into one-instruction delay slots. However, some
8389 insns may generate more than one machine instruction. These insns
8390 cannot be placed into a delay slot.
8391
8392 Often you can rewrite the single insn as a list of individual insns,
8393 each corresponding to one machine instruction. The disadvantage of
8394 doing so is that it will cause the compilation to be slower and require
8395 more space. If the resulting insns are too complex, it may also
8396 suppress some optimizations. The compiler splits the insn if there is a
8397 reason to believe that it might improve instruction or delay slot
8398 scheduling.
8399
8400 The insn combiner phase also splits putative insns. If three insns are
8401 merged into one insn with a complex expression that cannot be matched by
8402 some @code{define_insn} pattern, the combiner phase attempts to split
8403 the complex pattern into two insns that are recognized. Usually it can
8404 break the complex pattern into two patterns by splitting out some
8405 subexpression. However, in some other cases, such as performing an
8406 addition of a large constant in two insns on a RISC machine, the way to
8407 split the addition into two insns is machine-dependent.
8408
8409 @findex define_split
8410 The @code{define_split} definition tells the compiler how to split a
8411 complex insn into several simpler insns. It looks like this:
8412
8413 @smallexample
8414 (define_split
8415 [@var{insn-pattern}]
8416 "@var{condition}"
8417 [@var{new-insn-pattern-1}
8418 @var{new-insn-pattern-2}
8419 @dots{}]
8420 "@var{preparation-statements}")
8421 @end smallexample
8422
8423 @var{insn-pattern} is a pattern that needs to be split and
8424 @var{condition} is the final condition to be tested, as in a
8425 @code{define_insn}. When an insn matching @var{insn-pattern} and
8426 satisfying @var{condition} is found, it is replaced in the insn list
8427 with the insns given by @var{new-insn-pattern-1},
8428 @var{new-insn-pattern-2}, etc.
8429
8430 The @var{preparation-statements} are similar to those statements that
8431 are specified for @code{define_expand} (@pxref{Expander Definitions})
8432 and are executed before the new RTL is generated to prepare for the
8433 generated code or emit some insns whose pattern is not fixed. Unlike
8434 those in @code{define_expand}, however, these statements must not
8435 generate any new pseudo-registers. Once reload has completed, they also
8436 must not allocate any space in the stack frame.
8437
8438 There are two special macros defined for use in the preparation statements:
8439 @code{DONE} and @code{FAIL}. Use them with a following semicolon,
8440 as a statement.
8441
8442 @table @code
8443
8444 @findex DONE
8445 @item DONE
8446 Use the @code{DONE} macro to end RTL generation for the splitter. The
8447 only RTL insns generated as replacement for the matched input insn will
8448 be those already emitted by explicit calls to @code{emit_insn} within
8449 the preparation statements; the replacement pattern is not used.
8450
8451 @findex FAIL
8452 @item FAIL
8453 Make the @code{define_split} fail on this occasion. When a @code{define_split}
8454 fails, it means that the splitter was not truly available for the inputs
8455 it was given, and the input insn will not be split.
8456 @end table
8457
8458 If the preparation falls through (invokes neither @code{DONE} nor
8459 @code{FAIL}), then the @code{define_split} uses the replacement
8460 template.
8461
8462 Patterns are matched against @var{insn-pattern} in two different
8463 circumstances. If an insn needs to be split for delay slot scheduling
8464 or insn scheduling, the insn is already known to be valid, which means
8465 that it must have been matched by some @code{define_insn} and, if
8466 @code{reload_completed} is nonzero, is known to satisfy the constraints
8467 of that @code{define_insn}. In that case, the new insn patterns must
8468 also be insns that are matched by some @code{define_insn} and, if
8469 @code{reload_completed} is nonzero, must also satisfy the constraints
8470 of those definitions.
8471
8472 As an example of this usage of @code{define_split}, consider the following
8473 example from @file{a29k.md}, which splits a @code{sign_extend} from
8474 @code{HImode} to @code{SImode} into a pair of shift insns:
8475
8476 @smallexample
8477 (define_split
8478 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "gen_reg_operand" "")
8479 (sign_extend:SI (match_operand:HI 1 "gen_reg_operand" "")))]
8480 ""
8481 [(set (match_dup 0)
8482 (ashift:SI (match_dup 1)
8483 (const_int 16)))
8484 (set (match_dup 0)
8485 (ashiftrt:SI (match_dup 0)
8486 (const_int 16)))]
8487 "
8488 @{ operands[1] = gen_lowpart (SImode, operands[1]); @}")
8489 @end smallexample
8490
8491 When the combiner phase tries to split an insn pattern, it is always the
8492 case that the pattern is @emph{not} matched by any @code{define_insn}.
8493 The combiner pass first tries to split a single @code{set} expression
8494 and then the same @code{set} expression inside a @code{parallel}, but
8495 followed by a @code{clobber} of a pseudo-reg to use as a scratch
8496 register. In these cases, the combiner expects exactly one or two new insn
8497 patterns to be generated. It will verify that these patterns match some
8498 @code{define_insn} definitions, so you need not do this test in the
8499 @code{define_split} (of course, there is no point in writing a
8500 @code{define_split} that will never produce insns that match).
8501
8502 Here is an example of this use of @code{define_split}, taken from
8503 @file{rs6000.md}:
8504
8505 @smallexample
8506 (define_split
8507 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "gen_reg_operand" "")
8508 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "gen_reg_operand" "")
8509 (match_operand:SI 2 "non_add_cint_operand" "")))]
8510 ""
8511 [(set (match_dup 0) (plus:SI (match_dup 1) (match_dup 3)))
8512 (set (match_dup 0) (plus:SI (match_dup 0) (match_dup 4)))]
8513 "
8514 @{
8515 int low = INTVAL (operands[2]) & 0xffff;
8516 int high = (unsigned) INTVAL (operands[2]) >> 16;
8517
8518 if (low & 0x8000)
8519 high++, low |= 0xffff0000;
8520
8521 operands[3] = GEN_INT (high << 16);
8522 operands[4] = GEN_INT (low);
8523 @}")
8524 @end smallexample
8525
8526 Here the predicate @code{non_add_cint_operand} matches any
8527 @code{const_int} that is @emph{not} a valid operand of a single add
8528 insn. The add with the smaller displacement is written so that it
8529 can be substituted into the address of a subsequent operation.
8530
8531 An example that uses a scratch register, from the same file, generates
8532 an equality comparison of a register and a large constant:
8533
8534 @smallexample
8535 (define_split
8536 [(set (match_operand:CC 0 "cc_reg_operand" "")
8537 (compare:CC (match_operand:SI 1 "gen_reg_operand" "")
8538 (match_operand:SI 2 "non_short_cint_operand" "")))
8539 (clobber (match_operand:SI 3 "gen_reg_operand" ""))]
8540 "find_single_use (operands[0], insn, 0)
8541 && (GET_CODE (*find_single_use (operands[0], insn, 0)) == EQ
8542 || GET_CODE (*find_single_use (operands[0], insn, 0)) == NE)"
8543 [(set (match_dup 3) (xor:SI (match_dup 1) (match_dup 4)))
8544 (set (match_dup 0) (compare:CC (match_dup 3) (match_dup 5)))]
8545 "
8546 @{
8547 /* @r{Get the constant we are comparing against, C, and see what it
8548 looks like sign-extended to 16 bits. Then see what constant
8549 could be XOR'ed with C to get the sign-extended value.} */
8550
8551 int c = INTVAL (operands[2]);
8552 int sextc = (c << 16) >> 16;
8553 int xorv = c ^ sextc;
8554
8555 operands[4] = GEN_INT (xorv);
8556 operands[5] = GEN_INT (sextc);
8557 @}")
8558 @end smallexample
8559
8560 To avoid confusion, don't write a single @code{define_split} that
8561 accepts some insns that match some @code{define_insn} as well as some
8562 insns that don't. Instead, write two separate @code{define_split}
8563 definitions, one for the insns that are valid and one for the insns that
8564 are not valid.
8565
8566 The splitter is allowed to split jump instructions into sequence of
8567 jumps or create new jumps in while splitting non-jump instructions. As
8568 the control flow graph and branch prediction information needs to be updated,
8569 several restriction apply.
8570
8571 Splitting of jump instruction into sequence that over by another jump
8572 instruction is always valid, as compiler expect identical behavior of new
8573 jump. When new sequence contains multiple jump instructions or new labels,
8574 more assistance is needed. Splitter is required to create only unconditional
8575 jumps, or simple conditional jump instructions. Additionally it must attach a
8576 @code{REG_BR_PROB} note to each conditional jump. A global variable
8577 @code{split_branch_probability} holds the probability of the original branch in case
8578 it was a simple conditional jump, @minus{}1 otherwise. To simplify
8579 recomputing of edge frequencies, the new sequence is required to have only
8580 forward jumps to the newly created labels.
8581
8582 @findex define_insn_and_split
8583 For the common case where the pattern of a define_split exactly matches the
8584 pattern of a define_insn, use @code{define_insn_and_split}. It looks like
8585 this:
8586
8587 @smallexample
8588 (define_insn_and_split
8589 [@var{insn-pattern}]
8590 "@var{condition}"
8591 "@var{output-template}"
8592 "@var{split-condition}"
8593 [@var{new-insn-pattern-1}
8594 @var{new-insn-pattern-2}
8595 @dots{}]
8596 "@var{preparation-statements}"
8597 [@var{insn-attributes}])
8598
8599 @end smallexample
8600
8601 @var{insn-pattern}, @var{condition}, @var{output-template}, and
8602 @var{insn-attributes} are used as in @code{define_insn}. The
8603 @var{new-insn-pattern} vector and the @var{preparation-statements} are used as
8604 in a @code{define_split}. The @var{split-condition} is also used as in
8605 @code{define_split}, with the additional behavior that if the condition starts
8606 with @samp{&&}, the condition used for the split will be the constructed as a
8607 logical ``and'' of the split condition with the insn condition. For example,
8608 from i386.md:
8609
8610 @smallexample
8611 (define_insn_and_split "zero_extendhisi2_and"
8612 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "=r")
8613 (zero_extend:SI (match_operand:HI 1 "register_operand" "0")))
8614 (clobber (reg:CC 17))]
8615 "TARGET_ZERO_EXTEND_WITH_AND && !optimize_size"
8616 "#"
8617 "&& reload_completed"
8618 [(parallel [(set (match_dup 0)
8619 (and:SI (match_dup 0) (const_int 65535)))
8620 (clobber (reg:CC 17))])]
8621 ""
8622 [(set_attr "type" "alu1")])
8623
8624 @end smallexample
8625
8626 In this case, the actual split condition will be
8627 @samp{TARGET_ZERO_EXTEND_WITH_AND && !optimize_size && reload_completed}.
8628
8629 The @code{define_insn_and_split} construction provides exactly the same
8630 functionality as two separate @code{define_insn} and @code{define_split}
8631 patterns. It exists for compactness, and as a maintenance tool to prevent
8632 having to ensure the two patterns' templates match.
8633
8634 @findex define_insn_and_rewrite
8635 It is sometimes useful to have a @code{define_insn_and_split}
8636 that replaces specific operands of an instruction but leaves the
8637 rest of the instruction pattern unchanged. You can do this directly
8638 with a @code{define_insn_and_split}, but it requires a
8639 @var{new-insn-pattern-1} that repeats most of the original @var{insn-pattern}.
8640 There is also the complication that an implicit @code{parallel} in
8641 @var{insn-pattern} must become an explicit @code{parallel} in
8642 @var{new-insn-pattern-1}, which is easy to overlook.
8643 A simpler alternative is to use @code{define_insn_and_rewrite}, which
8644 is a form of @code{define_insn_and_split} that automatically generates
8645 @var{new-insn-pattern-1} by replacing each @code{match_operand}
8646 in @var{insn-pattern} with a corresponding @code{match_dup}, and each
8647 @code{match_operator} in the pattern with a corresponding @code{match_op_dup}.
8648 The arguments are otherwise identical to @code{define_insn_and_split}:
8649
8650 @smallexample
8651 (define_insn_and_rewrite
8652 [@var{insn-pattern}]
8653 "@var{condition}"
8654 "@var{output-template}"
8655 "@var{split-condition}"
8656 "@var{preparation-statements}"
8657 [@var{insn-attributes}])
8658 @end smallexample
8659
8660 The @code{match_dup}s and @code{match_op_dup}s in the new
8661 instruction pattern use any new operand values that the
8662 @var{preparation-statements} store in the @code{operands} array,
8663 as for a normal @code{define_insn_and_split}. @var{preparation-statements}
8664 can also emit additional instructions before the new instruction.
8665 They can even emit an entirely different sequence of instructions and
8666 use @code{DONE} to avoid emitting a new form of the original
8667 instruction.
8668
8669 The split in a @code{define_insn_and_rewrite} is only intended
8670 to apply to existing instructions that match @var{insn-pattern}.
8671 @var{split-condition} must therefore start with @code{&&},
8672 so that the split condition applies on top of @var{condition}.
8673
8674 Here is an example from the AArch64 SVE port, in which operand 1 is
8675 known to be equivalent to an all-true constant and isn't used by the
8676 output template:
8677
8678 @smallexample
8679 (define_insn_and_rewrite "*while_ult<GPI:mode><PRED_ALL:mode>_cc"
8680 [(set (reg:CC CC_REGNUM)
8681 (compare:CC
8682 (unspec:SI [(match_operand:PRED_ALL 1)
8683 (unspec:PRED_ALL
8684 [(match_operand:GPI 2 "aarch64_reg_or_zero" "rZ")
8685 (match_operand:GPI 3 "aarch64_reg_or_zero" "rZ")]
8686 UNSPEC_WHILE_LO)]
8687 UNSPEC_PTEST_PTRUE)
8688 (const_int 0)))
8689 (set (match_operand:PRED_ALL 0 "register_operand" "=Upa")
8690 (unspec:PRED_ALL [(match_dup 2)
8691 (match_dup 3)]
8692 UNSPEC_WHILE_LO))]
8693 "TARGET_SVE"
8694 "whilelo\t%0.<PRED_ALL:Vetype>, %<w>2, %<w>3"
8695 ;; Force the compiler to drop the unused predicate operand, so that we
8696 ;; don't have an unnecessary PTRUE.
8697 "&& !CONSTANT_P (operands[1])"
8698 @{
8699 operands[1] = CONSTM1_RTX (<MODE>mode);
8700 @}
8701 )
8702 @end smallexample
8703
8704 The splitter in this case simply replaces operand 1 with the constant
8705 value that it is known to have. The equivalent @code{define_insn_and_split}
8706 would be:
8707
8708 @smallexample
8709 (define_insn_and_split "*while_ult<GPI:mode><PRED_ALL:mode>_cc"
8710 [(set (reg:CC CC_REGNUM)
8711 (compare:CC
8712 (unspec:SI [(match_operand:PRED_ALL 1)
8713 (unspec:PRED_ALL
8714 [(match_operand:GPI 2 "aarch64_reg_or_zero" "rZ")
8715 (match_operand:GPI 3 "aarch64_reg_or_zero" "rZ")]
8716 UNSPEC_WHILE_LO)]
8717 UNSPEC_PTEST_PTRUE)
8718 (const_int 0)))
8719 (set (match_operand:PRED_ALL 0 "register_operand" "=Upa")
8720 (unspec:PRED_ALL [(match_dup 2)
8721 (match_dup 3)]
8722 UNSPEC_WHILE_LO))]
8723 "TARGET_SVE"
8724 "whilelo\t%0.<PRED_ALL:Vetype>, %<w>2, %<w>3"
8725 ;; Force the compiler to drop the unused predicate operand, so that we
8726 ;; don't have an unnecessary PTRUE.
8727 "&& !CONSTANT_P (operands[1])"
8728 [(parallel
8729 [(set (reg:CC CC_REGNUM)
8730 (compare:CC
8731 (unspec:SI [(match_dup 1)
8732 (unspec:PRED_ALL [(match_dup 2)
8733 (match_dup 3)]
8734 UNSPEC_WHILE_LO)]
8735 UNSPEC_PTEST_PTRUE)
8736 (const_int 0)))
8737 (set (match_dup 0)
8738 (unspec:PRED_ALL [(match_dup 2)
8739 (match_dup 3)]
8740 UNSPEC_WHILE_LO))])]
8741 @{
8742 operands[1] = CONSTM1_RTX (<MODE>mode);
8743 @}
8744 )
8745 @end smallexample
8746
8747 @end ifset
8748 @ifset INTERNALS
8749 @node Including Patterns
8750 @section Including Patterns in Machine Descriptions.
8751 @cindex insn includes
8752
8753 @findex include
8754 The @code{include} pattern tells the compiler tools where to
8755 look for patterns that are in files other than in the file
8756 @file{.md}. This is used only at build time and there is no preprocessing allowed.
8757
8758 It looks like:
8759
8760 @smallexample
8761
8762 (include
8763 @var{pathname})
8764 @end smallexample
8765
8766 For example:
8767
8768 @smallexample
8769
8770 (include "filestuff")
8771
8772 @end smallexample
8773
8774 Where @var{pathname} is a string that specifies the location of the file,
8775 specifies the include file to be in @file{gcc/config/target/filestuff}. The
8776 directory @file{gcc/config/target} is regarded as the default directory.
8777
8778
8779 Machine descriptions may be split up into smaller more manageable subsections
8780 and placed into subdirectories.
8781
8782 By specifying:
8783
8784 @smallexample
8785
8786 (include "BOGUS/filestuff")
8787
8788 @end smallexample
8789
8790 the include file is specified to be in @file{gcc/config/@var{target}/BOGUS/filestuff}.
8791
8792 Specifying an absolute path for the include file such as;
8793 @smallexample
8794
8795 (include "/u2/BOGUS/filestuff")
8796
8797 @end smallexample
8798 is permitted but is not encouraged.
8799
8800 @subsection RTL Generation Tool Options for Directory Search
8801 @cindex directory options .md
8802 @cindex options, directory search
8803 @cindex search options
8804
8805 The @option{-I@var{dir}} option specifies directories to search for machine descriptions.
8806 For example:
8807
8808 @smallexample
8809
8810 genrecog -I/p1/abc/proc1 -I/p2/abcd/pro2 target.md
8811
8812 @end smallexample
8813
8814
8815 Add the directory @var{dir} to the head of the list of directories to be
8816 searched for header files. This can be used to override a system machine definition
8817 file, substituting your own version, since these directories are
8818 searched before the default machine description file directories. If you use more than
8819 one @option{-I} option, the directories are scanned in left-to-right
8820 order; the standard default directory come after.
8821
8822
8823 @end ifset
8824 @ifset INTERNALS
8825 @node Peephole Definitions
8826 @section Machine-Specific Peephole Optimizers
8827 @cindex peephole optimizer definitions
8828 @cindex defining peephole optimizers
8829
8830 In addition to instruction patterns the @file{md} file may contain
8831 definitions of machine-specific peephole optimizations.
8832
8833 The combiner does not notice certain peephole optimizations when the data
8834 flow in the program does not suggest that it should try them. For example,
8835 sometimes two consecutive insns related in purpose can be combined even
8836 though the second one does not appear to use a register computed in the
8837 first one. A machine-specific peephole optimizer can detect such
8838 opportunities.
8839
8840 There are two forms of peephole definitions that may be used. The
8841 original @code{define_peephole} is run at assembly output time to
8842 match insns and substitute assembly text. Use of @code{define_peephole}
8843 is deprecated.
8844
8845 A newer @code{define_peephole2} matches insns and substitutes new
8846 insns. The @code{peephole2} pass is run after register allocation
8847 but before scheduling, which may result in much better code for
8848 targets that do scheduling.
8849
8850 @menu
8851 * define_peephole:: RTL to Text Peephole Optimizers
8852 * define_peephole2:: RTL to RTL Peephole Optimizers
8853 @end menu
8854
8855 @end ifset
8856 @ifset INTERNALS
8857 @node define_peephole
8858 @subsection RTL to Text Peephole Optimizers
8859 @findex define_peephole
8860
8861 @need 1000
8862 A definition looks like this:
8863
8864 @smallexample
8865 (define_peephole
8866 [@var{insn-pattern-1}
8867 @var{insn-pattern-2}
8868 @dots{}]
8869 "@var{condition}"
8870 "@var{template}"
8871 "@var{optional-insn-attributes}")
8872 @end smallexample
8873
8874 @noindent
8875 The last string operand may be omitted if you are not using any
8876 machine-specific information in this machine description. If present,
8877 it must obey the same rules as in a @code{define_insn}.
8878
8879 In this skeleton, @var{insn-pattern-1} and so on are patterns to match
8880 consecutive insns. The optimization applies to a sequence of insns when
8881 @var{insn-pattern-1} matches the first one, @var{insn-pattern-2} matches
8882 the next, and so on.
8883
8884 Each of the insns matched by a peephole must also match a
8885 @code{define_insn}. Peepholes are checked only at the last stage just
8886 before code generation, and only optionally. Therefore, any insn which
8887 would match a peephole but no @code{define_insn} will cause a crash in code
8888 generation in an unoptimized compilation, or at various optimization
8889 stages.
8890
8891 The operands of the insns are matched with @code{match_operands},
8892 @code{match_operator}, and @code{match_dup}, as usual. What is not
8893 usual is that the operand numbers apply to all the insn patterns in the
8894 definition. So, you can check for identical operands in two insns by
8895 using @code{match_operand} in one insn and @code{match_dup} in the
8896 other.
8897
8898 The operand constraints used in @code{match_operand} patterns do not have
8899 any direct effect on the applicability of the peephole, but they will
8900 be validated afterward, so make sure your constraints are general enough
8901 to apply whenever the peephole matches. If the peephole matches
8902 but the constraints are not satisfied, the compiler will crash.
8903
8904 It is safe to omit constraints in all the operands of the peephole; or
8905 you can write constraints which serve as a double-check on the criteria
8906 previously tested.
8907
8908 Once a sequence of insns matches the patterns, the @var{condition} is
8909 checked. This is a C expression which makes the final decision whether to
8910 perform the optimization (we do so if the expression is nonzero). If
8911 @var{condition} is omitted (in other words, the string is empty) then the
8912 optimization is applied to every sequence of insns that matches the
8913 patterns.
8914
8915 The defined peephole optimizations are applied after register allocation
8916 is complete. Therefore, the peephole definition can check which
8917 operands have ended up in which kinds of registers, just by looking at
8918 the operands.
8919
8920 @findex prev_active_insn
8921 The way to refer to the operands in @var{condition} is to write
8922 @code{operands[@var{i}]} for operand number @var{i} (as matched by
8923 @code{(match_operand @var{i} @dots{})}). Use the variable @code{insn}
8924 to refer to the last of the insns being matched; use
8925 @code{prev_active_insn} to find the preceding insns.
8926
8927 @findex dead_or_set_p
8928 When optimizing computations with intermediate results, you can use
8929 @var{condition} to match only when the intermediate results are not used
8930 elsewhere. Use the C expression @code{dead_or_set_p (@var{insn},
8931 @var{op})}, where @var{insn} is the insn in which you expect the value
8932 to be used for the last time (from the value of @code{insn}, together
8933 with use of @code{prev_nonnote_insn}), and @var{op} is the intermediate
8934 value (from @code{operands[@var{i}]}).
8935
8936 Applying the optimization means replacing the sequence of insns with one
8937 new insn. The @var{template} controls ultimate output of assembler code
8938 for this combined insn. It works exactly like the template of a
8939 @code{define_insn}. Operand numbers in this template are the same ones
8940 used in matching the original sequence of insns.
8941
8942 The result of a defined peephole optimizer does not need to match any of
8943 the insn patterns in the machine description; it does not even have an
8944 opportunity to match them. The peephole optimizer definition itself serves
8945 as the insn pattern to control how the insn is output.
8946
8947 Defined peephole optimizers are run as assembler code is being output,
8948 so the insns they produce are never combined or rearranged in any way.
8949
8950 Here is an example, taken from the 68000 machine description:
8951
8952 @smallexample
8953 (define_peephole
8954 [(set (reg:SI 15) (plus:SI (reg:SI 15) (const_int 4)))
8955 (set (match_operand:DF 0 "register_operand" "=f")
8956 (match_operand:DF 1 "register_operand" "ad"))]
8957 "FP_REG_P (operands[0]) && ! FP_REG_P (operands[1])"
8958 @{
8959 rtx xoperands[2];
8960 xoperands[1] = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, REGNO (operands[1]) + 1);
8961 #ifdef MOTOROLA
8962 output_asm_insn ("move.l %1,(sp)", xoperands);
8963 output_asm_insn ("move.l %1,-(sp)", operands);
8964 return "fmove.d (sp)+,%0";
8965 #else
8966 output_asm_insn ("movel %1,sp@@", xoperands);
8967 output_asm_insn ("movel %1,sp@@-", operands);
8968 return "fmoved sp@@+,%0";
8969 #endif
8970 @})
8971 @end smallexample
8972
8973 @need 1000
8974 The effect of this optimization is to change
8975
8976 @smallexample
8977 @group
8978 jbsr _foobar
8979 addql #4,sp
8980 movel d1,sp@@-
8981 movel d0,sp@@-
8982 fmoved sp@@+,fp0
8983 @end group
8984 @end smallexample
8985
8986 @noindent
8987 into
8988
8989 @smallexample
8990 @group
8991 jbsr _foobar
8992 movel d1,sp@@
8993 movel d0,sp@@-
8994 fmoved sp@@+,fp0
8995 @end group
8996 @end smallexample
8997
8998 @ignore
8999 @findex CC_REVERSED
9000 If a peephole matches a sequence including one or more jump insns, you must
9001 take account of the flags such as @code{CC_REVERSED} which specify that the
9002 condition codes are represented in an unusual manner. The compiler
9003 automatically alters any ordinary conditional jumps which occur in such
9004 situations, but the compiler cannot alter jumps which have been replaced by
9005 peephole optimizations. So it is up to you to alter the assembler code
9006 that the peephole produces. Supply C code to write the assembler output,
9007 and in this C code check the condition code status flags and change the
9008 assembler code as appropriate.
9009 @end ignore
9010
9011 @var{insn-pattern-1} and so on look @emph{almost} like the second
9012 operand of @code{define_insn}. There is one important difference: the
9013 second operand of @code{define_insn} consists of one or more RTX's
9014 enclosed in square brackets. Usually, there is only one: then the same
9015 action can be written as an element of a @code{define_peephole}. But
9016 when there are multiple actions in a @code{define_insn}, they are
9017 implicitly enclosed in a @code{parallel}. Then you must explicitly
9018 write the @code{parallel}, and the square brackets within it, in the
9019 @code{define_peephole}. Thus, if an insn pattern looks like this,
9020
9021 @smallexample
9022 (define_insn "divmodsi4"
9023 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=d")
9024 (div:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "general_operand" "0")
9025 (match_operand:SI 2 "general_operand" "dmsK")))
9026 (set (match_operand:SI 3 "general_operand" "=d")
9027 (mod:SI (match_dup 1) (match_dup 2)))]
9028 "TARGET_68020"
9029 "divsl%.l %2,%3:%0")
9030 @end smallexample
9031
9032 @noindent
9033 then the way to mention this insn in a peephole is as follows:
9034
9035 @smallexample
9036 (define_peephole
9037 [@dots{}
9038 (parallel
9039 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=d")
9040 (div:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "general_operand" "0")
9041 (match_operand:SI 2 "general_operand" "dmsK")))
9042 (set (match_operand:SI 3 "general_operand" "=d")
9043 (mod:SI (match_dup 1) (match_dup 2)))])
9044 @dots{}]
9045 @dots{})
9046 @end smallexample
9047
9048 @end ifset
9049 @ifset INTERNALS
9050 @node define_peephole2
9051 @subsection RTL to RTL Peephole Optimizers
9052 @findex define_peephole2
9053
9054 The @code{define_peephole2} definition tells the compiler how to
9055 substitute one sequence of instructions for another sequence,
9056 what additional scratch registers may be needed and what their
9057 lifetimes must be.
9058
9059 @smallexample
9060 (define_peephole2
9061 [@var{insn-pattern-1}
9062 @var{insn-pattern-2}
9063 @dots{}]
9064 "@var{condition}"
9065 [@var{new-insn-pattern-1}
9066 @var{new-insn-pattern-2}
9067 @dots{}]
9068 "@var{preparation-statements}")
9069 @end smallexample
9070
9071 The definition is almost identical to @code{define_split}
9072 (@pxref{Insn Splitting}) except that the pattern to match is not a
9073 single instruction, but a sequence of instructions.
9074
9075 It is possible to request additional scratch registers for use in the
9076 output template. If appropriate registers are not free, the pattern
9077 will simply not match.
9078
9079 @findex match_scratch
9080 @findex match_dup
9081 Scratch registers are requested with a @code{match_scratch} pattern at
9082 the top level of the input pattern. The allocated register (initially) will
9083 be dead at the point requested within the original sequence. If the scratch
9084 is used at more than a single point, a @code{match_dup} pattern at the
9085 top level of the input pattern marks the last position in the input sequence
9086 at which the register must be available.
9087
9088 Here is an example from the IA-32 machine description:
9089
9090 @smallexample
9091 (define_peephole2
9092 [(match_scratch:SI 2 "r")
9093 (parallel [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "")
9094 (match_operator:SI 3 "arith_or_logical_operator"
9095 [(match_dup 0)
9096 (match_operand:SI 1 "memory_operand" "")]))
9097 (clobber (reg:CC 17))])]
9098 "! optimize_size && ! TARGET_READ_MODIFY"
9099 [(set (match_dup 2) (match_dup 1))
9100 (parallel [(set (match_dup 0)
9101 (match_op_dup 3 [(match_dup 0) (match_dup 2)]))
9102 (clobber (reg:CC 17))])]
9103 "")
9104 @end smallexample
9105
9106 @noindent
9107 This pattern tries to split a load from its use in the hopes that we'll be
9108 able to schedule around the memory load latency. It allocates a single
9109 @code{SImode} register of class @code{GENERAL_REGS} (@code{"r"}) that needs
9110 to be live only at the point just before the arithmetic.
9111
9112 A real example requiring extended scratch lifetimes is harder to come by,
9113 so here's a silly made-up example:
9114
9115 @smallexample
9116 (define_peephole2
9117 [(match_scratch:SI 4 "r")
9118 (set (match_operand:SI 0 "" "") (match_operand:SI 1 "" ""))
9119 (set (match_operand:SI 2 "" "") (match_dup 1))
9120 (match_dup 4)
9121 (set (match_operand:SI 3 "" "") (match_dup 1))]
9122 "/* @r{determine 1 does not overlap 0 and 2} */"
9123 [(set (match_dup 4) (match_dup 1))
9124 (set (match_dup 0) (match_dup 4))
9125 (set (match_dup 2) (match_dup 4))
9126 (set (match_dup 3) (match_dup 4))]
9127 "")
9128 @end smallexample
9129
9130 There are two special macros defined for use in the preparation statements:
9131 @code{DONE} and @code{FAIL}. Use them with a following semicolon,
9132 as a statement.
9133
9134 @table @code
9135
9136 @findex DONE
9137 @item DONE
9138 Use the @code{DONE} macro to end RTL generation for the peephole. The
9139 only RTL insns generated as replacement for the matched input insn will
9140 be those already emitted by explicit calls to @code{emit_insn} within
9141 the preparation statements; the replacement pattern is not used.
9142
9143 @findex FAIL
9144 @item FAIL
9145 Make the @code{define_peephole2} fail on this occasion. When a @code{define_peephole2}
9146 fails, it means that the replacement was not truly available for the
9147 particular inputs it was given. In that case, GCC may still apply a
9148 later @code{define_peephole2} that also matches the given insn pattern.
9149 (Note that this is different from @code{define_split}, where @code{FAIL}
9150 prevents the input insn from being split at all.)
9151 @end table
9152
9153 If the preparation falls through (invokes neither @code{DONE} nor
9154 @code{FAIL}), then the @code{define_peephole2} uses the replacement
9155 template.
9156
9157 @noindent
9158 If we had not added the @code{(match_dup 4)} in the middle of the input
9159 sequence, it might have been the case that the register we chose at the
9160 beginning of the sequence is killed by the first or second @code{set}.
9161
9162 @end ifset
9163 @ifset INTERNALS
9164 @node Insn Attributes
9165 @section Instruction Attributes
9166 @cindex insn attributes
9167 @cindex instruction attributes
9168
9169 In addition to describing the instruction supported by the target machine,
9170 the @file{md} file also defines a group of @dfn{attributes} and a set of
9171 values for each. Every generated insn is assigned a value for each attribute.
9172 One possible attribute would be the effect that the insn has on the machine's
9173 condition code. This attribute can then be used by @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}
9174 to track the condition codes.
9175
9176 @menu
9177 * Defining Attributes:: Specifying attributes and their values.
9178 * Expressions:: Valid expressions for attribute values.
9179 * Tagging Insns:: Assigning attribute values to insns.
9180 * Attr Example:: An example of assigning attributes.
9181 * Insn Lengths:: Computing the length of insns.
9182 * Constant Attributes:: Defining attributes that are constant.
9183 * Mnemonic Attribute:: Obtain the instruction mnemonic as attribute value.
9184 * Delay Slots:: Defining delay slots required for a machine.
9185 * Processor pipeline description:: Specifying information for insn scheduling.
9186 @end menu
9187
9188 @end ifset
9189 @ifset INTERNALS
9190 @node Defining Attributes
9191 @subsection Defining Attributes and their Values
9192 @cindex defining attributes and their values
9193 @cindex attributes, defining
9194
9195 @findex define_attr
9196 The @code{define_attr} expression is used to define each attribute required
9197 by the target machine. It looks like:
9198
9199 @smallexample
9200 (define_attr @var{name} @var{list-of-values} @var{default})
9201 @end smallexample
9202
9203 @var{name} is a string specifying the name of the attribute being
9204 defined. Some attributes are used in a special way by the rest of the
9205 compiler. The @code{enabled} attribute can be used to conditionally
9206 enable or disable insn alternatives (@pxref{Disable Insn
9207 Alternatives}). The @code{predicable} attribute, together with a
9208 suitable @code{define_cond_exec} (@pxref{Conditional Execution}), can
9209 be used to automatically generate conditional variants of instruction
9210 patterns. The @code{mnemonic} attribute can be used to check for the
9211 instruction mnemonic (@pxref{Mnemonic Attribute}). The compiler
9212 internally uses the names @code{ce_enabled} and @code{nonce_enabled},
9213 so they should not be used elsewhere as alternative names.
9214
9215 @var{list-of-values} is either a string that specifies a comma-separated
9216 list of values that can be assigned to the attribute, or a null string to
9217 indicate that the attribute takes numeric values.
9218
9219 @var{default} is an attribute expression that gives the value of this
9220 attribute for insns that match patterns whose definition does not include
9221 an explicit value for this attribute. @xref{Attr Example}, for more
9222 information on the handling of defaults. @xref{Constant Attributes},
9223 for information on attributes that do not depend on any particular insn.
9224
9225 @findex insn-attr.h
9226 For each defined attribute, a number of definitions are written to the
9227 @file{insn-attr.h} file. For cases where an explicit set of values is
9228 specified for an attribute, the following are defined:
9229
9230 @itemize @bullet
9231 @item
9232 A @samp{#define} is written for the symbol @samp{HAVE_ATTR_@var{name}}.
9233
9234 @item
9235 An enumerated class is defined for @samp{attr_@var{name}} with
9236 elements of the form @samp{@var{upper-name}_@var{upper-value}} where
9237 the attribute name and value are first converted to uppercase.
9238
9239 @item
9240 A function @samp{get_attr_@var{name}} is defined that is passed an insn and
9241 returns the attribute value for that insn.
9242 @end itemize
9243
9244 For example, if the following is present in the @file{md} file:
9245
9246 @smallexample
9247 (define_attr "type" "branch,fp,load,store,arith" @dots{})
9248 @end smallexample
9249
9250 @noindent
9251 the following lines will be written to the file @file{insn-attr.h}.
9252
9253 @smallexample
9254 #define HAVE_ATTR_type 1
9255 enum attr_type @{TYPE_BRANCH, TYPE_FP, TYPE_LOAD,
9256 TYPE_STORE, TYPE_ARITH@};
9257 extern enum attr_type get_attr_type ();
9258 @end smallexample
9259
9260 If the attribute takes numeric values, no @code{enum} type will be
9261 defined and the function to obtain the attribute's value will return
9262 @code{int}.
9263
9264 There are attributes which are tied to a specific meaning. These
9265 attributes are not free to use for other purposes:
9266
9267 @table @code
9268 @item length
9269 The @code{length} attribute is used to calculate the length of emitted
9270 code chunks. This is especially important when verifying branch
9271 distances. @xref{Insn Lengths}.
9272
9273 @item enabled
9274 The @code{enabled} attribute can be defined to prevent certain
9275 alternatives of an insn definition from being used during code
9276 generation. @xref{Disable Insn Alternatives}.
9277
9278 @item mnemonic
9279 The @code{mnemonic} attribute can be defined to implement instruction
9280 specific checks in e.g.@: the pipeline description.
9281 @xref{Mnemonic Attribute}.
9282 @end table
9283
9284 For each of these special attributes, the corresponding
9285 @samp{HAVE_ATTR_@var{name}} @samp{#define} is also written when the
9286 attribute is not defined; in that case, it is defined as @samp{0}.
9287
9288 @findex define_enum_attr
9289 @anchor{define_enum_attr}
9290 Another way of defining an attribute is to use:
9291
9292 @smallexample
9293 (define_enum_attr "@var{attr}" "@var{enum}" @var{default})
9294 @end smallexample
9295
9296 This works in just the same way as @code{define_attr}, except that
9297 the list of values is taken from a separate enumeration called
9298 @var{enum} (@pxref{define_enum}). This form allows you to use
9299 the same list of values for several attributes without having to
9300 repeat the list each time. For example:
9301
9302 @smallexample
9303 (define_enum "processor" [
9304 model_a
9305 model_b
9306 @dots{}
9307 ])
9308 (define_enum_attr "arch" "processor"
9309 (const (symbol_ref "target_arch")))
9310 (define_enum_attr "tune" "processor"
9311 (const (symbol_ref "target_tune")))
9312 @end smallexample
9313
9314 defines the same attributes as:
9315
9316 @smallexample
9317 (define_attr "arch" "model_a,model_b,@dots{}"
9318 (const (symbol_ref "target_arch")))
9319 (define_attr "tune" "model_a,model_b,@dots{}"
9320 (const (symbol_ref "target_tune")))
9321 @end smallexample
9322
9323 but without duplicating the processor list. The second example defines two
9324 separate C enums (@code{attr_arch} and @code{attr_tune}) whereas the first
9325 defines a single C enum (@code{processor}).
9326 @end ifset
9327 @ifset INTERNALS
9328 @node Expressions
9329 @subsection Attribute Expressions
9330 @cindex attribute expressions
9331
9332 RTL expressions used to define attributes use the codes described above
9333 plus a few specific to attribute definitions, to be discussed below.
9334 Attribute value expressions must have one of the following forms:
9335
9336 @table @code
9337 @cindex @code{const_int} and attributes
9338 @item (const_int @var{i})
9339 The integer @var{i} specifies the value of a numeric attribute. @var{i}
9340 must be non-negative.
9341
9342 The value of a numeric attribute can be specified either with a
9343 @code{const_int}, or as an integer represented as a string in
9344 @code{const_string}, @code{eq_attr} (see below), @code{attr},
9345 @code{symbol_ref}, simple arithmetic expressions, and @code{set_attr}
9346 overrides on specific instructions (@pxref{Tagging Insns}).
9347
9348 @cindex @code{const_string} and attributes
9349 @item (const_string @var{value})
9350 The string @var{value} specifies a constant attribute value.
9351 If @var{value} is specified as @samp{"*"}, it means that the default value of
9352 the attribute is to be used for the insn containing this expression.
9353 @samp{"*"} obviously cannot be used in the @var{default} expression
9354 of a @code{define_attr}.
9355
9356 If the attribute whose value is being specified is numeric, @var{value}
9357 must be a string containing a non-negative integer (normally
9358 @code{const_int} would be used in this case). Otherwise, it must
9359 contain one of the valid values for the attribute.
9360
9361 @cindex @code{if_then_else} and attributes
9362 @item (if_then_else @var{test} @var{true-value} @var{false-value})
9363 @var{test} specifies an attribute test, whose format is defined below.
9364 The value of this expression is @var{true-value} if @var{test} is true,
9365 otherwise it is @var{false-value}.
9366
9367 @cindex @code{cond} and attributes
9368 @item (cond [@var{test1} @var{value1} @dots{}] @var{default})
9369 The first operand of this expression is a vector containing an even
9370 number of expressions and consisting of pairs of @var{test} and @var{value}
9371 expressions. The value of the @code{cond} expression is that of the
9372 @var{value} corresponding to the first true @var{test} expression. If
9373 none of the @var{test} expressions are true, the value of the @code{cond}
9374 expression is that of the @var{default} expression.
9375 @end table
9376
9377 @var{test} expressions can have one of the following forms:
9378
9379 @table @code
9380 @cindex @code{const_int} and attribute tests
9381 @item (const_int @var{i})
9382 This test is true if @var{i} is nonzero and false otherwise.
9383
9384 @cindex @code{not} and attributes
9385 @cindex @code{ior} and attributes
9386 @cindex @code{and} and attributes
9387 @item (not @var{test})
9388 @itemx (ior @var{test1} @var{test2})
9389 @itemx (and @var{test1} @var{test2})
9390 These tests are true if the indicated logical function is true.
9391
9392 @cindex @code{match_operand} and attributes
9393 @item (match_operand:@var{m} @var{n} @var{pred} @var{constraints})
9394 This test is true if operand @var{n} of the insn whose attribute value
9395 is being determined has mode @var{m} (this part of the test is ignored
9396 if @var{m} is @code{VOIDmode}) and the function specified by the string
9397 @var{pred} returns a nonzero value when passed operand @var{n} and mode
9398 @var{m} (this part of the test is ignored if @var{pred} is the null
9399 string).
9400
9401 The @var{constraints} operand is ignored and should be the null string.
9402
9403 @cindex @code{match_test} and attributes
9404 @item (match_test @var{c-expr})
9405 The test is true if C expression @var{c-expr} is true. In non-constant
9406 attributes, @var{c-expr} has access to the following variables:
9407
9408 @table @var
9409 @item insn
9410 The rtl instruction under test.
9411 @item which_alternative
9412 The @code{define_insn} alternative that @var{insn} matches.
9413 @xref{Output Statement}.
9414 @item operands
9415 An array of @var{insn}'s rtl operands.
9416 @end table
9417
9418 @var{c-expr} behaves like the condition in a C @code{if} statement,
9419 so there is no need to explicitly convert the expression into a boolean
9420 0 or 1 value. For example, the following two tests are equivalent:
9421
9422 @smallexample
9423 (match_test "x & 2")
9424 (match_test "(x & 2) != 0")
9425 @end smallexample
9426
9427 @cindex @code{le} and attributes
9428 @cindex @code{leu} and attributes
9429 @cindex @code{lt} and attributes
9430 @cindex @code{gt} and attributes
9431 @cindex @code{gtu} and attributes
9432 @cindex @code{ge} and attributes
9433 @cindex @code{geu} and attributes
9434 @cindex @code{ne} and attributes
9435 @cindex @code{eq} and attributes
9436 @cindex @code{plus} and attributes
9437 @cindex @code{minus} and attributes
9438 @cindex @code{mult} and attributes
9439 @cindex @code{div} and attributes
9440 @cindex @code{mod} and attributes
9441 @cindex @code{abs} and attributes
9442 @cindex @code{neg} and attributes
9443 @cindex @code{ashift} and attributes
9444 @cindex @code{lshiftrt} and attributes
9445 @cindex @code{ashiftrt} and attributes
9446 @item (le @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
9447 @itemx (leu @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
9448 @itemx (lt @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
9449 @itemx (ltu @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
9450 @itemx (gt @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
9451 @itemx (gtu @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
9452 @itemx (ge @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
9453 @itemx (geu @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
9454 @itemx (ne @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
9455 @itemx (eq @var{arith1} @var{arith2})
9456 These tests are true if the indicated comparison of the two arithmetic
9457 expressions is true. Arithmetic expressions are formed with
9458 @code{plus}, @code{minus}, @code{mult}, @code{div}, @code{mod},
9459 @code{abs}, @code{neg}, @code{and}, @code{ior}, @code{xor}, @code{not},
9460 @code{ashift}, @code{lshiftrt}, and @code{ashiftrt} expressions.
9461
9462 @findex get_attr
9463 @code{const_int} and @code{symbol_ref} are always valid terms (@pxref{Insn
9464 Lengths},for additional forms). @code{symbol_ref} is a string
9465 denoting a C expression that yields an @code{int} when evaluated by the
9466 @samp{get_attr_@dots{}} routine. It should normally be a global
9467 variable.
9468
9469 @findex eq_attr
9470 @item (eq_attr @var{name} @var{value})
9471 @var{name} is a string specifying the name of an attribute.
9472
9473 @var{value} is a string that is either a valid value for attribute
9474 @var{name}, a comma-separated list of values, or @samp{!} followed by a
9475 value or list. If @var{value} does not begin with a @samp{!}, this
9476 test is true if the value of the @var{name} attribute of the current
9477 insn is in the list specified by @var{value}. If @var{value} begins
9478 with a @samp{!}, this test is true if the attribute's value is
9479 @emph{not} in the specified list.
9480
9481 For example,
9482
9483 @smallexample
9484 (eq_attr "type" "load,store")
9485 @end smallexample
9486
9487 @noindent
9488 is equivalent to
9489
9490 @smallexample
9491 (ior (eq_attr "type" "load") (eq_attr "type" "store"))
9492 @end smallexample
9493
9494 If @var{name} specifies an attribute of @samp{alternative}, it refers to the
9495 value of the compiler variable @code{which_alternative}
9496 (@pxref{Output Statement}) and the values must be small integers. For
9497 example,
9498
9499 @smallexample
9500 (eq_attr "alternative" "2,3")
9501 @end smallexample
9502
9503 @noindent
9504 is equivalent to
9505
9506 @smallexample
9507 (ior (eq (symbol_ref "which_alternative") (const_int 2))
9508 (eq (symbol_ref "which_alternative") (const_int 3)))
9509 @end smallexample
9510
9511 Note that, for most attributes, an @code{eq_attr} test is simplified in cases
9512 where the value of the attribute being tested is known for all insns matching
9513 a particular pattern. This is by far the most common case.
9514
9515 @findex attr_flag
9516 @item (attr_flag @var{name})
9517 The value of an @code{attr_flag} expression is true if the flag
9518 specified by @var{name} is true for the @code{insn} currently being
9519 scheduled.
9520
9521 @var{name} is a string specifying one of a fixed set of flags to test.
9522 Test the flags @code{forward} and @code{backward} to determine the
9523 direction of a conditional branch.
9524
9525 This example describes a conditional branch delay slot which
9526 can be nullified for forward branches that are taken (annul-true) or
9527 for backward branches which are not taken (annul-false).
9528
9529 @smallexample
9530 (define_delay (eq_attr "type" "cbranch")
9531 [(eq_attr "in_branch_delay" "true")
9532 (and (eq_attr "in_branch_delay" "true")
9533 (attr_flag "forward"))
9534 (and (eq_attr "in_branch_delay" "true")
9535 (attr_flag "backward"))])
9536 @end smallexample
9537
9538 The @code{forward} and @code{backward} flags are false if the current
9539 @code{insn} being scheduled is not a conditional branch.
9540
9541 @code{attr_flag} is only used during delay slot scheduling and has no
9542 meaning to other passes of the compiler.
9543
9544 @findex attr
9545 @item (attr @var{name})
9546 The value of another attribute is returned. This is most useful
9547 for numeric attributes, as @code{eq_attr} and @code{attr_flag}
9548 produce more efficient code for non-numeric attributes.
9549 @end table
9550
9551 @end ifset
9552 @ifset INTERNALS
9553 @node Tagging Insns
9554 @subsection Assigning Attribute Values to Insns
9555 @cindex tagging insns
9556 @cindex assigning attribute values to insns
9557
9558 The value assigned to an attribute of an insn is primarily determined by
9559 which pattern is matched by that insn (or which @code{define_peephole}
9560 generated it). Every @code{define_insn} and @code{define_peephole} can
9561 have an optional last argument to specify the values of attributes for
9562 matching insns. The value of any attribute not specified in a particular
9563 insn is set to the default value for that attribute, as specified in its
9564 @code{define_attr}. Extensive use of default values for attributes
9565 permits the specification of the values for only one or two attributes
9566 in the definition of most insn patterns, as seen in the example in the
9567 next section.
9568
9569 The optional last argument of @code{define_insn} and
9570 @code{define_peephole} is a vector of expressions, each of which defines
9571 the value for a single attribute. The most general way of assigning an
9572 attribute's value is to use a @code{set} expression whose first operand is an
9573 @code{attr} expression giving the name of the attribute being set. The
9574 second operand of the @code{set} is an attribute expression
9575 (@pxref{Expressions}) giving the value of the attribute.
9576
9577 When the attribute value depends on the @samp{alternative} attribute
9578 (i.e., which is the applicable alternative in the constraint of the
9579 insn), the @code{set_attr_alternative} expression can be used. It
9580 allows the specification of a vector of attribute expressions, one for
9581 each alternative.
9582
9583 @findex set_attr
9584 When the generality of arbitrary attribute expressions is not required,
9585 the simpler @code{set_attr} expression can be used, which allows
9586 specifying a string giving either a single attribute value or a list
9587 of attribute values, one for each alternative.
9588
9589 The form of each of the above specifications is shown below. In each case,
9590 @var{name} is a string specifying the attribute to be set.
9591
9592 @table @code
9593 @item (set_attr @var{name} @var{value-string})
9594 @var{value-string} is either a string giving the desired attribute value,
9595 or a string containing a comma-separated list giving the values for
9596 succeeding alternatives. The number of elements must match the number
9597 of alternatives in the constraint of the insn pattern.
9598
9599 Note that it may be useful to specify @samp{*} for some alternative, in
9600 which case the attribute will assume its default value for insns matching
9601 that alternative.
9602
9603 @findex set_attr_alternative
9604 @item (set_attr_alternative @var{name} [@var{value1} @var{value2} @dots{}])
9605 Depending on the alternative of the insn, the value will be one of the
9606 specified values. This is a shorthand for using a @code{cond} with
9607 tests on the @samp{alternative} attribute.
9608
9609 @findex attr
9610 @item (set (attr @var{name}) @var{value})
9611 The first operand of this @code{set} must be the special RTL expression
9612 @code{attr}, whose sole operand is a string giving the name of the
9613 attribute being set. @var{value} is the value of the attribute.
9614 @end table
9615
9616 The following shows three different ways of representing the same
9617 attribute value specification:
9618
9619 @smallexample
9620 (set_attr "type" "load,store,arith")
9621
9622 (set_attr_alternative "type"
9623 [(const_string "load") (const_string "store")
9624 (const_string "arith")])
9625
9626 (set (attr "type")
9627 (cond [(eq_attr "alternative" "1") (const_string "load")
9628 (eq_attr "alternative" "2") (const_string "store")]
9629 (const_string "arith")))
9630 @end smallexample
9631
9632 @need 1000
9633 @findex define_asm_attributes
9634 The @code{define_asm_attributes} expression provides a mechanism to
9635 specify the attributes assigned to insns produced from an @code{asm}
9636 statement. It has the form:
9637
9638 @smallexample
9639 (define_asm_attributes [@var{attr-sets}])
9640 @end smallexample
9641
9642 @noindent
9643 where @var{attr-sets} is specified the same as for both the
9644 @code{define_insn} and the @code{define_peephole} expressions.
9645
9646 These values will typically be the ``worst case'' attribute values. For
9647 example, they might indicate that the condition code will be clobbered.
9648
9649 A specification for a @code{length} attribute is handled specially. The
9650 way to compute the length of an @code{asm} insn is to multiply the
9651 length specified in the expression @code{define_asm_attributes} by the
9652 number of machine instructions specified in the @code{asm} statement,
9653 determined by counting the number of semicolons and newlines in the
9654 string. Therefore, the value of the @code{length} attribute specified
9655 in a @code{define_asm_attributes} should be the maximum possible length
9656 of a single machine instruction.
9657
9658 @end ifset
9659 @ifset INTERNALS
9660 @node Attr Example
9661 @subsection Example of Attribute Specifications
9662 @cindex attribute specifications example
9663 @cindex attribute specifications
9664
9665 The judicious use of defaulting is important in the efficient use of
9666 insn attributes. Typically, insns are divided into @dfn{types} and an
9667 attribute, customarily called @code{type}, is used to represent this
9668 value. This attribute is normally used only to define the default value
9669 for other attributes. An example will clarify this usage.
9670
9671 Assume we have a RISC machine with a condition code and in which only
9672 full-word operations are performed in registers. Let us assume that we
9673 can divide all insns into loads, stores, (integer) arithmetic
9674 operations, floating point operations, and branches.
9675
9676 Here we will concern ourselves with determining the effect of an insn on
9677 the condition code and will limit ourselves to the following possible
9678 effects: The condition code can be set unpredictably (clobbered), not
9679 be changed, be set to agree with the results of the operation, or only
9680 changed if the item previously set into the condition code has been
9681 modified.
9682
9683 Here is part of a sample @file{md} file for such a machine:
9684
9685 @smallexample
9686 (define_attr "type" "load,store,arith,fp,branch" (const_string "arith"))
9687
9688 (define_attr "cc" "clobber,unchanged,set,change0"
9689 (cond [(eq_attr "type" "load")
9690 (const_string "change0")
9691 (eq_attr "type" "store,branch")
9692 (const_string "unchanged")
9693 (eq_attr "type" "arith")
9694 (if_then_else (match_operand:SI 0 "" "")
9695 (const_string "set")
9696 (const_string "clobber"))]
9697 (const_string "clobber")))
9698
9699 (define_insn ""
9700 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "general_operand" "=r,r,m")
9701 (match_operand:SI 1 "general_operand" "r,m,r"))]
9702 ""
9703 "@@
9704 move %0,%1
9705 load %0,%1
9706 store %0,%1"
9707 [(set_attr "type" "arith,load,store")])
9708 @end smallexample
9709
9710 Note that we assume in the above example that arithmetic operations
9711 performed on quantities smaller than a machine word clobber the condition
9712 code since they will set the condition code to a value corresponding to the
9713 full-word result.
9714
9715 @end ifset
9716 @ifset INTERNALS
9717 @node Insn Lengths
9718 @subsection Computing the Length of an Insn
9719 @cindex insn lengths, computing
9720 @cindex computing the length of an insn
9721
9722 For many machines, multiple types of branch instructions are provided, each
9723 for different length branch displacements. In most cases, the assembler
9724 will choose the correct instruction to use. However, when the assembler
9725 cannot do so, GCC can when a special attribute, the @code{length}
9726 attribute, is defined. This attribute must be defined to have numeric
9727 values by specifying a null string in its @code{define_attr}.
9728
9729 In the case of the @code{length} attribute, two additional forms of
9730 arithmetic terms are allowed in test expressions:
9731
9732 @table @code
9733 @cindex @code{match_dup} and attributes
9734 @item (match_dup @var{n})
9735 This refers to the address of operand @var{n} of the current insn, which
9736 must be a @code{label_ref}.
9737
9738 @cindex @code{pc} and attributes
9739 @item (pc)
9740 For non-branch instructions and backward branch instructions, this refers
9741 to the address of the current insn. But for forward branch instructions,
9742 this refers to the address of the next insn, because the length of the
9743 current insn is to be computed.
9744 @end table
9745
9746 @cindex @code{addr_vec}, length of
9747 @cindex @code{addr_diff_vec}, length of
9748 For normal insns, the length will be determined by value of the
9749 @code{length} attribute. In the case of @code{addr_vec} and
9750 @code{addr_diff_vec} insn patterns, the length is computed as
9751 the number of vectors multiplied by the size of each vector.
9752
9753 Lengths are measured in addressable storage units (bytes).
9754
9755 Note that it is possible to call functions via the @code{symbol_ref}
9756 mechanism to compute the length of an insn. However, if you use this
9757 mechanism you must provide dummy clauses to express the maximum length
9758 without using the function call. You can an example of this in the
9759 @code{pa} machine description for the @code{call_symref} pattern.
9760
9761 The following macros can be used to refine the length computation:
9762
9763 @table @code
9764 @findex ADJUST_INSN_LENGTH
9765 @item ADJUST_INSN_LENGTH (@var{insn}, @var{length})
9766 If defined, modifies the length assigned to instruction @var{insn} as a
9767 function of the context in which it is used. @var{length} is an lvalue
9768 that contains the initially computed length of the insn and should be
9769 updated with the correct length of the insn.
9770
9771 This macro will normally not be required. A case in which it is
9772 required is the ROMP@. On this machine, the size of an @code{addr_vec}
9773 insn must be increased by two to compensate for the fact that alignment
9774 may be required.
9775 @end table
9776
9777 @findex get_attr_length
9778 The routine that returns @code{get_attr_length} (the value of the
9779 @code{length} attribute) can be used by the output routine to
9780 determine the form of the branch instruction to be written, as the
9781 example below illustrates.
9782
9783 As an example of the specification of variable-length branches, consider
9784 the IBM 360. If we adopt the convention that a register will be set to
9785 the starting address of a function, we can jump to labels within 4k of
9786 the start using a four-byte instruction. Otherwise, we need a six-byte
9787 sequence to load the address from memory and then branch to it.
9788
9789 On such a machine, a pattern for a branch instruction might be specified
9790 as follows:
9791
9792 @smallexample
9793 (define_insn "jump"
9794 [(set (pc)
9795 (label_ref (match_operand 0 "" "")))]
9796 ""
9797 @{
9798 return (get_attr_length (insn) == 4
9799 ? "b %l0" : "l r15,=a(%l0); br r15");
9800 @}
9801 [(set (attr "length")
9802 (if_then_else (lt (match_dup 0) (const_int 4096))
9803 (const_int 4)
9804 (const_int 6)))])
9805 @end smallexample
9806
9807 @end ifset
9808 @ifset INTERNALS
9809 @node Constant Attributes
9810 @subsection Constant Attributes
9811 @cindex constant attributes
9812
9813 A special form of @code{define_attr}, where the expression for the
9814 default value is a @code{const} expression, indicates an attribute that
9815 is constant for a given run of the compiler. Constant attributes may be
9816 used to specify which variety of processor is used. For example,
9817
9818 @smallexample
9819 (define_attr "cpu" "m88100,m88110,m88000"
9820 (const
9821 (cond [(symbol_ref "TARGET_88100") (const_string "m88100")
9822 (symbol_ref "TARGET_88110") (const_string "m88110")]
9823 (const_string "m88000"))))
9824
9825 (define_attr "memory" "fast,slow"
9826 (const
9827 (if_then_else (symbol_ref "TARGET_FAST_MEM")
9828 (const_string "fast")
9829 (const_string "slow"))))
9830 @end smallexample
9831
9832 The routine generated for constant attributes has no parameters as it
9833 does not depend on any particular insn. RTL expressions used to define
9834 the value of a constant attribute may use the @code{symbol_ref} form,
9835 but may not use either the @code{match_operand} form or @code{eq_attr}
9836 forms involving insn attributes.
9837
9838 @end ifset
9839 @ifset INTERNALS
9840 @node Mnemonic Attribute
9841 @subsection Mnemonic Attribute
9842 @cindex mnemonic attribute
9843
9844 The @code{mnemonic} attribute is a string type attribute holding the
9845 instruction mnemonic for an insn alternative. The attribute values
9846 will automatically be generated by the machine description parser if
9847 there is an attribute definition in the md file:
9848
9849 @smallexample
9850 (define_attr "mnemonic" "unknown" (const_string "unknown"))
9851 @end smallexample
9852
9853 The default value can be freely chosen as long as it does not collide
9854 with any of the instruction mnemonics. This value will be used
9855 whenever the machine description parser is not able to determine the
9856 mnemonic string. This might be the case for output templates
9857 containing more than a single instruction as in
9858 @code{"mvcle\t%0,%1,0\;jo\t.-4"}.
9859
9860 The @code{mnemonic} attribute set is not generated automatically if the
9861 instruction string is generated via C code.
9862
9863 An existing @code{mnemonic} attribute set in an insn definition will not
9864 be overriden by the md file parser. That way it is possible to
9865 manually set the instruction mnemonics for the cases where the md file
9866 parser fails to determine it automatically.
9867
9868 The @code{mnemonic} attribute is useful for dealing with instruction
9869 specific properties in the pipeline description without defining
9870 additional insn attributes.
9871
9872 @smallexample
9873 (define_attr "ooo_expanded" ""
9874 (cond [(eq_attr "mnemonic" "dlr,dsgr,d,dsgf,stam,dsgfr,dlgr")
9875 (const_int 1)]
9876 (const_int 0)))
9877 @end smallexample
9878
9879 @end ifset
9880 @ifset INTERNALS
9881 @node Delay Slots
9882 @subsection Delay Slot Scheduling
9883 @cindex delay slots, defining
9884
9885 The insn attribute mechanism can be used to specify the requirements for
9886 delay slots, if any, on a target machine. An instruction is said to
9887 require a @dfn{delay slot} if some instructions that are physically
9888 after the instruction are executed as if they were located before it.
9889 Classic examples are branch and call instructions, which often execute
9890 the following instruction before the branch or call is performed.
9891
9892 On some machines, conditional branch instructions can optionally
9893 @dfn{annul} instructions in the delay slot. This means that the
9894 instruction will not be executed for certain branch outcomes. Both
9895 instructions that annul if the branch is true and instructions that
9896 annul if the branch is false are supported.
9897
9898 Delay slot scheduling differs from instruction scheduling in that
9899 determining whether an instruction needs a delay slot is dependent only
9900 on the type of instruction being generated, not on data flow between the
9901 instructions. See the next section for a discussion of data-dependent
9902 instruction scheduling.
9903
9904 @findex define_delay
9905 The requirement of an insn needing one or more delay slots is indicated
9906 via the @code{define_delay} expression. It has the following form:
9907
9908 @smallexample
9909 (define_delay @var{test}
9910 [@var{delay-1} @var{annul-true-1} @var{annul-false-1}
9911 @var{delay-2} @var{annul-true-2} @var{annul-false-2}
9912 @dots{}])
9913 @end smallexample
9914
9915 @var{test} is an attribute test that indicates whether this
9916 @code{define_delay} applies to a particular insn. If so, the number of
9917 required delay slots is determined by the length of the vector specified
9918 as the second argument. An insn placed in delay slot @var{n} must
9919 satisfy attribute test @var{delay-n}. @var{annul-true-n} is an
9920 attribute test that specifies which insns may be annulled if the branch
9921 is true. Similarly, @var{annul-false-n} specifies which insns in the
9922 delay slot may be annulled if the branch is false. If annulling is not
9923 supported for that delay slot, @code{(nil)} should be coded.
9924
9925 For example, in the common case where branch and call insns require
9926 a single delay slot, which may contain any insn other than a branch or
9927 call, the following would be placed in the @file{md} file:
9928
9929 @smallexample
9930 (define_delay (eq_attr "type" "branch,call")
9931 [(eq_attr "type" "!branch,call") (nil) (nil)])
9932 @end smallexample
9933
9934 Multiple @code{define_delay} expressions may be specified. In this
9935 case, each such expression specifies different delay slot requirements
9936 and there must be no insn for which tests in two @code{define_delay}
9937 expressions are both true.
9938
9939 For example, if we have a machine that requires one delay slot for branches
9940 but two for calls, no delay slot can contain a branch or call insn,
9941 and any valid insn in the delay slot for the branch can be annulled if the
9942 branch is true, we might represent this as follows:
9943
9944 @smallexample
9945 (define_delay (eq_attr "type" "branch")
9946 [(eq_attr "type" "!branch,call")
9947 (eq_attr "type" "!branch,call")
9948 (nil)])
9949
9950 (define_delay (eq_attr "type" "call")
9951 [(eq_attr "type" "!branch,call") (nil) (nil)
9952 (eq_attr "type" "!branch,call") (nil) (nil)])
9953 @end smallexample
9954 @c the above is *still* too long. --mew 4feb93
9955
9956 @end ifset
9957 @ifset INTERNALS
9958 @node Processor pipeline description
9959 @subsection Specifying processor pipeline description
9960 @cindex processor pipeline description
9961 @cindex processor functional units
9962 @cindex instruction latency time
9963 @cindex interlock delays
9964 @cindex data dependence delays
9965 @cindex reservation delays
9966 @cindex pipeline hazard recognizer
9967 @cindex automaton based pipeline description
9968 @cindex regular expressions
9969 @cindex deterministic finite state automaton
9970 @cindex automaton based scheduler
9971 @cindex RISC
9972 @cindex VLIW
9973
9974 To achieve better performance, most modern processors
9975 (super-pipelined, superscalar @acronym{RISC}, and @acronym{VLIW}
9976 processors) have many @dfn{functional units} on which several
9977 instructions can be executed simultaneously. An instruction starts
9978 execution if its issue conditions are satisfied. If not, the
9979 instruction is stalled until its conditions are satisfied. Such
9980 @dfn{interlock (pipeline) delay} causes interruption of the fetching
9981 of successor instructions (or demands nop instructions, e.g.@: for some
9982 MIPS processors).
9983
9984 There are two major kinds of interlock delays in modern processors.
9985 The first one is a data dependence delay determining @dfn{instruction
9986 latency time}. The instruction execution is not started until all
9987 source data have been evaluated by prior instructions (there are more
9988 complex cases when the instruction execution starts even when the data
9989 are not available but will be ready in given time after the
9990 instruction execution start). Taking the data dependence delays into
9991 account is simple. The data dependence (true, output, and
9992 anti-dependence) delay between two instructions is given by a
9993 constant. In most cases this approach is adequate. The second kind
9994 of interlock delays is a reservation delay. The reservation delay
9995 means that two instructions under execution will be in need of shared
9996 processors resources, i.e.@: buses, internal registers, and/or
9997 functional units, which are reserved for some time. Taking this kind
9998 of delay into account is complex especially for modern @acronym{RISC}
9999 processors.
10000
10001 The task of exploiting more processor parallelism is solved by an
10002 instruction scheduler. For a better solution to this problem, the
10003 instruction scheduler has to have an adequate description of the
10004 processor parallelism (or @dfn{pipeline description}). GCC
10005 machine descriptions describe processor parallelism and functional
10006 unit reservations for groups of instructions with the aid of
10007 @dfn{regular expressions}.
10008
10009 The GCC instruction scheduler uses a @dfn{pipeline hazard recognizer} to
10010 figure out the possibility of the instruction issue by the processor
10011 on a given simulated processor cycle. The pipeline hazard recognizer is
10012 automatically generated from the processor pipeline description. The
10013 pipeline hazard recognizer generated from the machine description
10014 is based on a deterministic finite state automaton (@acronym{DFA}):
10015 the instruction issue is possible if there is a transition from one
10016 automaton state to another one. This algorithm is very fast, and
10017 furthermore, its speed is not dependent on processor
10018 complexity@footnote{However, the size of the automaton depends on
10019 processor complexity. To limit this effect, machine descriptions
10020 can split orthogonal parts of the machine description among several
10021 automata: but then, since each of these must be stepped independently,
10022 this does cause a small decrease in the algorithm's performance.}.
10023
10024 @cindex automaton based pipeline description
10025 The rest of this section describes the directives that constitute
10026 an automaton-based processor pipeline description. The order of
10027 these constructions within the machine description file is not
10028 important.
10029
10030 @findex define_automaton
10031 @cindex pipeline hazard recognizer
10032 The following optional construction describes names of automata
10033 generated and used for the pipeline hazards recognition. Sometimes
10034 the generated finite state automaton used by the pipeline hazard
10035 recognizer is large. If we use more than one automaton and bind functional
10036 units to the automata, the total size of the automata is usually
10037 less than the size of the single automaton. If there is no one such
10038 construction, only one finite state automaton is generated.
10039
10040 @smallexample
10041 (define_automaton @var{automata-names})
10042 @end smallexample
10043
10044 @var{automata-names} is a string giving names of the automata. The
10045 names are separated by commas. All the automata should have unique names.
10046 The automaton name is used in the constructions @code{define_cpu_unit} and
10047 @code{define_query_cpu_unit}.
10048
10049 @findex define_cpu_unit
10050 @cindex processor functional units
10051 Each processor functional unit used in the description of instruction
10052 reservations should be described by the following construction.
10053
10054 @smallexample
10055 (define_cpu_unit @var{unit-names} [@var{automaton-name}])
10056 @end smallexample
10057
10058 @var{unit-names} is a string giving the names of the functional units
10059 separated by commas. Don't use name @samp{nothing}, it is reserved
10060 for other goals.
10061
10062 @var{automaton-name} is a string giving the name of the automaton with
10063 which the unit is bound. The automaton should be described in
10064 construction @code{define_automaton}. You should give
10065 @dfn{automaton-name}, if there is a defined automaton.
10066
10067 The assignment of units to automata are constrained by the uses of the
10068 units in insn reservations. The most important constraint is: if a
10069 unit reservation is present on a particular cycle of an alternative
10070 for an insn reservation, then some unit from the same automaton must
10071 be present on the same cycle for the other alternatives of the insn
10072 reservation. The rest of the constraints are mentioned in the
10073 description of the subsequent constructions.
10074
10075 @findex define_query_cpu_unit
10076 @cindex querying function unit reservations
10077 The following construction describes CPU functional units analogously
10078 to @code{define_cpu_unit}. The reservation of such units can be
10079 queried for an automaton state. The instruction scheduler never
10080 queries reservation of functional units for given automaton state. So
10081 as a rule, you don't need this construction. This construction could
10082 be used for future code generation goals (e.g.@: to generate
10083 @acronym{VLIW} insn templates).
10084
10085 @smallexample
10086 (define_query_cpu_unit @var{unit-names} [@var{automaton-name}])
10087 @end smallexample
10088
10089 @var{unit-names} is a string giving names of the functional units
10090 separated by commas.
10091
10092 @var{automaton-name} is a string giving the name of the automaton with
10093 which the unit is bound.
10094
10095 @findex define_insn_reservation
10096 @cindex instruction latency time
10097 @cindex regular expressions
10098 @cindex data bypass
10099 The following construction is the major one to describe pipeline
10100 characteristics of an instruction.
10101
10102 @smallexample
10103 (define_insn_reservation @var{insn-name} @var{default_latency}
10104 @var{condition} @var{regexp})
10105 @end smallexample
10106
10107 @var{default_latency} is a number giving latency time of the
10108 instruction. There is an important difference between the old
10109 description and the automaton based pipeline description. The latency
10110 time is used for all dependencies when we use the old description. In
10111 the automaton based pipeline description, the given latency time is only
10112 used for true dependencies. The cost of anti-dependencies is always
10113 zero and the cost of output dependencies is the difference between
10114 latency times of the producing and consuming insns (if the difference
10115 is negative, the cost is considered to be zero). You can always
10116 change the default costs for any description by using the target hook
10117 @code{TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST} (@pxref{Scheduling}).
10118
10119 @var{insn-name} is a string giving the internal name of the insn. The
10120 internal names are used in constructions @code{define_bypass} and in
10121 the automaton description file generated for debugging. The internal
10122 name has nothing in common with the names in @code{define_insn}. It is a
10123 good practice to use insn classes described in the processor manual.
10124
10125 @var{condition} defines what RTL insns are described by this
10126 construction. You should remember that you will be in trouble if
10127 @var{condition} for two or more different
10128 @code{define_insn_reservation} constructions is TRUE for an insn. In
10129 this case what reservation will be used for the insn is not defined.
10130 Such cases are not checked during generation of the pipeline hazards
10131 recognizer because in general recognizing that two conditions may have
10132 the same value is quite difficult (especially if the conditions
10133 contain @code{symbol_ref}). It is also not checked during the
10134 pipeline hazard recognizer work because it would slow down the
10135 recognizer considerably.
10136
10137 @var{regexp} is a string describing the reservation of the cpu's functional
10138 units by the instruction. The reservations are described by a regular
10139 expression according to the following syntax:
10140
10141 @smallexample
10142 regexp = regexp "," oneof
10143 | oneof
10144
10145 oneof = oneof "|" allof
10146 | allof
10147
10148 allof = allof "+" repeat
10149 | repeat
10150
10151 repeat = element "*" number
10152 | element
10153
10154 element = cpu_function_unit_name
10155 | reservation_name
10156 | result_name
10157 | "nothing"
10158 | "(" regexp ")"
10159 @end smallexample
10160
10161 @itemize @bullet
10162 @item
10163 @samp{,} is used for describing the start of the next cycle in
10164 the reservation.
10165
10166 @item
10167 @samp{|} is used for describing a reservation described by the first
10168 regular expression @strong{or} a reservation described by the second
10169 regular expression @strong{or} etc.
10170
10171 @item
10172 @samp{+} is used for describing a reservation described by the first
10173 regular expression @strong{and} a reservation described by the
10174 second regular expression @strong{and} etc.
10175
10176 @item
10177 @samp{*} is used for convenience and simply means a sequence in which
10178 the regular expression are repeated @var{number} times with cycle
10179 advancing (see @samp{,}).
10180
10181 @item
10182 @samp{cpu_function_unit_name} denotes reservation of the named
10183 functional unit.
10184
10185 @item
10186 @samp{reservation_name} --- see description of construction
10187 @samp{define_reservation}.
10188
10189 @item
10190 @samp{nothing} denotes no unit reservations.
10191 @end itemize
10192
10193 @findex define_reservation
10194 Sometimes unit reservations for different insns contain common parts.
10195 In such case, you can simplify the pipeline description by describing
10196 the common part by the following construction
10197
10198 @smallexample
10199 (define_reservation @var{reservation-name} @var{regexp})
10200 @end smallexample
10201
10202 @var{reservation-name} is a string giving name of @var{regexp}.
10203 Functional unit names and reservation names are in the same name
10204 space. So the reservation names should be different from the
10205 functional unit names and cannot be the reserved name @samp{nothing}.
10206
10207 @findex define_bypass
10208 @cindex instruction latency time
10209 @cindex data bypass
10210 The following construction is used to describe exceptions in the
10211 latency time for given instruction pair. This is so called bypasses.
10212
10213 @smallexample
10214 (define_bypass @var{number} @var{out_insn_names} @var{in_insn_names}
10215 [@var{guard}])
10216 @end smallexample
10217
10218 @var{number} defines when the result generated by the instructions
10219 given in string @var{out_insn_names} will be ready for the
10220 instructions given in string @var{in_insn_names}. Each of these
10221 strings is a comma-separated list of filename-style globs and
10222 they refer to the names of @code{define_insn_reservation}s.
10223 For example:
10224 @smallexample
10225 (define_bypass 1 "cpu1_load_*, cpu1_store_*" "cpu1_load_*")
10226 @end smallexample
10227 defines a bypass between instructions that start with
10228 @samp{cpu1_load_} or @samp{cpu1_store_} and those that start with
10229 @samp{cpu1_load_}.
10230
10231 @var{guard} is an optional string giving the name of a C function which
10232 defines an additional guard for the bypass. The function will get the
10233 two insns as parameters. If the function returns zero the bypass will
10234 be ignored for this case. The additional guard is necessary to
10235 recognize complicated bypasses, e.g.@: when the consumer is only an address
10236 of insn @samp{store} (not a stored value).
10237
10238 If there are more one bypass with the same output and input insns, the
10239 chosen bypass is the first bypass with a guard in description whose
10240 guard function returns nonzero. If there is no such bypass, then
10241 bypass without the guard function is chosen.
10242
10243 @findex exclusion_set
10244 @findex presence_set
10245 @findex final_presence_set
10246 @findex absence_set
10247 @findex final_absence_set
10248 @cindex VLIW
10249 @cindex RISC
10250 The following five constructions are usually used to describe
10251 @acronym{VLIW} processors, or more precisely, to describe a placement
10252 of small instructions into @acronym{VLIW} instruction slots. They
10253 can be used for @acronym{RISC} processors, too.
10254
10255 @smallexample
10256 (exclusion_set @var{unit-names} @var{unit-names})
10257 (presence_set @var{unit-names} @var{patterns})
10258 (final_presence_set @var{unit-names} @var{patterns})
10259 (absence_set @var{unit-names} @var{patterns})
10260 (final_absence_set @var{unit-names} @var{patterns})
10261 @end smallexample
10262
10263 @var{unit-names} is a string giving names of functional units
10264 separated by commas.
10265
10266 @var{patterns} is a string giving patterns of functional units
10267 separated by comma. Currently pattern is one unit or units
10268 separated by white-spaces.
10269
10270 The first construction (@samp{exclusion_set}) means that each
10271 functional unit in the first string cannot be reserved simultaneously
10272 with a unit whose name is in the second string and vice versa. For
10273 example, the construction is useful for describing processors
10274 (e.g.@: some SPARC processors) with a fully pipelined floating point
10275 functional unit which can execute simultaneously only single floating
10276 point insns or only double floating point insns.
10277
10278 The second construction (@samp{presence_set}) means that each
10279 functional unit in the first string cannot be reserved unless at
10280 least one of pattern of units whose names are in the second string is
10281 reserved. This is an asymmetric relation. For example, it is useful
10282 for description that @acronym{VLIW} @samp{slot1} is reserved after
10283 @samp{slot0} reservation. We could describe it by the following
10284 construction
10285
10286 @smallexample
10287 (presence_set "slot1" "slot0")
10288 @end smallexample
10289
10290 Or @samp{slot1} is reserved only after @samp{slot0} and unit @samp{b0}
10291 reservation. In this case we could write
10292
10293 @smallexample
10294 (presence_set "slot1" "slot0 b0")
10295 @end smallexample
10296
10297 The third construction (@samp{final_presence_set}) is analogous to
10298 @samp{presence_set}. The difference between them is when checking is
10299 done. When an instruction is issued in given automaton state
10300 reflecting all current and planned unit reservations, the automaton
10301 state is changed. The first state is a source state, the second one
10302 is a result state. Checking for @samp{presence_set} is done on the
10303 source state reservation, checking for @samp{final_presence_set} is
10304 done on the result reservation. This construction is useful to
10305 describe a reservation which is actually two subsequent reservations.
10306 For example, if we use
10307
10308 @smallexample
10309 (presence_set "slot1" "slot0")
10310 @end smallexample
10311
10312 the following insn will be never issued (because @samp{slot1} requires
10313 @samp{slot0} which is absent in the source state).
10314
10315 @smallexample
10316 (define_reservation "insn_and_nop" "slot0 + slot1")
10317 @end smallexample
10318
10319 but it can be issued if we use analogous @samp{final_presence_set}.
10320
10321 The forth construction (@samp{absence_set}) means that each functional
10322 unit in the first string can be reserved only if each pattern of units
10323 whose names are in the second string is not reserved. This is an
10324 asymmetric relation (actually @samp{exclusion_set} is analogous to
10325 this one but it is symmetric). For example it might be useful in a
10326 @acronym{VLIW} description to say that @samp{slot0} cannot be reserved
10327 after either @samp{slot1} or @samp{slot2} have been reserved. This
10328 can be described as:
10329
10330 @smallexample
10331 (absence_set "slot0" "slot1, slot2")
10332 @end smallexample
10333
10334 Or @samp{slot2} cannot be reserved if @samp{slot0} and unit @samp{b0}
10335 are reserved or @samp{slot1} and unit @samp{b1} are reserved. In
10336 this case we could write
10337
10338 @smallexample
10339 (absence_set "slot2" "slot0 b0, slot1 b1")
10340 @end smallexample
10341
10342 All functional units mentioned in a set should belong to the same
10343 automaton.
10344
10345 The last construction (@samp{final_absence_set}) is analogous to
10346 @samp{absence_set} but checking is done on the result (state)
10347 reservation. See comments for @samp{final_presence_set}.
10348
10349 @findex automata_option
10350 @cindex deterministic finite state automaton
10351 @cindex nondeterministic finite state automaton
10352 @cindex finite state automaton minimization
10353 You can control the generator of the pipeline hazard recognizer with
10354 the following construction.
10355
10356 @smallexample
10357 (automata_option @var{options})
10358 @end smallexample
10359
10360 @var{options} is a string giving options which affect the generated
10361 code. Currently there are the following options:
10362
10363 @itemize @bullet
10364 @item
10365 @dfn{no-minimization} makes no minimization of the automaton. This is
10366 only worth to do when we are debugging the description and need to
10367 look more accurately at reservations of states.
10368
10369 @item
10370 @dfn{time} means printing time statistics about the generation of
10371 automata.
10372
10373 @item
10374 @dfn{stats} means printing statistics about the generated automata
10375 such as the number of DFA states, NDFA states and arcs.
10376
10377 @item
10378 @dfn{v} means a generation of the file describing the result automata.
10379 The file has suffix @samp{.dfa} and can be used for the description
10380 verification and debugging.
10381
10382 @item
10383 @dfn{w} means a generation of warning instead of error for
10384 non-critical errors.
10385
10386 @item
10387 @dfn{no-comb-vect} prevents the automaton generator from generating
10388 two data structures and comparing them for space efficiency. Using
10389 a comb vector to represent transitions may be better, but it can be
10390 very expensive to construct. This option is useful if the build
10391 process spends an unacceptably long time in genautomata.
10392
10393 @item
10394 @dfn{ndfa} makes nondeterministic finite state automata. This affects
10395 the treatment of operator @samp{|} in the regular expressions. The
10396 usual treatment of the operator is to try the first alternative and,
10397 if the reservation is not possible, the second alternative. The
10398 nondeterministic treatment means trying all alternatives, some of them
10399 may be rejected by reservations in the subsequent insns.
10400
10401 @item
10402 @dfn{collapse-ndfa} modifies the behavior of the generator when
10403 producing an automaton. An additional state transition to collapse a
10404 nondeterministic @acronym{NDFA} state to a deterministic @acronym{DFA}
10405 state is generated. It can be triggered by passing @code{const0_rtx} to
10406 state_transition. In such an automaton, cycle advance transitions are
10407 available only for these collapsed states. This option is useful for
10408 ports that want to use the @code{ndfa} option, but also want to use
10409 @code{define_query_cpu_unit} to assign units to insns issued in a cycle.
10410
10411 @item
10412 @dfn{progress} means output of a progress bar showing how many states
10413 were generated so far for automaton being processed. This is useful
10414 during debugging a @acronym{DFA} description. If you see too many
10415 generated states, you could interrupt the generator of the pipeline
10416 hazard recognizer and try to figure out a reason for generation of the
10417 huge automaton.
10418 @end itemize
10419
10420 As an example, consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} machine which can
10421 issue three insns (two integer insns and one floating point insn) on
10422 the cycle but can finish only two insns. To describe this, we define
10423 the following functional units.
10424
10425 @smallexample
10426 (define_cpu_unit "i0_pipeline, i1_pipeline, f_pipeline")
10427 (define_cpu_unit "port0, port1")
10428 @end smallexample
10429
10430 All simple integer insns can be executed in any integer pipeline and
10431 their result is ready in two cycles. The simple integer insns are
10432 issued into the first pipeline unless it is reserved, otherwise they
10433 are issued into the second pipeline. Integer division and
10434 multiplication insns can be executed only in the second integer
10435 pipeline and their results are ready correspondingly in 9 and 4
10436 cycles. The integer division is not pipelined, i.e.@: the subsequent
10437 integer division insn cannot be issued until the current division
10438 insn finished. Floating point insns are fully pipelined and their
10439 results are ready in 3 cycles. Where the result of a floating point
10440 insn is used by an integer insn, an additional delay of one cycle is
10441 incurred. To describe all of this we could specify
10442
10443 @smallexample
10444 (define_cpu_unit "div")
10445
10446 (define_insn_reservation "simple" 2 (eq_attr "type" "int")
10447 "(i0_pipeline | i1_pipeline), (port0 | port1)")
10448
10449 (define_insn_reservation "mult" 4 (eq_attr "type" "mult")
10450 "i1_pipeline, nothing*2, (port0 | port1)")
10451
10452 (define_insn_reservation "div" 9 (eq_attr "type" "div")
10453 "i1_pipeline, div*7, div + (port0 | port1)")
10454
10455 (define_insn_reservation "float" 3 (eq_attr "type" "float")
10456 "f_pipeline, nothing, (port0 | port1))
10457
10458 (define_bypass 4 "float" "simple,mult,div")
10459 @end smallexample
10460
10461 To simplify the description we could describe the following reservation
10462
10463 @smallexample
10464 (define_reservation "finish" "port0|port1")
10465 @end smallexample
10466
10467 and use it in all @code{define_insn_reservation} as in the following
10468 construction
10469
10470 @smallexample
10471 (define_insn_reservation "simple" 2 (eq_attr "type" "int")
10472 "(i0_pipeline | i1_pipeline), finish")
10473 @end smallexample
10474
10475
10476 @end ifset
10477 @ifset INTERNALS
10478 @node Conditional Execution
10479 @section Conditional Execution
10480 @cindex conditional execution
10481 @cindex predication
10482
10483 A number of architectures provide for some form of conditional
10484 execution, or predication. The hallmark of this feature is the
10485 ability to nullify most of the instructions in the instruction set.
10486 When the instruction set is large and not entirely symmetric, it
10487 can be quite tedious to describe these forms directly in the
10488 @file{.md} file. An alternative is the @code{define_cond_exec} template.
10489
10490 @findex define_cond_exec
10491 @smallexample
10492 (define_cond_exec
10493 [@var{predicate-pattern}]
10494 "@var{condition}"
10495 "@var{output-template}"
10496 "@var{optional-insn-attribues}")
10497 @end smallexample
10498
10499 @var{predicate-pattern} is the condition that must be true for the
10500 insn to be executed at runtime and should match a relational operator.
10501 One can use @code{match_operator} to match several relational operators
10502 at once. Any @code{match_operand} operands must have no more than one
10503 alternative.
10504
10505 @var{condition} is a C expression that must be true for the generated
10506 pattern to match.
10507
10508 @findex current_insn_predicate
10509 @var{output-template} is a string similar to the @code{define_insn}
10510 output template (@pxref{Output Template}), except that the @samp{*}
10511 and @samp{@@} special cases do not apply. This is only useful if the
10512 assembly text for the predicate is a simple prefix to the main insn.
10513 In order to handle the general case, there is a global variable
10514 @code{current_insn_predicate} that will contain the entire predicate
10515 if the current insn is predicated, and will otherwise be @code{NULL}.
10516
10517 @var{optional-insn-attributes} is an optional vector of attributes that gets
10518 appended to the insn attributes of the produced cond_exec rtx. It can
10519 be used to add some distinguishing attribute to cond_exec rtxs produced
10520 that way. An example usage would be to use this attribute in conjunction
10521 with attributes on the main pattern to disable particular alternatives under
10522 certain conditions.
10523
10524 When @code{define_cond_exec} is used, an implicit reference to
10525 the @code{predicable} instruction attribute is made.
10526 @xref{Insn Attributes}. This attribute must be a boolean (i.e.@: have
10527 exactly two elements in its @var{list-of-values}), with the possible
10528 values being @code{no} and @code{yes}. The default and all uses in
10529 the insns must be a simple constant, not a complex expressions. It
10530 may, however, depend on the alternative, by using a comma-separated
10531 list of values. If that is the case, the port should also define an
10532 @code{enabled} attribute (@pxref{Disable Insn Alternatives}), which
10533 should also allow only @code{no} and @code{yes} as its values.
10534
10535 For each @code{define_insn} for which the @code{predicable}
10536 attribute is true, a new @code{define_insn} pattern will be
10537 generated that matches a predicated version of the instruction.
10538 For example,
10539
10540 @smallexample
10541 (define_insn "addsi"
10542 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "r")
10543 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "register_operand" "r")
10544 (match_operand:SI 2 "register_operand" "r")))]
10545 "@var{test1}"
10546 "add %2,%1,%0")
10547
10548 (define_cond_exec
10549 [(ne (match_operand:CC 0 "register_operand" "c")
10550 (const_int 0))]
10551 "@var{test2}"
10552 "(%0)")
10553 @end smallexample
10554
10555 @noindent
10556 generates a new pattern
10557
10558 @smallexample
10559 (define_insn ""
10560 [(cond_exec
10561 (ne (match_operand:CC 3 "register_operand" "c") (const_int 0))
10562 (set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "r")
10563 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "register_operand" "r")
10564 (match_operand:SI 2 "register_operand" "r"))))]
10565 "(@var{test2}) && (@var{test1})"
10566 "(%3) add %2,%1,%0")
10567 @end smallexample
10568
10569 @end ifset
10570 @ifset INTERNALS
10571 @node Define Subst
10572 @section RTL Templates Transformations
10573 @cindex define_subst
10574
10575 For some hardware architectures there are common cases when the RTL
10576 templates for the instructions can be derived from the other RTL
10577 templates using simple transformations. E.g., @file{i386.md} contains
10578 an RTL template for the ordinary @code{sub} instruction---
10579 @code{*subsi_1}, and for the @code{sub} instruction with subsequent
10580 zero-extension---@code{*subsi_1_zext}. Such cases can be easily
10581 implemented by a single meta-template capable of generating a modified
10582 case based on the initial one:
10583
10584 @findex define_subst
10585 @smallexample
10586 (define_subst "@var{name}"
10587 [@var{input-template}]
10588 "@var{condition}"
10589 [@var{output-template}])
10590 @end smallexample
10591 @var{input-template} is a pattern describing the source RTL template,
10592 which will be transformed.
10593
10594 @var{condition} is a C expression that is conjunct with the condition
10595 from the input-template to generate a condition to be used in the
10596 output-template.
10597
10598 @var{output-template} is a pattern that will be used in the resulting
10599 template.
10600
10601 @code{define_subst} mechanism is tightly coupled with the notion of the
10602 subst attribute (@pxref{Subst Iterators}). The use of
10603 @code{define_subst} is triggered by a reference to a subst attribute in
10604 the transforming RTL template. This reference initiates duplication of
10605 the source RTL template and substitution of the attributes with their
10606 values. The source RTL template is left unchanged, while the copy is
10607 transformed by @code{define_subst}. This transformation can fail in the
10608 case when the source RTL template is not matched against the
10609 input-template of the @code{define_subst}. In such case the copy is
10610 deleted.
10611
10612 @code{define_subst} can be used only in @code{define_insn} and
10613 @code{define_expand}, it cannot be used in other expressions (e.g.@: in
10614 @code{define_insn_and_split}).
10615
10616 @menu
10617 * Define Subst Example:: Example of @code{define_subst} work.
10618 * Define Subst Pattern Matching:: Process of template comparison.
10619 * Define Subst Output Template:: Generation of output template.
10620 @end menu
10621
10622 @node Define Subst Example
10623 @subsection @code{define_subst} Example
10624 @cindex define_subst
10625
10626 To illustrate how @code{define_subst} works, let us examine a simple
10627 template transformation.
10628
10629 Suppose there are two kinds of instructions: one that touches flags and
10630 the other that does not. The instructions of the second type could be
10631 generated with the following @code{define_subst}:
10632
10633 @smallexample
10634 (define_subst "add_clobber_subst"
10635 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "" "")
10636 (match_operand:SI 1 "" ""))]
10637 ""
10638 [(set (match_dup 0)
10639 (match_dup 1))
10640 (clobber (reg:CC FLAGS_REG))])
10641 @end smallexample
10642
10643 This @code{define_subst} can be applied to any RTL pattern containing
10644 @code{set} of mode SI and generates a copy with clobber when it is
10645 applied.
10646
10647 Assume there is an RTL template for a @code{max} instruction to be used
10648 in @code{define_subst} mentioned above:
10649
10650 @smallexample
10651 (define_insn "maxsi"
10652 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "=r")
10653 (max:SI
10654 (match_operand:SI 1 "register_operand" "r")
10655 (match_operand:SI 2 "register_operand" "r")))]
10656 ""
10657 "max\t@{%2, %1, %0|%0, %1, %2@}"
10658 [@dots{}])
10659 @end smallexample
10660
10661 To mark the RTL template for @code{define_subst} application,
10662 subst-attributes are used. They should be declared in advance:
10663
10664 @smallexample
10665 (define_subst_attr "add_clobber_name" "add_clobber_subst" "_noclobber" "_clobber")
10666 @end smallexample
10667
10668 Here @samp{add_clobber_name} is the attribute name,
10669 @samp{add_clobber_subst} is the name of the corresponding
10670 @code{define_subst}, the third argument (@samp{_noclobber}) is the
10671 attribute value that would be substituted into the unchanged version of
10672 the source RTL template, and the last argument (@samp{_clobber}) is the
10673 value that would be substituted into the second, transformed,
10674 version of the RTL template.
10675
10676 Once the subst-attribute has been defined, it should be used in RTL
10677 templates which need to be processed by the @code{define_subst}. So,
10678 the original RTL template should be changed:
10679
10680 @smallexample
10681 (define_insn "maxsi<add_clobber_name>"
10682 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "=r")
10683 (max:SI
10684 (match_operand:SI 1 "register_operand" "r")
10685 (match_operand:SI 2 "register_operand" "r")))]
10686 ""
10687 "max\t@{%2, %1, %0|%0, %1, %2@}"
10688 [@dots{}])
10689 @end smallexample
10690
10691 The result of the @code{define_subst} usage would look like the following:
10692
10693 @smallexample
10694 (define_insn "maxsi_noclobber"
10695 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "=r")
10696 (max:SI
10697 (match_operand:SI 1 "register_operand" "r")
10698 (match_operand:SI 2 "register_operand" "r")))]
10699 ""
10700 "max\t@{%2, %1, %0|%0, %1, %2@}"
10701 [@dots{}])
10702 (define_insn "maxsi_clobber"
10703 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "=r")
10704 (max:SI
10705 (match_operand:SI 1 "register_operand" "r")
10706 (match_operand:SI 2 "register_operand" "r")))
10707 (clobber (reg:CC FLAGS_REG))]
10708 ""
10709 "max\t@{%2, %1, %0|%0, %1, %2@}"
10710 [@dots{}])
10711 @end smallexample
10712
10713 @node Define Subst Pattern Matching
10714 @subsection Pattern Matching in @code{define_subst}
10715 @cindex define_subst
10716
10717 All expressions, allowed in @code{define_insn} or @code{define_expand},
10718 are allowed in the input-template of @code{define_subst}, except
10719 @code{match_par_dup}, @code{match_scratch}, @code{match_parallel}. The
10720 meanings of expressions in the input-template were changed:
10721
10722 @code{match_operand} matches any expression (possibly, a subtree in
10723 RTL-template), if modes of the @code{match_operand} and this expression
10724 are the same, or mode of the @code{match_operand} is @code{VOIDmode}, or
10725 this expression is @code{match_dup}, @code{match_op_dup}. If the
10726 expression is @code{match_operand} too, and predicate of
10727 @code{match_operand} from the input pattern is not empty, then the
10728 predicates are compared. That can be used for more accurate filtering
10729 of accepted RTL-templates.
10730
10731 @code{match_operator} matches common operators (like @code{plus},
10732 @code{minus}), @code{unspec}, @code{unspec_volatile} operators and
10733 @code{match_operator}s from the original pattern if the modes match and
10734 @code{match_operator} from the input pattern has the same number of
10735 operands as the operator from the original pattern.
10736
10737 @node Define Subst Output Template
10738 @subsection Generation of output template in @code{define_subst}
10739 @cindex define_subst
10740
10741 If all necessary checks for @code{define_subst} application pass, a new
10742 RTL-pattern, based on the output-template, is created to replace the old
10743 template. Like in input-patterns, meanings of some RTL expressions are
10744 changed when they are used in output-patterns of a @code{define_subst}.
10745 Thus, @code{match_dup} is used for copying the whole expression from the
10746 original pattern, which matched corresponding @code{match_operand} from
10747 the input pattern.
10748
10749 @code{match_dup N} is used in the output template to be replaced with
10750 the expression from the original pattern, which matched
10751 @code{match_operand N} from the input pattern. As a consequence,
10752 @code{match_dup} cannot be used to point to @code{match_operand}s from
10753 the output pattern, it should always refer to a @code{match_operand}
10754 from the input pattern. If a @code{match_dup N} occurs more than once
10755 in the output template, its first occurrence is replaced with the
10756 expression from the original pattern, and the subsequent expressions
10757 are replaced with @code{match_dup N}, i.e., a reference to the first
10758 expression.
10759
10760 In the output template one can refer to the expressions from the
10761 original pattern and create new ones. For instance, some operands could
10762 be added by means of standard @code{match_operand}.
10763
10764 After replacing @code{match_dup} with some RTL-subtree from the original
10765 pattern, it could happen that several @code{match_operand}s in the
10766 output pattern have the same indexes. It is unknown, how many and what
10767 indexes would be used in the expression which would replace
10768 @code{match_dup}, so such conflicts in indexes are inevitable. To
10769 overcome this issue, @code{match_operands} and @code{match_operators},
10770 which were introduced into the output pattern, are renumerated when all
10771 @code{match_dup}s are replaced.
10772
10773 Number of alternatives in @code{match_operand}s introduced into the
10774 output template @code{M} could differ from the number of alternatives in
10775 the original pattern @code{N}, so in the resultant pattern there would
10776 be @code{N*M} alternatives. Thus, constraints from the original pattern
10777 would be duplicated @code{N} times, constraints from the output pattern
10778 would be duplicated @code{M} times, producing all possible combinations.
10779 @end ifset
10780
10781 @ifset INTERNALS
10782 @node Constant Definitions
10783 @section Constant Definitions
10784 @cindex constant definitions
10785 @findex define_constants
10786
10787 Using literal constants inside instruction patterns reduces legibility and
10788 can be a maintenance problem.
10789
10790 To overcome this problem, you may use the @code{define_constants}
10791 expression. It contains a vector of name-value pairs. From that
10792 point on, wherever any of the names appears in the MD file, it is as
10793 if the corresponding value had been written instead. You may use
10794 @code{define_constants} multiple times; each appearance adds more
10795 constants to the table. It is an error to redefine a constant with
10796 a different value.
10797
10798 To come back to the a29k load multiple example, instead of
10799
10800 @smallexample
10801 (define_insn ""
10802 [(match_parallel 0 "load_multiple_operation"
10803 [(set (match_operand:SI 1 "gpc_reg_operand" "=r")
10804 (match_operand:SI 2 "memory_operand" "m"))
10805 (use (reg:SI 179))
10806 (clobber (reg:SI 179))])]
10807 ""
10808 "loadm 0,0,%1,%2")
10809 @end smallexample
10810
10811 You could write:
10812
10813 @smallexample
10814 (define_constants [
10815 (R_BP 177)
10816 (R_FC 178)
10817 (R_CR 179)
10818 (R_Q 180)
10819 ])
10820
10821 (define_insn ""
10822 [(match_parallel 0 "load_multiple_operation"
10823 [(set (match_operand:SI 1 "gpc_reg_operand" "=r")
10824 (match_operand:SI 2 "memory_operand" "m"))
10825 (use (reg:SI R_CR))
10826 (clobber (reg:SI R_CR))])]
10827 ""
10828 "loadm 0,0,%1,%2")
10829 @end smallexample
10830
10831 The constants that are defined with a define_constant are also output
10832 in the insn-codes.h header file as #defines.
10833
10834 @cindex enumerations
10835 @findex define_c_enum
10836 You can also use the machine description file to define enumerations.
10837 Like the constants defined by @code{define_constant}, these enumerations
10838 are visible to both the machine description file and the main C code.
10839
10840 The syntax is as follows:
10841
10842 @smallexample
10843 (define_c_enum "@var{name}" [
10844 @var{value0}
10845 @var{value1}
10846 @dots{}
10847 @var{valuen}
10848 ])
10849 @end smallexample
10850
10851 This definition causes the equivalent of the following C code to appear
10852 in @file{insn-constants.h}:
10853
10854 @smallexample
10855 enum @var{name} @{
10856 @var{value0} = 0,
10857 @var{value1} = 1,
10858 @dots{}
10859 @var{valuen} = @var{n}
10860 @};
10861 #define NUM_@var{cname}_VALUES (@var{n} + 1)
10862 @end smallexample
10863
10864 where @var{cname} is the capitalized form of @var{name}.
10865 It also makes each @var{valuei} available in the machine description
10866 file, just as if it had been declared with:
10867
10868 @smallexample
10869 (define_constants [(@var{valuei} @var{i})])
10870 @end smallexample
10871
10872 Each @var{valuei} is usually an upper-case identifier and usually
10873 begins with @var{cname}.
10874
10875 You can split the enumeration definition into as many statements as
10876 you like. The above example is directly equivalent to:
10877
10878 @smallexample
10879 (define_c_enum "@var{name}" [@var{value0}])
10880 (define_c_enum "@var{name}" [@var{value1}])
10881 @dots{}
10882 (define_c_enum "@var{name}" [@var{valuen}])
10883 @end smallexample
10884
10885 Splitting the enumeration helps to improve the modularity of each
10886 individual @code{.md} file. For example, if a port defines its
10887 synchronization instructions in a separate @file{sync.md} file,
10888 it is convenient to define all synchronization-specific enumeration
10889 values in @file{sync.md} rather than in the main @file{.md} file.
10890
10891 Some enumeration names have special significance to GCC:
10892
10893 @table @code
10894 @item unspecv
10895 @findex unspec_volatile
10896 If an enumeration called @code{unspecv} is defined, GCC will use it
10897 when printing out @code{unspec_volatile} expressions. For example:
10898
10899 @smallexample
10900 (define_c_enum "unspecv" [
10901 UNSPECV_BLOCKAGE
10902 ])
10903 @end smallexample
10904
10905 causes GCC to print @samp{(unspec_volatile @dots{} 0)} as:
10906
10907 @smallexample
10908 (unspec_volatile ... UNSPECV_BLOCKAGE)
10909 @end smallexample
10910
10911 @item unspec
10912 @findex unspec
10913 If an enumeration called @code{unspec} is defined, GCC will use
10914 it when printing out @code{unspec} expressions. GCC will also use
10915 it when printing out @code{unspec_volatile} expressions unless an
10916 @code{unspecv} enumeration is also defined. You can therefore
10917 decide whether to keep separate enumerations for volatile and
10918 non-volatile expressions or whether to use the same enumeration
10919 for both.
10920 @end table
10921
10922 @findex define_enum
10923 @anchor{define_enum}
10924 Another way of defining an enumeration is to use @code{define_enum}:
10925
10926 @smallexample
10927 (define_enum "@var{name}" [
10928 @var{value0}
10929 @var{value1}
10930 @dots{}
10931 @var{valuen}
10932 ])
10933 @end smallexample
10934
10935 This directive implies:
10936
10937 @smallexample
10938 (define_c_enum "@var{name}" [
10939 @var{cname}_@var{cvalue0}
10940 @var{cname}_@var{cvalue1}
10941 @dots{}
10942 @var{cname}_@var{cvaluen}
10943 ])
10944 @end smallexample
10945
10946 @findex define_enum_attr
10947 where @var{cvaluei} is the capitalized form of @var{valuei}.
10948 However, unlike @code{define_c_enum}, the enumerations defined
10949 by @code{define_enum} can be used in attribute specifications
10950 (@pxref{define_enum_attr}).
10951 @end ifset
10952 @ifset INTERNALS
10953 @node Iterators
10954 @section Iterators
10955 @cindex iterators in @file{.md} files
10956
10957 Ports often need to define similar patterns for more than one machine
10958 mode or for more than one rtx code. GCC provides some simple iterator
10959 facilities to make this process easier.
10960
10961 @menu
10962 * Mode Iterators:: Generating variations of patterns for different modes.
10963 * Code Iterators:: Doing the same for codes.
10964 * Int Iterators:: Doing the same for integers.
10965 * Subst Iterators:: Generating variations of patterns for define_subst.
10966 * Parameterized Names:: Specifying iterator values in C++ code.
10967 @end menu
10968
10969 @node Mode Iterators
10970 @subsection Mode Iterators
10971 @cindex mode iterators in @file{.md} files
10972
10973 Ports often need to define similar patterns for two or more different modes.
10974 For example:
10975
10976 @itemize @bullet
10977 @item
10978 If a processor has hardware support for both single and double
10979 floating-point arithmetic, the @code{SFmode} patterns tend to be
10980 very similar to the @code{DFmode} ones.
10981
10982 @item
10983 If a port uses @code{SImode} pointers in one configuration and
10984 @code{DImode} pointers in another, it will usually have very similar
10985 @code{SImode} and @code{DImode} patterns for manipulating pointers.
10986 @end itemize
10987
10988 Mode iterators allow several patterns to be instantiated from one
10989 @file{.md} file template. They can be used with any type of
10990 rtx-based construct, such as a @code{define_insn},
10991 @code{define_split}, or @code{define_peephole2}.
10992
10993 @menu
10994 * Defining Mode Iterators:: Defining a new mode iterator.
10995 * Substitutions:: Combining mode iterators with substitutions
10996 * Examples:: Examples
10997 @end menu
10998
10999 @node Defining Mode Iterators
11000 @subsubsection Defining Mode Iterators
11001 @findex define_mode_iterator
11002
11003 The syntax for defining a mode iterator is:
11004
11005 @smallexample
11006 (define_mode_iterator @var{name} [(@var{mode1} "@var{cond1}") @dots{} (@var{moden} "@var{condn}")])
11007 @end smallexample
11008
11009 This allows subsequent @file{.md} file constructs to use the mode suffix
11010 @code{:@var{name}}. Every construct that does so will be expanded
11011 @var{n} times, once with every use of @code{:@var{name}} replaced by
11012 @code{:@var{mode1}}, once with every use replaced by @code{:@var{mode2}},
11013 and so on. In the expansion for a particular @var{modei}, every
11014 C condition will also require that @var{condi} be true.
11015
11016 For example:
11017
11018 @smallexample
11019 (define_mode_iterator P [(SI "Pmode == SImode") (DI "Pmode == DImode")])
11020 @end smallexample
11021
11022 defines a new mode suffix @code{:P}. Every construct that uses
11023 @code{:P} will be expanded twice, once with every @code{:P} replaced
11024 by @code{:SI} and once with every @code{:P} replaced by @code{:DI}.
11025 The @code{:SI} version will only apply if @code{Pmode == SImode} and
11026 the @code{:DI} version will only apply if @code{Pmode == DImode}.
11027
11028 As with other @file{.md} conditions, an empty string is treated
11029 as ``always true''. @code{(@var{mode} "")} can also be abbreviated
11030 to @code{@var{mode}}. For example:
11031
11032 @smallexample
11033 (define_mode_iterator GPR [SI (DI "TARGET_64BIT")])
11034 @end smallexample
11035
11036 means that the @code{:DI} expansion only applies if @code{TARGET_64BIT}
11037 but that the @code{:SI} expansion has no such constraint.
11038
11039 Iterators are applied in the order they are defined. This can be
11040 significant if two iterators are used in a construct that requires
11041 substitutions. @xref{Substitutions}.
11042
11043 @node Substitutions
11044 @subsubsection Substitution in Mode Iterators
11045 @findex define_mode_attr
11046
11047 If an @file{.md} file construct uses mode iterators, each version of the
11048 construct will often need slightly different strings or modes. For
11049 example:
11050
11051 @itemize @bullet
11052 @item
11053 When a @code{define_expand} defines several @code{add@var{m}3} patterns
11054 (@pxref{Standard Names}), each expander will need to use the
11055 appropriate mode name for @var{m}.
11056
11057 @item
11058 When a @code{define_insn} defines several instruction patterns,
11059 each instruction will often use a different assembler mnemonic.
11060
11061 @item
11062 When a @code{define_insn} requires operands with different modes,
11063 using an iterator for one of the operand modes usually requires a specific
11064 mode for the other operand(s).
11065 @end itemize
11066
11067 GCC supports such variations through a system of ``mode attributes''.
11068 There are two standard attributes: @code{mode}, which is the name of
11069 the mode in lower case, and @code{MODE}, which is the same thing in
11070 upper case. You can define other attributes using:
11071
11072 @smallexample
11073 (define_mode_attr @var{name} [(@var{mode1} "@var{value1}") @dots{} (@var{moden} "@var{valuen}")])
11074 @end smallexample
11075
11076 where @var{name} is the name of the attribute and @var{valuei}
11077 is the value associated with @var{modei}.
11078
11079 When GCC replaces some @var{:iterator} with @var{:mode}, it will scan
11080 each string and mode in the pattern for sequences of the form
11081 @code{<@var{iterator}:@var{attr}>}, where @var{attr} is the name of a
11082 mode attribute. If the attribute is defined for @var{mode}, the whole
11083 @code{<@dots{}>} sequence will be replaced by the appropriate attribute
11084 value.
11085
11086 For example, suppose an @file{.md} file has:
11087
11088 @smallexample
11089 (define_mode_iterator P [(SI "Pmode == SImode") (DI "Pmode == DImode")])
11090 (define_mode_attr load [(SI "lw") (DI "ld")])
11091 @end smallexample
11092
11093 If one of the patterns that uses @code{:P} contains the string
11094 @code{"<P:load>\t%0,%1"}, the @code{SI} version of that pattern
11095 will use @code{"lw\t%0,%1"} and the @code{DI} version will use
11096 @code{"ld\t%0,%1"}.
11097
11098 Here is an example of using an attribute for a mode:
11099
11100 @smallexample
11101 (define_mode_iterator LONG [SI DI])
11102 (define_mode_attr SHORT [(SI "HI") (DI "SI")])
11103 (define_insn @dots{}
11104 (sign_extend:LONG (match_operand:<LONG:SHORT> @dots{})) @dots{})
11105 @end smallexample
11106
11107 The @code{@var{iterator}:} prefix may be omitted, in which case the
11108 substitution will be attempted for every iterator expansion.
11109
11110 @node Examples
11111 @subsubsection Mode Iterator Examples
11112
11113 Here is an example from the MIPS port. It defines the following
11114 modes and attributes (among others):
11115
11116 @smallexample
11117 (define_mode_iterator GPR [SI (DI "TARGET_64BIT")])
11118 (define_mode_attr d [(SI "") (DI "d")])
11119 @end smallexample
11120
11121 and uses the following template to define both @code{subsi3}
11122 and @code{subdi3}:
11123
11124 @smallexample
11125 (define_insn "sub<mode>3"
11126 [(set (match_operand:GPR 0 "register_operand" "=d")
11127 (minus:GPR (match_operand:GPR 1 "register_operand" "d")
11128 (match_operand:GPR 2 "register_operand" "d")))]
11129 ""
11130 "<d>subu\t%0,%1,%2"
11131 [(set_attr "type" "arith")
11132 (set_attr "mode" "<MODE>")])
11133 @end smallexample
11134
11135 This is exactly equivalent to:
11136
11137 @smallexample
11138 (define_insn "subsi3"
11139 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "=d")
11140 (minus:SI (match_operand:SI 1 "register_operand" "d")
11141 (match_operand:SI 2 "register_operand" "d")))]
11142 ""
11143 "subu\t%0,%1,%2"
11144 [(set_attr "type" "arith")
11145 (set_attr "mode" "SI")])
11146
11147 (define_insn "subdi3"
11148 [(set (match_operand:DI 0 "register_operand" "=d")
11149 (minus:DI (match_operand:DI 1 "register_operand" "d")
11150 (match_operand:DI 2 "register_operand" "d")))]
11151 ""
11152 "dsubu\t%0,%1,%2"
11153 [(set_attr "type" "arith")
11154 (set_attr "mode" "DI")])
11155 @end smallexample
11156
11157 @node Code Iterators
11158 @subsection Code Iterators
11159 @cindex code iterators in @file{.md} files
11160 @findex define_code_iterator
11161 @findex define_code_attr
11162
11163 Code iterators operate in a similar way to mode iterators. @xref{Mode Iterators}.
11164
11165 The construct:
11166
11167 @smallexample
11168 (define_code_iterator @var{name} [(@var{code1} "@var{cond1}") @dots{} (@var{coden} "@var{condn}")])
11169 @end smallexample
11170
11171 defines a pseudo rtx code @var{name} that can be instantiated as
11172 @var{codei} if condition @var{condi} is true. Each @var{codei}
11173 must have the same rtx format. @xref{RTL Classes}.
11174
11175 As with mode iterators, each pattern that uses @var{name} will be
11176 expanded @var{n} times, once with all uses of @var{name} replaced by
11177 @var{code1}, once with all uses replaced by @var{code2}, and so on.
11178 @xref{Defining Mode Iterators}.
11179
11180 It is possible to define attributes for codes as well as for modes.
11181 There are two standard code attributes: @code{code}, the name of the
11182 code in lower case, and @code{CODE}, the name of the code in upper case.
11183 Other attributes are defined using:
11184
11185 @smallexample
11186 (define_code_attr @var{name} [(@var{code1} "@var{value1}") @dots{} (@var{coden} "@var{valuen}")])
11187 @end smallexample
11188
11189 Instruction patterns can use code attributes as rtx codes, which can be
11190 useful if two sets of codes act in tandem. For example, the following
11191 @code{define_insn} defines two patterns, one calculating a signed absolute
11192 difference and another calculating an unsigned absolute difference:
11193
11194 @smallexample
11195 (define_code_iterator any_max [smax umax])
11196 (define_code_attr paired_min [(smax "smin") (umax "umin")])
11197 (define_insn @dots{}
11198 [(set (match_operand:SI 0 @dots{})
11199 (minus:SI (any_max:SI (match_operand:SI 1 @dots{})
11200 (match_operand:SI 2 @dots{}))
11201 (<paired_min>:SI (match_dup 1) (match_dup 2))))]
11202 @dots{})
11203 @end smallexample
11204
11205 The signed version of the instruction uses @code{smax} and @code{smin}
11206 while the unsigned version uses @code{umax} and @code{umin}. There
11207 are no versions that pair @code{smax} with @code{umin} or @code{umax}
11208 with @code{smin}.
11209
11210 Here's an example of code iterators in action, taken from the MIPS port:
11211
11212 @smallexample
11213 (define_code_iterator any_cond [unordered ordered unlt unge uneq ltgt unle ungt
11214 eq ne gt ge lt le gtu geu ltu leu])
11215
11216 (define_expand "b<code>"
11217 [(set (pc)
11218 (if_then_else (any_cond:CC (cc0)
11219 (const_int 0))
11220 (label_ref (match_operand 0 ""))
11221 (pc)))]
11222 ""
11223 @{
11224 gen_conditional_branch (operands, <CODE>);
11225 DONE;
11226 @})
11227 @end smallexample
11228
11229 This is equivalent to:
11230
11231 @smallexample
11232 (define_expand "bunordered"
11233 [(set (pc)
11234 (if_then_else (unordered:CC (cc0)
11235 (const_int 0))
11236 (label_ref (match_operand 0 ""))
11237 (pc)))]
11238 ""
11239 @{
11240 gen_conditional_branch (operands, UNORDERED);
11241 DONE;
11242 @})
11243
11244 (define_expand "bordered"
11245 [(set (pc)
11246 (if_then_else (ordered:CC (cc0)
11247 (const_int 0))
11248 (label_ref (match_operand 0 ""))
11249 (pc)))]
11250 ""
11251 @{
11252 gen_conditional_branch (operands, ORDERED);
11253 DONE;
11254 @})
11255
11256 @dots{}
11257 @end smallexample
11258
11259 @node Int Iterators
11260 @subsection Int Iterators
11261 @cindex int iterators in @file{.md} files
11262 @findex define_int_iterator
11263 @findex define_int_attr
11264
11265 Int iterators operate in a similar way to code iterators. @xref{Code Iterators}.
11266
11267 The construct:
11268
11269 @smallexample
11270 (define_int_iterator @var{name} [(@var{int1} "@var{cond1}") @dots{} (@var{intn} "@var{condn}")])
11271 @end smallexample
11272
11273 defines a pseudo integer constant @var{name} that can be instantiated as
11274 @var{inti} if condition @var{condi} is true. Each @var{int} must have the
11275 same rtx format. @xref{RTL Classes}. Int iterators can appear in only
11276 those rtx fields that have 'i', 'n', 'w', or 'p' as the specifier. This
11277 means that each @var{int} has to be a constant defined using define_constant
11278 or define_c_enum.
11279
11280 As with mode and code iterators, each pattern that uses @var{name} will be
11281 expanded @var{n} times, once with all uses of @var{name} replaced by
11282 @var{int1}, once with all uses replaced by @var{int2}, and so on.
11283 @xref{Defining Mode Iterators}.
11284
11285 It is possible to define attributes for ints as well as for codes and modes.
11286 Attributes are defined using:
11287
11288 @smallexample
11289 (define_int_attr @var{name} [(@var{int1} "@var{value1}") @dots{} (@var{intn} "@var{valuen}")])
11290 @end smallexample
11291
11292 Here's an example of int iterators in action, taken from the ARM port:
11293
11294 @smallexample
11295 (define_int_iterator QABSNEG [UNSPEC_VQABS UNSPEC_VQNEG])
11296
11297 (define_int_attr absneg [(UNSPEC_VQABS "abs") (UNSPEC_VQNEG "neg")])
11298
11299 (define_insn "neon_vq<absneg><mode>"
11300 [(set (match_operand:VDQIW 0 "s_register_operand" "=w")
11301 (unspec:VDQIW [(match_operand:VDQIW 1 "s_register_operand" "w")
11302 (match_operand:SI 2 "immediate_operand" "i")]
11303 QABSNEG))]
11304 "TARGET_NEON"
11305 "vq<absneg>.<V_s_elem>\t%<V_reg>0, %<V_reg>1"
11306 [(set_attr "type" "neon_vqneg_vqabs")]
11307 )
11308
11309 @end smallexample
11310
11311 This is equivalent to:
11312
11313 @smallexample
11314 (define_insn "neon_vqabs<mode>"
11315 [(set (match_operand:VDQIW 0 "s_register_operand" "=w")
11316 (unspec:VDQIW [(match_operand:VDQIW 1 "s_register_operand" "w")
11317 (match_operand:SI 2 "immediate_operand" "i")]
11318 UNSPEC_VQABS))]
11319 "TARGET_NEON"
11320 "vqabs.<V_s_elem>\t%<V_reg>0, %<V_reg>1"
11321 [(set_attr "type" "neon_vqneg_vqabs")]
11322 )
11323
11324 (define_insn "neon_vqneg<mode>"
11325 [(set (match_operand:VDQIW 0 "s_register_operand" "=w")
11326 (unspec:VDQIW [(match_operand:VDQIW 1 "s_register_operand" "w")
11327 (match_operand:SI 2 "immediate_operand" "i")]
11328 UNSPEC_VQNEG))]
11329 "TARGET_NEON"
11330 "vqneg.<V_s_elem>\t%<V_reg>0, %<V_reg>1"
11331 [(set_attr "type" "neon_vqneg_vqabs")]
11332 )
11333
11334 @end smallexample
11335
11336 @node Subst Iterators
11337 @subsection Subst Iterators
11338 @cindex subst iterators in @file{.md} files
11339 @findex define_subst
11340 @findex define_subst_attr
11341
11342 Subst iterators are special type of iterators with the following
11343 restrictions: they could not be declared explicitly, they always have
11344 only two values, and they do not have explicit dedicated name.
11345 Subst-iterators are triggered only when corresponding subst-attribute is
11346 used in RTL-pattern.
11347
11348 Subst iterators transform templates in the following way: the templates
11349 are duplicated, the subst-attributes in these templates are replaced
11350 with the corresponding values, and a new attribute is implicitly added
11351 to the given @code{define_insn}/@code{define_expand}. The name of the
11352 added attribute matches the name of @code{define_subst}. Such
11353 attributes are declared implicitly, and it is not allowed to have a
11354 @code{define_attr} named as a @code{define_subst}.
11355
11356 Each subst iterator is linked to a @code{define_subst}. It is declared
11357 implicitly by the first appearance of the corresponding
11358 @code{define_subst_attr}, and it is not allowed to define it explicitly.
11359
11360 Declarations of subst-attributes have the following syntax:
11361
11362 @findex define_subst_attr
11363 @smallexample
11364 (define_subst_attr "@var{name}"
11365 "@var{subst-name}"
11366 "@var{no-subst-value}"
11367 "@var{subst-applied-value}")
11368 @end smallexample
11369
11370 @var{name} is a string with which the given subst-attribute could be
11371 referred to.
11372
11373 @var{subst-name} shows which @code{define_subst} should be applied to an
11374 RTL-template if the given subst-attribute is present in the
11375 RTL-template.
11376
11377 @var{no-subst-value} is a value with which subst-attribute would be
11378 replaced in the first copy of the original RTL-template.
11379
11380 @var{subst-applied-value} is a value with which subst-attribute would be
11381 replaced in the second copy of the original RTL-template.
11382
11383 @node Parameterized Names
11384 @subsection Parameterized Names
11385 @cindex @samp{@@} in instruction pattern names
11386 Ports sometimes need to apply iterators using C++ code, in order to
11387 get the code or RTL pattern for a specific instruction. For example,
11388 suppose we have the @samp{neon_vq<absneg><mode>} pattern given above:
11389
11390 @smallexample
11391 (define_int_iterator QABSNEG [UNSPEC_VQABS UNSPEC_VQNEG])
11392
11393 (define_int_attr absneg [(UNSPEC_VQABS "abs") (UNSPEC_VQNEG "neg")])
11394
11395 (define_insn "neon_vq<absneg><mode>"
11396 [(set (match_operand:VDQIW 0 "s_register_operand" "=w")
11397 (unspec:VDQIW [(match_operand:VDQIW 1 "s_register_operand" "w")
11398 (match_operand:SI 2 "immediate_operand" "i")]
11399 QABSNEG))]
11400 @dots{}
11401 )
11402 @end smallexample
11403
11404 A port might need to generate this pattern for a variable
11405 @samp{QABSNEG} value and a variable @samp{VDQIW} mode. There are two
11406 ways of doing this. The first is to build the rtx for the pattern
11407 directly from C++ code; this is a valid technique and avoids any risk
11408 of combinatorial explosion. The second is to prefix the instruction
11409 name with the special character @samp{@@}, which tells GCC to generate
11410 the four additional functions below. In each case, @var{name} is the
11411 name of the instruction without the leading @samp{@@} character,
11412 without the @samp{<@dots{}>} placeholders, and with any underscore
11413 before a @samp{<@dots{}>} placeholder removed if keeping it would
11414 lead to a double or trailing underscore.
11415
11416 @table @samp
11417 @item insn_code maybe_code_for_@var{name} (@var{i1}, @var{i2}, @dots{})
11418 See whether replacing the first @samp{<@dots{}>} placeholder with
11419 iterator value @var{i1}, the second with iterator value @var{i2}, and
11420 so on, gives a valid instruction. Return its code if so, otherwise
11421 return @code{CODE_FOR_nothing}.
11422
11423 @item insn_code code_for_@var{name} (@var{i1}, @var{i2}, @dots{})
11424 Same, but abort the compiler if the requested instruction does not exist.
11425
11426 @item rtx maybe_gen_@var{name} (@var{i1}, @var{i2}, @dots{}, @var{op0}, @var{op1}, @dots{})
11427 Check for a valid instruction in the same way as
11428 @code{maybe_code_for_@var{name}}. If the instruction exists,
11429 generate an instance of it using the operand values given by @var{op0},
11430 @var{op1}, and so on, otherwise return null.
11431
11432 @item rtx gen_@var{name} (@var{i1}, @var{i2}, @dots{}, @var{op0}, @var{op1}, @dots{})
11433 Same, but abort the compiler if the requested instruction does not exist,
11434 or if the instruction generator invoked the @code{FAIL} macro.
11435 @end table
11436
11437 For example, changing the pattern above to:
11438
11439 @smallexample
11440 (define_insn "@@neon_vq<absneg><mode>"
11441 [(set (match_operand:VDQIW 0 "s_register_operand" "=w")
11442 (unspec:VDQIW [(match_operand:VDQIW 1 "s_register_operand" "w")
11443 (match_operand:SI 2 "immediate_operand" "i")]
11444 QABSNEG))]
11445 @dots{}
11446 )
11447 @end smallexample
11448
11449 would define the same patterns as before, but in addition would generate
11450 the four functions below:
11451
11452 @smallexample
11453 insn_code maybe_code_for_neon_vq (int, machine_mode);
11454 insn_code code_for_neon_vq (int, machine_mode);
11455 rtx maybe_gen_neon_vq (int, machine_mode, rtx, rtx, rtx);
11456 rtx gen_neon_vq (int, machine_mode, rtx, rtx, rtx);
11457 @end smallexample
11458
11459 Calling @samp{code_for_neon_vq (UNSPEC_VQABS, V8QImode)}
11460 would then give @code{CODE_FOR_neon_vqabsv8qi}.
11461
11462 It is possible to have multiple @samp{@@} patterns with the same
11463 name and same types of iterator. For example:
11464
11465 @smallexample
11466 (define_insn "@@some_arithmetic_op<mode>"
11467 [(set (match_operand:INTEGER_MODES 0 "register_operand") @dots{})]
11468 @dots{}
11469 )
11470
11471 (define_insn "@@some_arithmetic_op<mode>"
11472 [(set (match_operand:FLOAT_MODES 0 "register_operand") @dots{})]
11473 @dots{}
11474 )
11475 @end smallexample
11476
11477 would produce a single set of functions that handles both
11478 @code{INTEGER_MODES} and @code{FLOAT_MODES}.
11479
11480 It is also possible for these @samp{@@} patterns to have different
11481 numbers of operands from each other. For example, patterns with
11482 a binary rtl code might take three operands (one output and two inputs)
11483 while patterns with a ternary rtl code might take four operands (one
11484 output and three inputs). This combination would produce separate
11485 @samp{maybe_gen_@var{name}} and @samp{gen_@var{name}} functions for
11486 each operand count, but it would still produce a single
11487 @samp{maybe_code_for_@var{name}} and a single @samp{code_for_@var{name}}.
11488
11489 @end ifset